ptp2011_10k.htm


UNITED STATES
SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION
WASHINGTON, D.C.  20549
FORM 10-K

x
ANNUAL REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934
   
 
For the fiscal year ended December 31, 2011
 
or
o
TRANSITION REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934
   
 
For the transition period from __________ to ___________

Commission File Number 001-31341
Platinum Underwriters Holdings, Ltd.
(Exact name of registrant as specified in its charter)
Bermuda
(State or other jurisdiction of incorporation or organization)
 
98-0416483
(I.R.S. Employer Identification No.)
The Belvedere Building
69 Pitts Bay Road
Pembroke HM 08, Bermuda
(Address of principal executive offices, including postal code)
Registrant’s telephone number, including area code: (441) 295-7195
Securities registered pursuant to Section 12(b) of the Act:
Title of each class
Name of each exchange on which registered
Common Shares, par value $0.01 per share
New York Stock Exchange
 
Securities registered pursuant to Section 12(g) of the Act:  None
 
Indicate by check mark if the registrant is a well-known seasoned issuer, as defined in Rule 405 of the Securities Act.      Yes x  No o
 
Indicate by check mark if the registrant is not required to file reports pursuant to Section 13 or Section 15(d) of the Act.  Yes o  No x
 
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant: (1) has filed all reports required to be filed by Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to file such reports), and (2) has been subject to such filing requirements for the past 90 days.  Yes x  No o
 
Indicate by a check mark whether the registrant has submitted electronically and posted on its corporate Web site, if any, every Interactive Data File required to be submitted and posted pursuant to Rule 405 of Regulation S-T (§232.405 of this chapter) during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to submit and post such files).    Yes x  No o
 
Indicate by check mark if disclosure of delinquent filers pursuant to Item 405 of Regulation S-K is not contained herein, and will not be contained, to the best of registrant’s knowledge, in definitive proxy or information statements incorporated by reference in Part III of this Form 10-K or any amendment to this Form 10-K. x
 
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a large accelerated filer, an accelerated filer, a non-accelerated filer, or a smaller reporting company.  See the definitions of “large accelerated filer,” “accelerated filer” and “smaller reporting company” in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act.
Large accelerated filer  x
Accelerated filer  o
Non-accelerated filer (Do not check if a smaller reporting company)  o
Smaller reporting company  o
 
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a shell company (as defined in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act).  Yes o  No x
 
The aggregate market value of common shares held by non-affiliates of the registrant as of June 30, 2011, the last business day of our most recently completed second fiscal quarter, was $1,218,086,448 based on the closing sale price of $33.24 per common share on the New York Stock Exchange on that date.  For purposes of this computation only, all executive officers, directors, and 10% beneficial owners of the registrant are deemed to be affiliates.
 
The registrant had 35,530,351 common shares, par value $0.01 per share, outstanding as of February 8, 2012.
 
DOCUMENTS INCORPORATED BY REFERENCE
 
Portions of the registrant’s definitive proxy statement for the 2012 Annual General Meeting of Shareholders are incorporated by reference into Part III of this report.
 
 
 

 
 
PLATINUM UNDERWRITERS HOLDINGS, LTD.
TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
   
Page
     
PART I
 
     
Item 1.
 Business
3
Item 1A.
 Risk Factors
19
Item 1B.
 Unresolved Staff Comments
27
Item 2.
 Properties
27
Item 3.
 Legal Proceedings
27
Item 4.
 Mine Safety Disclosures
28
     
PART II
 
     
Item 5.
 Market For Registrant’s Common Equity, Related Shareholder Matters and Issuer Purchases of Equity Securities
28
Item 6.
 Selected Financial Data
30
Item 7.
 Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations
31
Item 7A.
 Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures About Market Risk
55
Item 8.
 Financial Statements and Supplementary Data
56
Item 9.
 Changes in and Disagreements With Accountants on Accounting and Financial Disclosure
56
Item 9A.
 Controls and Procedures
56
   Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm’s Report on Internal Control over Financial Reporting  
Item 9B.
 Other Information
58
     
PART III
 
     
Item 10.
 Directors, Executive Officers and Corporate Governance
58
Item 11.
 Executive Compensation
58
Item 12.
 Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners and Management and Related Shareholder Matters
58
Item 13.
 Certain Relationships and Related Transactions, and Director Independence
59
Item 14.
 Principal Accountant Fees and Services
59
     
PART IV
 
     
Item 15.
 Exhibits and Financial Statement Schedules
59
     
Signatures
 
62
Platinum Underwriters Holdings, Ltd and Subsidiaries Consolidated Financial Statements
    F-1
Index to Schedules to Consolidated Financial Statements
S-1
Exhibits
   

 
i

 
 
Note On Forward-Looking Statements

This Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2011 (this “Form 10-K”) contains forward-looking statements within the meaning of Section 27A of the Securities Act of 1933 (the “Securities Act”) and Section 21E of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 (the “Exchange Act”).  Forward-looking statements are based on our current plans or expectations that are inherently subject to significant business, economic and competitive uncertainties and contingencies.  These uncertainties and contingencies can affect actual results and could cause actual results to differ materially from those expressed in any forward-looking statements made by or on behalf of us.  In particular, statements using words such as “may”, “should”, “estimate”, “expect”, “anticipate”, “intend”, “believe”, “predict”, “potential”, or words of similar import generally involve forward-looking statements.

The inclusion of forward-looking statements in this Form 10-K should not be considered as a representation by us or any other person that our current plans or expectations will be achieved.  Numerous factors could cause our actual results to differ materially from those in forward-looking statements, including the following:
 
·  
the occurrence of severe natural or man-made catastrophic events;
 
·  
the effectiveness of our loss limitation methods and pricing models;
 
·  
the adequacy of our ceding companies’ ability to assess the risks they underwrite;
 
·  
the adequacy of our liability for unpaid losses and loss adjustment expenses;
 
·  
the effects of emerging claim and coverage issues on our business;
 
·  
our ability to maintain our A.M. Best Company, Inc. (“A.M. Best”) and Standard & Poor’s Ratings Services (“S&P”) ratings;
 
·  
our ability to raise capital on acceptable terms if necessary;
 
·  
our exposure to credit loss from counterparties in the normal course of business;
 
·  
our ability to provide reinsurance from Bermuda to insurers domiciled in the United States;
 
·  
the effect on our business of cyclicality of the property and casualty reinsurance business;
 
·  
the effect on our business of the highly competitive nature of the property and casualty reinsurance industry;
 
·  
losses that we could face from terrorism, political unrest and war;
 
·  
our dependence on the business provided to us by reinsurance brokers and our exposure to credit risk associated with our brokers during the premium and loss settlement process;
 
·  
the availability of catastrophic loss protection on acceptable terms;
 
·  
foreign currency exchange rate fluctuation;
 
·  
our ability to maintain and enhance effective operating procedures and internal controls over financial reporting;
 
·  
our need to make many estimates and judgments in the preparation of our financial statements;
 
·  
the limitations placed on our financial and operational flexibility by the representations, warranties and covenants in our debt and credit facilities;
 
·  
our ability to retain key executives and attract and retain additional qualified personnel in the future;
 
·  
the performance of our investment portfolio;
 
 
- 1 -

 
 
·  
fluctuations in the mortgage-backed and asset-backed securities markets;
 
·  
the effects of changes in market interest rates on our investment portfolio;
 
·  
the concentration of our investment portfolio in any particular industry, asset class or geographic region;
 
·  
the effects that the imposition of U.S. corporate income tax would have on Platinum Underwriters Holdings, Ltd. and its non-U.S. subsidiaries;
 
·  
the risk that U.S. persons who hold our shares will be subject to adverse U.S. federal income tax consequences under certain circumstances;
 
·  
the risk that U.S. persons who dispose of our shares may be subject to U.S. federal income taxation at the rates applicable to dividends on all or a portion of their gains, if any;
 
·  
the risk that holders of 10% or more of our shares may be subject to U.S. income taxation under the “controlled foreign corporation” rules;
 
·  
the effect of changes in U.S. federal income tax law on an investment in our shares;
 
·  
the possibility that we may become subject to taxes in Bermuda;
 
·  
the effect on our business of potential changes in the regulatory system under which we operate;
 
·  
the impact of regulatory regimes and changes to accounting rules on our financial results, irrespective of business operations;
 
·  
the uncertain impact on our business of the Dodd-Frank Wall Street Reform and Consumer Protection Act of 2010;
 
·  
the dependence of the cash flows of Platinum Underwriters Holdings, Ltd., a holding company, on dividends, interest and other permissible payments from its subsidiaries to meet its obligations;
 
·  
the risk that our shareholders may have greater difficulty in protecting their interests than would shareholders of a U.S. corporation; and
 
·  
limitations on the ownership, transfer and voting rights of our common shares.
 
As a consequence, our future financial condition and results may differ from those expressed in any forward-looking statements made by or on behalf of us.  The foregoing factors, which are discussed in more detail in Item 1A, “Risk Factors”, in this Form 10-K, should not be construed as exhaustive.  Additionally, forward-looking statements speak only as of the date they are made, and we undertake no obligation to revise or update forward-looking statements to reflect new information or circumstances after the date hereof or to reflect the occurrence of future events.

 
- 2 -

 

PART I
 
Item 1.
Business

General Overview
 
Platinum Underwriters Holdings, Ltd. (“Platinum Holdings”) is a holding company domiciled in Bermuda with approximately $1.9 billion in capital as of December 31, 2011, consisting of $1.7 billion of common shareholders’ equity and $250.0 million of Series B 7.5% Notes due June 1, 2017 (the “debt obligations”).  Through our reinsurance subsidiaries we provide property and marine, casualty and finite risk reinsurance coverages to a diverse clientele of insurers and select reinsurers on a worldwide basis.
 
Platinum Holdings and its consolidated subsidiaries (collectively, the “Company”) include Platinum Holdings, Platinum Underwriters Bermuda, Ltd. (“Platinum Bermuda”), Platinum Underwriters Reinsurance, Inc. (“Platinum US”), Platinum Underwriters Finance, Inc. (“Platinum Finance”), Platinum Regency Holdings (“Platinum Regency”), Platinum Administrative Services, Inc. and Platinum UK Services Company Limited.  The terms "we", "us", and "our" also refer to the Company, unless the context otherwise indicates.
 
Platinum Regency is an intermediate holding company based in Ireland and a wholly owned subsidiary of Platinum Holdings.  Platinum Finance is an intermediate holding company based in the U.S. and a wholly owned subsidiary of Platinum Regency.  We operate through two licensed reinsurance subsidiaries, Platinum Bermuda, a Bermuda reinsurance company, and Platinum US, a U.S. reinsurance company.   Platinum Bermuda is a wholly owned subsidiary of Platinum Holdings and Platinum US is a wholly owned subsidiary of Platinum Finance.  Platinum Administrative Services, Inc. and Platinum UK Services Company Limited are service company subsidiaries that provide administrative support services to the Company.
 
For the year ended December 31, 2011, our Property and Marine, Casualty and Finite Risk operating segments accounted for approximately 53%, 46% and 1%, respectively, of our total net written premiums of $651.5 million.  As of December 31, 2011, we had total investments and cash and cash equivalents of $4.2 billion and shareholders’ equity of $1.7 billion.

Our Strategy
 
We seek to achieve attractive long-term returns for our shareholders through disciplined risk management and market leadership in selected classes of property and marine, casualty and finite risk reinsurance by employing the following strategy:
 
 
Operate as a multi-class reinsurer.  We seek to offer a broad range of reinsurance coverages to our ceding companies.  We believe that this approach enables us to more effectively serve our clients, diversify our risk and leverage our capital.
 
 
Focus on profitability, not market share.  Our management team pursues a strategy that emphasizes profitability rather than market share.  Key elements of this strategy are prudent risk selection, appropriate pricing and adjustment of our business mix to respond to changing market conditions.
 
 
Exercise disciplined underwriting and risk management.  We exercise underwriting and risk management discipline by: (i) maintaining a diverse spread of risk in our book of business across product lines and geographic zones, (ii) emphasizing excess-of-loss contracts over proportional contracts, (iii) managing our aggregate property catastrophe exposure through the application of sophisticated modeling tools and (iv) monitoring our accumulating exposures on non-property catastrophe exposed coverages.
 
 
Operate from a position of financial strength.  Our capital is unencumbered by any potential adverse development of unpaid losses for business written prior to January 1, 2002.  Our investment strategy focuses on security and stability in our investment portfolio by maintaining a portfolio that consists primarily of diversified, high quality, predominantly investment grade fixed maturity securities.
 
We believe this strategy allows us to maintain our strong financial position and to be opportunistic when market conditions are most attractive.

Operating Segments
 
We have organized our worldwide reinsurance business into the following three operating segments:  Property and Marine, Casualty and Finite Risk.  We generally write reinsurance in each of our operating segments on either an excess-of-loss basis or a proportional basis (which is also referred to as pro rata or quota share).
 
In the case of excess-of-loss reinsurance, we assume all or a specified portion of the ceding company’s risks in excess of a specified claim amount, referred to as the ceding company’s retention or our attachment point.  We manage our underwriting risk from excess-of-loss contracts by charging reinsurance premiums at specific retention levels based upon our own underwriting assumptions.  Because ceding companies typically retain a larger loss exposure under excess-of-loss contracts, we believe that they typically have a strong incentive to underwrite risks and adjust losses in a prudent manner.
 
 
- 3 -

 
 
In the case of proportional reinsurance, we assume a predetermined portion of the ceding company’s risks under the covered primary insurance contract or contracts.  The frequency of claims under a proportional contract is usually greater than under an excess-of-loss contract, since we share proportionally in all losses.  Premiums for proportional reinsurance are typically a predetermined portion of the premiums the ceding company receives from its insureds.
 
Substantially all of the reinsurance that we underwrite is on a treaty basis, which covers a type or category of insurance policies issued by the ceding company.  In limited and opportunistic circumstances, we underwrite facultative reinsurance, where we assume all or a part of a specific insurance policy or policies.
 
The following table sets forth our net premiums written for the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009 by operating segment and by type of reinsurance ($ in thousands):
 
Net Premiums Written by Operating Segment and Type of Reinsurance

   
Years Ended December 31,
 
   
2011
   
2010
   
2009
 
   
Net Premium Written
   
Percentage of Net Premiums Written
   
Net Premium Written
   
Percentage of Net Premiums Written
   
Net Premium Written
   
Percentage of Net Premiums Written
 
Property and Marine
                                   
Excess-of-Loss
  $ 275,879       42 %   $ 337,464       44 %   $ 348,363       39 %
Proportional
    68,803       11 %     75,211       10 %     168,648       19 %
Subtotal Property and Marine
    344,682       53 %     412,675       54 %     517,011       58 %
Casualty
                                               
Excess-of-Loss
    242,314       37 %     292,968       39 %     308,054       34 %
Proportional
    54,675       9 %     36,429       5 %     48,434       5 %
Subtotal Casualty
    296,989       46 %     329,397       44 %     356,488       39 %
Finite Risk
                                               
Excess-of-Loss
    531       0 %     -       0 %     -       0 %
Proportional
    9,312       1 %     18,517       2 %     24,335       3 %
Subtotal Finite Risk
    9,843       1 %     18,517       2 %     24,335       3 %
Combined Segments
                                               
Excess-of-Loss
    518,724       79 %     630,432       83 %     656,417       73 %
Proportional
    132,790       21 %     130,157       17 %     241,417       27 %
Total
  $ 651,514       100 %   $ 760,589       100 %   $ 897,834       100 %

The following table sets forth our net premiums written for the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009 by operating segment and by geographic location of the ceding company ($ in thousands):
 
Net Premiums Written by Operating Segment and Geographic Location of the Ceding Company

   
Years Ended December 31,
 
   
2011
   
2010
   
2009
 
   
Net Premium Written
   
Percentage of Net Premiums Written
   
Net Premium Written
   
Percentage of Net Premiums Written
   
Net Premium Written
   
Percentage of Net Premiums Written
 
Property and Marine
                                   
United States
  $ 189,442       29 %   $ 230,914       30 %   $ 350,726       39 %
International
    155,240       24 %     181,761       24 %     166,285       19 %
Subtotal Property and Marine
    344,682       53 %     412,675       54 %     517,011       58 %
Casualty
                                               
United States
    258,450       40 %     277,666       37 %     315,422       35 %
International
    38,539       6 %     51,731       7 %     41,066       4 %
Subtotal Casualty
    296,989       46 %     329,397       44 %     356,488       39 %
Finite Risk
                                               
United States
    9,843       1 %     18,517       2 %     24,335       3 %
International
    -       0 %     -       0 %     -       0 %
Subtotal Finite Risk
    9,843       1 %     18,517       2 %     24,335       3 %
Combined Segments
                                               
United States
    457,735       70 %     527,097       69 %     690,483       77 %
International
    193,779       30 %     233,492       31 %     207,351       23 %
Total
  $ 651,514       100 %   $ 760,589       100 %   $ 897,834       100 %
 
 
- 4 -

 
 
Additional financial information about our operating segments is set forth in Item 7,“Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operation,” in this Form 10-K.
 
Property and Marine
 
Property reinsurance protects a ceding company against financial loss arising out of damage to property or loss of its use caused by an insured peril. Property catastrophe reinsurance protects a ceding company against losses arising out of multiple claims for a single event while property per-risk reinsurance protects a ceding company against loss arising out of a single claim for a single event.  Our Property and Marine operating segment includes principally property (including crop) and marine coverages that cover risks located in the United States and select international markets.  This business includes property catastrophe excess-of-loss reinsurance contracts, property per-risk excess-of-loss reinsurance contracts and property proportional reinsurance contracts.  We write a limited amount of property facultative reinsurance. Marine reinsurance treaties include excess-of-loss as well as proportional treaties. We employ underwriters and actuaries with expertise in each of the following areas:
 
 
Property.  We provide reinsurance coverage for damage to property and crops.  Our catastrophe excess-of-loss reinsurance contracts provide defined limits of liability, permitting us to quantify our aggregate maximum loss exposure for various catastrophic events.  Quantification of loss exposure is fundamental to our ability to manage our loss exposure through geographical zone limits and program limits.
 
 
Marine.  We provide reinsurance coverage for marine, offshore energy and aerospace insurance programs.  Coverages reinsured include hull damage, protection and indemnity, cargo damage, satellite damage, aviation hull, aviation liability, and general marine liability.
 
Casualty
 
Casualty reinsurance protects a ceding company against financial loss arising out of the obligation to others for loss or damage to persons or property.  Our Casualty operating segment principally includes reinsurance contracts that cover general and product liability, professional liability, accident and health, umbrella liability, workers' compensation, casualty clash, automobile liability, surety, trade credit, and political risk.  We generally write casualty reinsurance on an excess-of-loss basis.
 
We seek to write casualty reinsurance contracts covering established books of insurance products where we believe that past experience provides a reasonable basis to price the reinsurance adequately.  We underwrite new exposures selectively and perform a comprehensive evaluation of the risk and ceding company being reinsured.  We employ underwriters and actuaries that have expertise in one or more of the following areas:
 
 
General and Product Liability.  We provide reinsurance of various third-party liability coverages to both small and large insureds in both commercial and personal lines predominantly on an excess-of-loss basis.  This business includes coverage of commercial, farmowners and homeowners policies as well as third-party liability coverages such as product liability.
 
 
Professional Liability. We write reinsurance contracts covering professional liability programs, including directors and officers, employment practices, and errors and omissions for professionals such as accountants, lawyers, medical professionals, architects and engineers.  The underlying insurance products for these lines of business are generally written on a claims made basis, which requires notification of claims related to the liabilities insured under the policy to be submitted to the insurer during a specified coverage period.
 
 
Accident and Health.  We provide accident and health reinsurance, most often covering employer self-insured or fully insured health plans, on a quota share and excess-of-loss basis.  We also write reinsurance of student health insurance, sports disability, Medicare and Medicare supplement and other forms of accident and health insurance.
 
 
Umbrella Liability. We provide reinsurance of umbrella policies, which are excess insurance policies that provide coverage, typically for general liability or automobile liability, when claims, individually or in the aggregate, exceed the limit of the original policy underlying the excess policy.
 
 
Workers’ Compensation.  We reinsure workers’ compensation on a catastrophic basis as well as on a per-claimant basis.  We may provide full statutory coverage or coverage that is subject to specific carve-outs.  Our exposure to workers’ compensation would generally arise from a single occurrence, such as a factory explosion, or earthquake which involves claims from more than one employer.
 
 
Casualty Clash. We provide casualty clash reinsurance, which covers losses arising from a single event insured under more than one policy or where there are multiple claimants under one policy.  This type of reinsurance is analogous to property catastrophe reinsurance, but written for casualty lines of business.
 
 
Automobile Liability. We provide automobile liability reinsurance, which relates to the risks associated with the insured’s vehicle and third-party coverage for the insured’s liability to other parties for injuries, for damage to the insured’s property due to the use of the insured vehicle and coverage for uninsured motorists and medical payments.
 
 
Surety. We reinsure risks associated with commercial and contract surety bonds issued to third parties to guarantee the performance of an obligation by the principal under the bond.  Commercial bonds guarantee compliance with obligations arising out of regulatory or statutory requirements.  Contract bonds guarantee the performance of contractual obligations between two parties and include payment and performance bonds.
 
 
- 5 -

 
 
 
Trade Credit.  Trade credit insurance is purchased by companies to ensure that invoices for goods and services provided to their customers are paid on time.  We provide trade credit reinsurance for financial losses sustained through the failure of an insured’s customers to pay for goods or services supplied to them.
 
 
Political Risk.  Political risk reinsurance covers the impairment of assets as a result of expropriation, political violence, currency inconvertibility, and the failure by sovereign countries to honor their obligations.  The locations of risks that we reinsure include Asia, Central and Eastern Europe, Latin America, Africa and the Middle East.
 
 
Finite Risk
 
Finite risk reinsurance, often referred to as non-traditional reinsurance, includes principally structured reinsurance contracts with ceding companies whose needs may not be met efficiently through traditional reinsurance products. Reinsurance contracts classified as finite risk are typically structured to include loss limitation or loss mitigation features.  In exchange for contractual features that limit our risk, these reinsurance contracts typically provide the potential for a significant profit commission to the ceding company.  The classes of risks underwritten through our finite risk contracts are generally consistent with the classes covered by our traditional products. The finite risk reinsurance contracts that we underwrite generally provide prospective protection, meaning coverage is provided for losses that are incurred after inception of the contract, as contrasted with retrospective coverage, which covers losses that are incurred prior to inception of the contract.  The three main categories of our finite risk reinsurance contracts are quota share, multi-year excess-of-loss and whole account aggregate stop loss:
 
 
Finite quota share.  Under finite quota share reinsurance contracts, the reinsurer agrees to indemnify a ceding company for a percentage of its losses up to an aggregate maximum or cap in return for a percentage of the ceding company’s premium, less a ceding commission.  The expected benefit to the ceding company provided by finite quota share reinsurance is increased underwriting capacity of the ceding company and a sharing of premiums and losses with the reinsurer.  These reinsurance contracts often provide broad protection and may cover multiple classes of a ceding company's business.  Unlike traditional quota share reinsurance agreements, these contracts often provide for profit commissions which take into account investment income for purposes of calculating the reinsurer's profit on business ceded.  Additionally, finite quota share reinsurance contracts are often written on a funds withheld basis, meaning the parties agree that funds that would normally be remitted to a reinsurer are withheld by the ceding company.  The funds withheld are generally credited with interest at a negotiated rate and the net balances are settled generally after expiration at a date established in the contract.
 
 
Multi-year excess-of-loss.  These reinsurance contracts often complement ceding companies’ traditional excess-of-loss reinsurance programs.  This type of contract often carries an up-front premium plus additional premiums which are dependent on the magnitude of losses claimed by the ceding company under the contract.  The expected benefit to the ceding company on multi-year excess-of-loss reinsurance is that the ceding company has the ability to negotiate specific terms and conditions that remain applicable over multiple years of coverage.  These reinsurance contracts may cover multiple classes of a ceding company's business and typically provide the benefit of reducing the impact of large or catastrophic losses on a ceding company's underwriting results.  In general, these reinsurance contracts are designed so that the ceding company funds the expected level of loss activity over the multi-year period.  The reinsurer incorporates a profit margin to cover its costs and a charge for the risk that actual losses assumed may be worse than expected.  The payment of premiums based on the magnitude of losses claimed is intended to benefit the ceding company by linking its own loss experience to the actual cost of reinsurance over time.  The multiple year term and premium structure of multi-year excess-of-loss reinsurance contracts are not typically found in traditional reinsurance contracts.
 
 
Whole account aggregate stop loss.  Aggregate stop loss reinsurance contracts provide broad protection against a wide range of contingencies that are difficult to address with traditional reinsurance, including inadequate pricing by a ceding company or higher frequency of claims than the ceding company expected.  The reinsurer on a whole account aggregate stop loss contract agrees to indemnify a ceding company for aggregate losses in excess of a deductible specified in the contract.  These contracts can be offered on a single or multi-year basis, and may provide catastrophic and attritional loss protection.  The benefit of whole account aggregate stop loss contracts to ceding companies is that such contracts provide the broadest possible protection of a ceding company's underwriting results which is not generally available in the traditional reinsurance market.  Unlike traditional reinsurance contracts, these contracts often contain sub-limits of coverage for losses on certain classes of business or exposures and often include provisions for profit commissions which take into account investment income for purposes of calculating the reinsurer's profit on business ceded. Additionally, these reinsurance contracts may be written on a funds withheld basis.
 
Marketing
 
We market our reinsurance products worldwide primarily through non-exclusive relationships with leading reinsurance brokers, as we believe that the use of reinsurance brokers enables us to operate on a more cost-effective basis and to maintain the flexibility to enter and exit reinsurance lines in a quick and efficient manner.  We also believe that brokers are particularly useful in assisting with placements of excess-of-loss reinsurance programs. In addition to their role as intermediaries in placing risk, brokers perform data collection, contract preparation and other administrative tasks.  We believe that by doing business largely through reinsurance brokers we are able to avoid the expense and regulatory complications of a worldwide network of offices and thereby minimize fixed costs associated with marketing activities.
 
Based on in-force premiums written by us as of December 31, 2011, the brokers from which we derived the largest portions of our business (with the approximate percentage of business derived from each of such brokers and its affiliates) were: Marsh & McLennan Companies (35.3%), Aon Benfield (35.2%), and Willis Group Holdings (15.3%).  The loss of business relationships with any of these brokers could have a material adverse effect on our business.
 
 
- 6 -

 
 
Underwriting and Risk Management
 
Overview
 
Our approach to underwriting and risk management emphasizes discipline and profitability rather than premium volume or market share.  We seek to limit our overall exposure to risk by limiting the amount of reinsurance we write by geographic zone, peril and type of program or contract.  Our risk management practices include evaluating the quality of the ceding company in connection with our review of a program proposal and using contract terms, diversification criteria, probability analysis and analysis of comparable historical loss experience.  We estimate the impact of catastrophic events using information from ceding companies, reinsurance contract information, expected loss ratios, our historical loss ratios, industry loss data and catastrophe modeling software to evaluate our exposure to losses from individual contracts and in the aggregate.
 
Ceding Company Selection and Underwriting Evaluation
 
Before entering into a reinsurance contract, we consider the quality of the ceding company, including the experience and reputation of its management, its capital, its risk management and underwriting strategy and practices and its claims settlement practices and procedures. In addition, we seek to obtain information on the nature of the perils to be covered and, in the case of natural peril catastrophe exposures, aggregate information as to the location or locations of the risks covered under the reinsurance contract.  We request information on the ceding company’s loss history for the perils proposed to be covered, together with relevant underwriting considerations, which would impact our exposures.  If the program meets all these initial underwriting criteria, we then evaluate the proposal’s risk/reward profile to assess the adequacy of the proposed pricing and its potential impact on our overall return on capital.
 
Loss Limits
 
Reinsurance contracts generally contain limits that restrict the amount that we may be required to pay in the event of a loss.  These limits may apply on a per risk, per occurrence, or aggregate basis.  Contracts with per risk limits include a limit on our liability for each underlying insured, for each occurrence.  If multiple underlying insureds are affected by a single event, our total limit of liability, without any other mitigating contractual terms, would be the sum of the per risk limits for all the underlying insureds affected by the event up to the occurrence or aggregate limits.  Per occurrence limits restrict our liability to a certain amount for each event, regardless of the number of underlying insureds involved.  If multiple events occur in a single reinsurance policy period, our total limit of liability, without any other mitigating contractual terms, would be the sum of the occurrence limits for all events within the policy term.  Aggregate limits provide us with a maximum amount for which we are liable, in total, for all underlying risks and all occurrences combined within the coverage period.
 
Our contracts typically contain a per risk limit or an occurrence limit and may contain both.  Some of our contracts contain an aggregate limit.  Property and marine reinsurance contracts with natural catastrophe exposure generally contain occurrence limits.  In addition, our high layer property and marine reinsurance contracts generally contain aggregate limits.  Casualty reinsurance contracts generally contain either a per risk or an occurrence limit.  Casualty clash contracts generally contain an aggregate limit.  Few of our other casualty contracts contain an aggregate limit.
 
Loss Modeling and Monitoring
 
For catastrophe coverages exposed to natural perils, we measure our exposure to aggregate catastrophic claims using catastrophe models that analyze the effect of wind speed and earthquakes on the exposed property values within our portfolio.  We seek to limit the amount of capital that we expect to lose from a severe catastrophic event; however, there can be no assurance that we will successfully limit actual losses from such a catastrophic event.
 
We use sophisticated modeling techniques to measure and estimate loss exposure under both simulated and actual loss scenarios.  We also use these models to assess the impact of both single and multiple events.  We evaluate the commercial catastrophe exposure models that form the basis for our own proprietary pricing models.  These computer-based loss modeling systems primarily utilize direct exposure information obtained from our clients and data compiled by A.M. Best to assess each client’s potential for catastrophe losses.  We believe that loss modeling is an important part of the underwriting process for catastrophe exposure pricing.
 
We maintain a database of our exposure in each geographic zone and estimate our probable maximum loss for each zone and for each peril (e.g. earthquakes and hurricanes) to which that zone is subject based on catastrophe models and underwriting assessments.  We also use catastrophe loss modeling to review exposures from events that cross country borders, such as wind events that may affect the Caribbean and Florida or the United Kingdom and continental Europe.  Our largest exposures are in the United States for hurricane and earthquake, in Europe for flood and wind, and in Japan for earthquake and typhoons.
 
In respect of our property catastrophe exposure, we seek to limit our estimated probable maximum loss to a specific level for severe catastrophic events.  We currently expect to limit the probable maximum pre-tax loss for 2012 to no more than 22.5% of total capital for a severe catastrophic event in any geographic zone that could be expected to occur once in every 250 years, although we may change this threshold at any time.  The estimated probable maximum loss for a catastrophic event in any geographic zone arising from a 1-in-250 year event was approximately $219.0 million, or 11.3% of total capital, and $396.0 million, or 18.5% of total capital, as of January 1, 2012 and January 1, 2011, respectively.
 
We also monitor our exposures to accumulating risks for man-made perils impacting coverage such as surety, umbrella liability, directors’ and officers’ liability, trade credit and terrorism.
 
Diversification
 
We seek to diversify our property catastrophe exposure across geographic zones and type of peril around the world in order to manage the concentration of risk.  We attempt to limit our coverage for risks located in a particular zone to a predetermined level.  Currently, our largest property exposures are in Florida and other coastal states in the United States, and in the Caribbean, Japan, and northern Europe.
 
 
- 7 -

 
 
We seek to diversify our casualty exposure by writing casualty business throughout the United States and internationally.  In addition, we seek to diversify our casualty exposure by writing casualty reinsurance across a broad range of product lines.
 
Retrocessional Reinsurance and Derivative Instruments
 
We buy retrocessional reinsurance, which is insurance for our own account, to reduce liability on individual risks, protect against catastrophic losses and obtain additional underwriting capacity.  Our decisions with respect to purchasing retrocessional coverage take into account both the potential coverage and market conditions such as pricing, terms, conditions and availability of such coverage, with the aim of securing cost-effective protection.  We may purchase industry loss warranty reinsurance, which provides retrocessional coverage when insurance industry losses for a defined event exceed a certain level.  We expect that the type and level of retrocessional coverage we purchase will vary over time, reflecting our view of the changing dynamics of both the underlying exposure and the reinsurance markets.  There can be no assurance that retrocessional coverage will be available on terms we find acceptable.
 
Retrocessional agreements do not relieve us from our obligations to the insurers and reinsurers from whom we assume business.  The failure of retrocessionaires to honor their obligations would result in losses to us.  Consequently, we consider the financial strength of retrocessionaires when determining whether to purchase retrocessional coverage from them.  We generally obtain retrocessional coverage from companies rated “A-” or better by A.M. Best unless the retrocessionaire’s obligations are collateralized.  We routinely monitor the financial performance and rating status of all material retrocessionaires.
 
We may also use derivative instruments to reduce our exposure to catastrophe losses as an alternative to traditional retrocession.  We either trade derivatives on recognized exchanges or require collateral to enhance the financial security of the derivative counterparty.  We may also use derivative instruments to reduce our exposure to other types of underwriting exposures, such as on our crop portfolio.

Claims Administration
 
Our claims personnel administer claims arising from our reinsurance contracts, including validating and monitoring claims, posting case reserves and approving payments.  Authority for establishing reserves and payment of claims is based upon the level and experience of claims personnel.
 
Our claims personnel, or consultants engaged by us, conduct periodic audits of specific claims and the overall claims procedures of our ceding companies at their offices.  We rely on our ability to effectively monitor the claims handling and claims reserving practices of ceding companies in order to help establish the reinsurance premium for reinsurance contracts and to estimate our liability for unpaid losses and loss adjustment expenses.  Moreover, prior to accepting or renewing certain risks, our underwriters may request that our claims personnel conduct pre-underwriting claims audits of ceding companies.

Unpaid Losses and Loss Adjustment Expenses
 
Unpaid losses and loss adjustment expenses on our consolidated balance sheets represent our best estimates, at a given point in time, of our liability to pay losses and loss adjustment expenses (“LAE”) for reinsured claims for events that have occurred on or before the balance sheet date.  We do not establish liabilities for unpaid losses and LAE until the occurrence of an event that may give rise to a loss.
 
Estimates of losses and LAE are established after extensive consultation with individual underwriters, actuarial review of loss development patterns and comparison with industry and our own loss information.  These estimates are based on predictions of future developments and trends, including predictions of claim severity and frequency.  Consequently, estimates of ultimate losses and LAE, and our unpaid liability for losses and LAE, may differ materially from our initial estimates.  We report changes in estimates of prior years’ unpaid losses and LAE in our consolidated statement of operations in the period in which we make the change.
 
The following table sets forth the changes in our liability for unpaid losses and LAE for the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009 ($ in thousands):

   
2011
   
2010
   
2009
 
Net unpaid losses and LAE as of January 1,
  $ 2,208,466     $ 2,335,008     $ 2,452,045  
Net incurred losses and LAE related to:
                       
Current year
    905,595       625,250       579,304  
Prior years
    (100,158 )     (157,830 )     (100,962 )
Net incurred losses and LAE
    805,437       467,420       478,342  
Net paid losses and LAE related to:
                       
Current year
    155,534       96,245       67,693  
Prior years
    477,755       497,968       539,517  
Net paid losses and LAE
    633,289       594,213       607,210  
Net effects of foreign currency exchange rate changes
    5,045       251       11,831  
Net unpaid losses and LAE as of December 31,
    2,385,659       2,208,466       2,335,008  
Reinsurance recoverable on unpaid losses and LAE
    3,955       8,912       14,328  
Gross unpaid losses and LAE as of December 31,
  $ 2,389,614     $ 2,217,378     $ 2,349,336  
 
 
- 8 -

 
 
The following table sets forth the components of net incurred losses and LAE related to prior years for the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009 ($ in thousands):

   
2011
   
2010
   
2009
 
Net favorable loss development
  $ (112,984 )   $ (158,939 )   $ (100,793 )
Effect of changes in premium estimates
    10,857       14,331       (169 )
Change in unallocated loss adjustment expense reserves
    1,969       (13,222 )     -  
Net incurred losses and LAE - prior years
  $ (100,158 )   $ (157,830 )   $ (100,962 )

Net favorable loss development was primarily the result of favorable adjustments in ultimate loss ratios.  Prior years’ incurred losses and LAE included losses associated with changes in premium estimates and the patterns of their earnings.  The effect on net income of changes in premium estimates, after considering corresponding changes in related losses, LAE and acquisition expenses, was not significant.  During the year ended December 31, 2010, a review of our administrative expenses of managing claims resulted in a $13.2 million reduction of unallocated loss adjustment expense (“ULAE”) reserves.

The net favorable loss development for the year ended December 31, 2011 emerged primarily from the Property and Marine and Casualty segments.  The Property and Marine segment had $41.4 million of net favorable loss development, including $19.4 million of net favorable loss development related to major catastrophe events, primarily from 2010 events, and an additional $22.0 million of net favorable loss development unrelated to major catastrophe events.  The Casualty segment had $59.4 million of net favorable loss development, of which $52.7 million was attributable to the long-tailed casualty classes.  The majority of the long-tailed casualty net favorable loss development was attributable to the 2007 and prior underwriting years of the claims made, casualty occurrence excess-of-loss and umbrella classes, partially offset by net unfavorable loss development in the international casualty class in the 2008 and 2010 underwriting years.  The Finite Risk segment experienced net favorable loss development of $12.1 million, which was partially offset by $8.2 million of additional profit commissions on these contracts.

The net favorable loss development for the year ended December 31, 2010 emerged primarily from the Property and Marine and Casualty segments.  The Property and Marine segment had $36.9 million of net favorable loss development, including $53.0 million of net favorable loss development unrelated to major catastrophe events and net unfavorable loss development of $16.2 million related to major catastrophe events, primarily Hurricane Ike.  The Casualty segment had $113.3 million of net favorable loss development, of which $96.4 million was attributable to the long-tailed casualty classes in the 2006 and prior underwriting years.  The majority of the long-tailed casualty net favorable loss development was attributable to the claims made, casualty occurrence excess-of-loss, clash and umbrella classes, partially offset by net unfavorable loss development in the international casualty class in the 2008 underwriting year.  The Finite Risk segment experienced net favorable loss development of $8.8 million, which was substantially offset by adjustments relating to profit commissions on these contracts.
 
The net favorable loss development for the year ended December 31, 2009 emerged primarily from the Property and Marine and Casualty segments and was unrelated to major catastrophe events.  The Property and Marine segment had $14.3 million of net favorable loss development, including $17.7 million of net favorable loss development unrelated to major catastrophe events and net unfavorable loss development of $3.5 million related to major catastrophe events.  The Casualty segment had $73.6 million of net favorable loss development, of which $68.2 million was attributable to the long-tailed casualty classes.  The majority of the long-tailed casualty net favorable loss development was attributable to the umbrella, claims made and casualty occurrence excess-of-loss classes.  The Finite Risk segment experienced net favorable loss development of $12.9 million, which was substantially offset by adjustments relating to profit commissions on these contracts.
 
The net favorable loss development for the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009 was primarily attributable to a level of cumulative losses reported by our ceding companies that was lower than expected, and that, in our judgment, resulted in sufficient credibility in the loss experience to change our previously selected loss ratios and reduce estimated ultimate losses.  For additional discussion on changes in loss experience see Item 7, “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations-Critical Accounting Estimates-Variability of Outcomes,” in this Form 10-K.
 
The table below shows the development of the liability for net unpaid losses and LAE from December 31, 2002, the end of the first period of our operations, through December 31, 2011.  The top line of the table shows the liability for unpaid losses and LAE, net of unpaid retrocessional reinsurance recoverable, at the balance sheet date for each of the indicated years.  This represents our estimate of our gross and net liability for losses and LAE arising in all prior years that are unpaid at the balance sheet date, including our estimate of the cost of claims incurred but not yet reported, generally referred to as “IBNR.”  We re-estimate the liability to reflect additional information regarding claims incurred prior to the end of each year.  Changes in our estimate of our liability for unpaid losses and LAE recorded at the end of the prior year are reflected in the consolidated statement of operations of the year during which the liabilities are re-estimated and result in a redundancy or deficiency of our unpaid losses and LAE.  A cumulative redundancy or deficiency reflects the cumulative difference between the original estimate of our liability for unpaid losses and LAE and the current re-estimated liability.
 
The table also shows the cumulative amounts paid as of successive years with respect to that liability.  Unpaid losses and LAE denominated in foreign currencies are restated at the foreign exchange rates in effect as of December 31, 2011 and the resulting cumulative foreign exchange effect is shown as an adjustment to the cumulative redundancy.  Each amount in the table includes the effects of all changes in amounts for the prior years.
 
The table does not present accident year or underwriting year development data nor does it include any corresponding adjustments that may accompany loss redundancies or deficiencies such as premium or commission adjustments.  Conditions and trends that have affected the development of liabilities in the past may not necessarily exist in the future.  Therefore, it would not be appropriate to extrapolate future deficiencies or redundancies based on the following table.

 
- 9 -

 
 
Development of Loss and LAE Reserves
($ in thousands)

   
2002
   
2003
   
2004
   
2005
   
2006
   
2007
   
2008
   
2009
   
2010
   
2011
 
Net unpaid losses and LAE as of December 31,
  $ 281,659     731,918     $ 1,379,227     $ 2,268,655     $ 2,326,227     $ 2,342,185     $ 2,452,045     $ 2,335,008     $ 2,208,466     $ 2,385,659  
Net unpaid losses and LAE re-estimated as of:
                                                                               
One year later
    224,693       649,902       1,306,708       2,215,635       2,235,849       2,182,249       2,351,083       2,177,178       2,108,308          
Two years later
    194,422       604,891       1,277,627       2,149,153       2,129,932       2,076,330       2,217,451       2,075,876                  
Three years later
    176,884       603,293       1,254,213       2,072,604       2,032,074       1,931,064       2,124,700                          
Four years later
    175,683       601,719       1,210,091       1,999,484       1,924,117       1,848,172                                  
Five years later
    173,546       589,028       1,170,602       1,934,784       1,868,036                                          
Six years later
    173,601       586,747       1,131,404       1,900,762                                                  
Seven years later
    180,929       571,473       1,112,460                                                          
Eight years later
    179,335       565,208                                                                  
Nine years later
    177,855                                                                          
                                                                                 
Net cumulative redundancy
    103,804       166,710       266,767       367,893       458,191       494,013       327,346       259,132       100,158          
Adjustment for foreign currency exchange
    13,755       4,526       (10,399 )     3,550       (1,084 )     (4,466 )     1,286       (2,161 )     595          
Cumulative redundancy excluding foreign currency exchange
    117,559       171,236       256,368       371,443       457,107       489,547       328,632       256,971       100,753          
                                                                                 
Net cumulative paid losses and LAE as of:
                                                                               
One year later
    41,709       205,889       388,700       624,006       577,739       433,961       539,514       497,968       477,758          
Two years later
    62,604       265,376       536,351       1,065,607       873,487       725,689       877,863       778,838                  
Three years later
    73,908       320,399       696,809       1,285,151       1,096,071       952,980       1,112,639                          
Four years later
    90,982       373,081       799,763       1,440,075       1,265,463       1,102,726                                  
Five years later
    107,425       416,902       869,188       1,550,747       1,364,615                                          
Six years later
    125,264       456,040       912,442       1,612,831                                                  
Seven years later
    146,278       476,506       944,286                                                          
Eight years later
    152,462       492,013                                                                  
Nine years later
    158,587                                                                          
                                                                                 
Gross liability-end of year
    281,659       736,934       1,380,955       2,323,990       2,368,482       2,361,038       2,463,506       2,349,336       2,217,378       2,389,614  
Reinsurance recoverable on unpaid losses and LAE
    -       5,016       1,728       55,335       42,255       18,853       11,461       14,328       8,912       3,955  
Net liability-end of year
  $ 281,659     $ 731,918     $ 1,379,227     $ 2,268,655     $ 2,326,227     $ 2,342,185     $ 2,452,045     $ 2,335,008     $ 2,208,466     $ 2,385,659  
                                                                                 
Gross liability-re-estimated
  $ 177,855     $ 570,190     $ 1,115,666     $ 1,963,267     $ 1,923,470     $ 1,866,653     $ 2,138,463     $ 2,092,712     $ 2,117,787          
Gross cumulative redundancy
  $ 103,804     $ 166,744     $ 265,289     $ 360,723     $ 445,012     $ 494,384     $ 325,044     $ 256,624     $ 99,591          
 
Investments
 
As of December 31, 2011, our investments and cash and cash equivalents totaled $4.2 billion, consisting of $2.8 billion of fixed maturity securities, $588.8 million of short-term investments and $792.5 million of cash and cash equivalents.  See Item 7, “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations – Financial Condition”, in this Form 10-K for additional discussion and disclosures on our investment and cash position.
 
The primary objective of our investment strategy is to generate investment income by maintaining a portfolio that consists primarily of diversified, high quality, predominantly investment grade fixed maturity securities.  We do not invest in instruments such as credit default swaps or collateralized debt obligations.  We may invest in common and preferred stocks and securities denominated in currencies other than the U.S. dollar.  In addition, we may use financial futures and options and foreign currency exchange contracts as part of a hedging strategy.  From time to time, we may make investments of a strategic or opportunistic nature. We evaluate the expected rate of return of various investment classes over the current risk-free rate of return when determining investment allocations.  We also manage the duration of our investment portfolio while considering the duration of our reinsurance and other contractual liabilities.
 
 
- 10 -

 
 
Our investment guidelines contain limits on the portion of our investment portfolio that may be invested in various investment classes and in the securities of any single issue or issuer, with the exception of U.S. Government securities or securities guaranteed by the U.S. Government. We review our investment guidelines periodically and from time to time may adjust accordingly.
 
Our investments are subject to market risks.  The principal risks that influence the fair value of our investment portfolio are interest rate risk, credit risk, liquidity risk and foreign currency exchange rate risk.  See Item 7A, “Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures about Market Risk”, in this Form 10-K.
 
The following table summarizes the fair value of our investments and cash and cash equivalents as of December 31, 2011 and 2010 ($ in thousands):

   
December 31,
 
   
2011
   
2010
 
U.S. Government
  $ 5,083     $ 391,303  
U.S. Government agencies
    100,259       116,450  
Municipal bonds
    1,660,760       1,537,432  
Non-U.S. governments
    196,392       216,395  
Corporate bonds
    349,548       366,968  
Commercial mortgage-backed securities
    204,609       203,313  
Residential mortgage-backed securities
    251,627       166,458  
Asset-backed securities
    20,422       23,568  
Insurance-linked securities
    -       26,086  
Total fixed maturity securities
  $ 2,788,700     $ 3,047,973  
Short-term investments
    588,834       176,648  
Total investments
  $ 3,377,534     $ 3,224,621  
Cash and cash equivalents
    792,510       987,877  
Total investments and cash and cash equivalents
  $ 4,170,044     $ 4,212,498  

U.S. Government agencies consist of securities issued by financial institutions under the Temporary Liquidity Guarantee Program guaranteed by the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation.  Non-U.S. governments consist primarily of securities issued by governments and financial institutions that are explicitly guaranteed by the respective government.
 
As of December 31, 2011 and 2010, our portfolio of fixed maturity securities and short-term investments had a dollar weighted average rating of Aa2, primarily measured by Moody’s Investors Service (“Moody’s”).  If a particular security did not have a Moody's rating, then a rating from S&P was generally converted to a Moody's equivalent rating.
 
The following table summarizes the fair values of our fixed maturity securities and short-term investments as of December 31, 2011 and 2010 by credit quality ($ in thousands):

     
December 31,
 
     
2011
   
2010
 
     
Fair Value
   
% of Total
   
Fair Value
   
% of Total
 
Credit Quality                          
Aaa
    $ 1,504,876       44.6 %   $ 1,395,880       43.3 %
Aa
      1,037,257       30.7 %     1,033,317       32.0 %
A
      556,439       16.5     470,525       14.6
Baa
      206,978       6.1 %     225,928       7.0 %
Below Baa
      71,984       2.1 %     98,971       3.1 %
Total
    $ 3,377,534       100.0 %   $ 3,224,621       100.0 %

As of December 31, 2011, there were approximately $20.5 million of municipal bonds whose ratings of "Aa" included the benefit of guarantees from third-party insurers that would otherwise be rated as "A" without the existence of such guarantees.  
 
We consider the estimated duration of our reinsurance and other contractual liabilities when establishing the target duration of our investment portfolio.  Our aggregate cash and cash equivalents and invested assets, including accrued investment income and net balances due to and from brokers, had a duration of 3.6 years and 4.1 years as of December 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively.
 
 
- 11 -

 
 
Valuation
 
The investment valuation process requires significant judgment and involves analyzing factors specific to each security.  When determining the fair value of a security we generally obtain prices from several sources and establish a hierarchy based on the reliability of information.  The determination of whether unrealized losses represent temporary changes in fair value or were the result of other-than-temporary impairments also involves significant judgment.  See Item 7, “Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations - Critical Accounting Estimates - Valuation of Investments”, in this Form 10-K.

Competition
 
The property and casualty reinsurance industry is highly competitive.  Some of our competitors are large financial institutions that have reinsurance operations, while others are specialty reinsurance companies.  Many of our competitors have greater financial, marketing and management resources than we do.  We compete with reinsurers worldwide on the basis of many factors, including premium charges and other terms and conditions offered, services provided, ratings assigned by independent rating agencies, speed of claims payment, perceived financial strength and experience and reputation of the reinsurer in the line of reinsurance to be underwritten.
 
Our principal competitors vary by type of business.  Bermuda-based reinsurers are significant competitors on property catastrophe business.  Lloyd’s of London syndicates are significant competitors on marine business.  On international business, large European reinsurers are significant competitors.  Large U.S. direct reinsurers, as well as lead U.S.-based broker market reinsurers, are significant competitors on U.S. casualty business.  Our competitors include Alterra Capital Holdings Limited, Arch Capital Group Ltd., Aspen Insurance Holdings Limited, Axis Capital Holdings Limited, Endurance Specialty Holdings Ltd., Everest Re Group, Ltd., Flagstone Reinsurance Holdings Limited, Montpelier Re Holdings Ltd., PartnerRe Ltd., RenaissanceRe Holdings Ltd. (“RenaissanceRe”), Transatlantic Holdings, Inc. and Validus Holdings, Ltd.
 
Traditional as well as new capital market participants from time to time produce alternative products (such as reinsurance securitizations, catastrophe bonds and various derivative instruments, such as swaps) that may compete with certain types of reinsurance, such as property catastrophe.  Over time, these initiatives could significantly affect supply, pricing and competition in our industry and partially displace our traditional reinsurance products.
 
Financial Strength Ratings
 
Insurer financial strength ratings are current opinions of rating agencies of the financial strength of an insurance organization with respect to its ability to meet obligations under its insurance policies and contracts.  Financial strength ratings are used by ceding companies and reinsurance intermediaries to aid in assessing the financial strength and quality of reinsurers, and thus are an important factor in evaluating and establishing their competitive positions.  A.M. Best and S&P are generally considered to be significant rating agencies for the evaluation of insurance and reinsurance companies.  A.M. Best and S&P ratings are based on a quantitative and qualitative evaluation of performance with respect to capitalization, operating results, business position, financial flexibility, liquidity and enterprise risk management.
 
A.M. Best has assigned a financial strength rating of “A” (Excellent) with a stable outlook to each of our reinsurance subsidiaries.  This rating is the third highest of sixteen rating levels.  According to A.M. Best, a rating of “A” indicates A.M. Best’s opinion that a company has an excellent ability to meet its ongoing obligations to policyholders.  S&P has assigned a financial strength rating of “A-” (Strong) with a stable outlook to each of our reinsurance subsidiaries.  This rating is the seventh highest of twenty-two levels.  According to S&P, a rating of   “A-” indicates S&P’s opinion that an insurer has strong capacity to meet financial commitments, but is somewhat more susceptible to the adverse effects of changes in circumstances and economic conditions than obligors in higher-rated categories.  These ratings are subject to periodic review by A.M. Best and S&P and may be revised downward or revoked at the sole discretion of A.M. Best or S&P.  A.M. Best and S&P may increase their scrutiny of rated companies, revise their rating standards or take other action that could lead to changes in our ratings. If A.M. Best or S&P revise their rating standards associated with our current rating, our rating may be downgraded or we may need to raise additional capital to maintain our rating.

Employees
 
As of December 31, 2011, we employed 125 people.

Regulation
 
The business of reinsurance is regulated in most countries and by most states in the United States, although the degree and type of regulation varies significantly from one jurisdiction to another.  Reinsurers are generally subject to less direct regulation than primary insurers.  Reinsurers licensed in the United States and Bermuda are regulated and must comply with financial supervision standards comparable to those governing primary insurers.  Platinum Bermuda is domiciled in Bermuda and Platinum US is domiciled in Maryland.  Although principally regulated by the regulatory authorities of those jurisdictions, our reinsurance subsidiaries may also be subject to regulation in the jurisdiction of their ceding companies.
 
Bermuda Regulation
 
Platinum Holdings and Platinum Bermuda are incorporated in Bermuda.  The Insurance Act 1978 of Bermuda and related regulations, as amended (the “Insurance Act”), provides that no person may carry on any insurance business in or from within Bermuda unless registered as an insurer under the Insurance Act by the Bermuda Monetary Authority (the “Authority”) which is responsible for the day-to-day supervision of insurers. Platinum Bermuda is registered as an insurer in Bermuda.
 
The Insurance Act also grants to the Authority powers to supervise, investigate and intervene in the affairs of insurance companies.  Under the Insurance Act, insurance business includes reinsurance business.
 
 
- 12 -

 
 
An Insurance Advisory Committee appointed by the Bermuda Minister of Finance (the “Minister of Finance”) advises the Authority on matters connected with the discharge of the Authority’s functions, and subcommittees thereof supervise, investigate and review the law and practice of insurance in Bermuda, including reviews of accounting and administrative procedures.
 
An insurer’s registration may be canceled by the Authority on grounds specified in the Insurance Act, including failure of the insurer to comply with its obligations under the Insurance Act or if, in the opinion of the Authority, the insurer has not been carrying on business in accordance with sound insurance principles.  The Insurance Act also imposes solvency and liquidity standards and auditing and reporting requirements on Bermuda insurance companies.  Certain significant aspects of the Bermuda insurance regulatory framework are set forth below.
 
The Insurance Act distinguishes between long-term business and general business.  Long-term business consists of life, annuity, accident and disability contracts in effect for not less than five years and certain other types of contracts.  General business is any insurance business that is not long-term business.  There are six classifications of insurers carrying on general business, with Class 4 insurers being very large commercial underwriters.  Platinum Bermuda is registered as a Class 4 insurer and is regulated as such under the Insurance Act.
 
Principal Representative and Principal Office.  Platinum Bermuda is required to maintain a principal office in Bermuda and to appoint and maintain a principal representative in Bermuda.  For the purpose of the Insurance Act, the principal office of Platinum Bermuda is at our principal executive offices in Bermuda.  Without a reason acceptable to the Authority, an insurer may not terminate the appointment of its principal representative, and the principal representative may not cease to act as such, unless 30 days notice in writing is given to the Authority of the intention to do so.  It is the duty of the principal representative, upon reaching the view that there is a likelihood of the insurer for which the principal representative acts becoming insolvent or that a reportable “event” has, to the principal representative’s knowledge, occurred or is believed to have occurred, to immediately notify the Authority and to make a report in writing to the Authority within 14 days setting out all the particulars of the case that are available to the principal representative.  Examples of such a reportable “event” include failure by the insurer to comply substantially with a condition imposed upon the insurer by the Authority relating to a solvency margin or liquidity or other ratio, a significant loss likely to cause the insurer to fail to comply with its enhanced capital requirement (discussed below) and the occurrence of a material change (as such term is defined under the Insurance Act) in its business operations.
 
Where there has been a significant loss that is reasonably likely to cause the insurer to fail to comply with its enhanced capital requirement, the principal representative must also furnish the Authority with a capital and solvency return reflecting an enhanced capital requirement prepared using post-loss data within 45 days.  Furthermore, where a notification has been made to the Authority regarding a material change, the principal representative has 30 days from the date of such notification to furnish the Authority with unaudited interim statutory financial statements in relation to such period as the Authority may require, together with a general business solvency certificate in respect of those statements.
 
Independent Approved Auditor.  Platinum Bermuda must appoint an independent auditor who will annually audit and report on Platinum Bermuda’s financial statements prepared under generally accepted accounting principles or international financial reporting standards (“GAAP financial statements”), statutory financial statements and the statutory financial return of the insurer, each of which, are required to be filed annually with the Authority.  The independent auditor of Platinum Bermuda must be approved by the Authority.  No person having an interest in Platinum Bermuda other than as an insured, and no officer, servant or agent of Platinum Bermuda, shall be eligible for appointment as an approved auditor for Platinum Bermuda and any person appointed as an approved auditor to Platinum Bermuda who subsequently acquires such interest or becomes an officer, servant or agent of that insurer shall cease to be an approved auditor.  If Platinum Bermuda fails to appoint an approved auditor or at any time fails to fill a vacancy for such auditor, the Authority may appoint an approved auditor for Platinum Bermuda and shall fix the remuneration to be paid to the approved auditor within 14 days, if not agreed sooner by the insurer and the auditor.  Platinum Bermuda’s independent auditor is KPMG in Bermuda.
 
Loss Reserve Specialist.  Platinum Bermuda is required to submit an opinion of its approved loss reserve specialist relating to general business with its statutory financial return in respect of its loss and loss expense provisions.  The loss reserve specialist, who will normally be a qualified casualty actuary, must be approved by the Authority.
 
Annual Financial Statements.  Platinum Bermuda must prepare and submit, on an annual basis, GAAP financial statements and statutory financial statements.  The Insurance Act prescribes rules for the preparation and substance of such statutory financial statements (which include, in statutory form, a balance sheet, an income statement, a statement of capital and surplus and notes thereto).  The statutory financial statements include information and analysis regarding premiums, claims, reinsurance and investments of the insurer.  Platinum Bermuda is required to file with the Authority the annual GAAP financial statements and statutory financial statements within four months from the end of the relevant financial year (unless specifically extended).  The statutory financial statements do not form part of the public records maintained by the Authority but the GAAP financial statements are available for public inspection.
 
Annual Statutory Financial Return and Annual Capital and Solvency Return.  Each year, Platinum Bermuda is required to file with the Authority a statutory financial return within four months of the financial year end (unless specifically extended).
 
The statutory financial return for an insurer registered as a Class 4 general business insurer includes, among other things, a report of the approved independent auditor on the statutory financial statements of such insurer, a general business solvency certificate, the statutory financial statements relating to the general business and the opinion of the loss reserve specialist.
 
The solvency certificates must be signed by the principal representative and at least two directors of the insurer who are required to certify, among other matters, whether the minimum solvency margin has been met and whether the insurer complied with the conditions attached to its certificate of registration.  The approved independent auditor is required to state whether in its opinion it was reasonable for the directors to so certify.
 
Where an insurer’s accounts have been audited for any purpose other than compliance with the Insurance Act, a statement to that effect must be filed with the statutory financial return.  The statutory financial return is not available for public inspection.
 
 
- 13 -

 
 
In addition, each year Platinum Bermuda is required to file with the Authority a capital and solvency return within four months of the financial year end (unless specifically extended).  The prescribed form of capital and solvency return comprises the insurer’s Bermuda Solvency Capital Requirement (“BSCR”) model, a schedule of fixed income investments by rating category, a schedule of net loss and loss expense provision by line of business, a schedule of premiums written by line of business, a schedule of risk management, a schedule of fixed income securities, a schedule of commercial insurer’s solvency self assessment (“CISSA”), a schedule of catastrophe risk return, a schedule of loss triangles or reconciliation of net loss reserves and a schedule of eligible capital.  The capital and solvency return is not available for public inspection.
 
Minimum Liquidity Ratio.  The Insurance Act provides a minimum liquidity ratio for general business insurers.  An insurer engaged in general business is required to maintain the value of its relevant assets at not less than 75% of the amount of its relevant liabilities.  Relevant assets include cash and time deposits, quoted investments, unquoted bonds and debentures, first liens on real estate, investment income due and accrued, accounts and premiums receivable and reinsurance balances receivable.  There are certain categories of assets which, unless specifically permitted by the Authority, do not automatically qualify as relevant assets, such as unquoted equity securities, investments in and advances to affiliates and real estate and collateral loans.  The relevant liabilities are total general business insurance reserves and total other liabilities less the aggregate of deferred income tax, sundry liabilities (by interpretation, those not specifically defined) and letters of credit, guarantees and other instruments.
 
Minimum Solvency Margin, Enhanced Capital Requirement and Restrictions on Dividends and Distributions.  Platinum Bermuda must at all times maintain a minimum solvency margin and an enhanced capital requirement in accordance with the provisions of the Insurance Act.
 
The Insurance Act provides that the value of the statutory assets of an insurer must exceed the value of its statutory liabilities by an amount greater than its prescribed minimum solvency margin. As a Class 4 insurer, Platinum Bermuda is required to maintain a minimum solvency margin equal to the greater of (A) $100 million, (B) 50% of net premiums written (being gross premiums written less any premiums ceded by Platinum Bermuda but Platinum Bermuda may not deduct more than 25% of gross premiums when computing net premiums written), and (C) 15% of net discounted aggregate losses and loss expense provisions and other insurance reserves.
 
As a Class 4 insurer, Platinum Bermuda is required to maintain available statutory capital and surplus in an amount that is equal to or exceeds the target capital levels based on enhanced capital requirements (“ECR”) calculated using the BSCR model. The Authority has provided for the use of pre-approved internally developed company models in lieu of the standardized BSCR.  The BSCR model is a risk-based capital model which provides a method for determining an insurer’s capital requirements (statutory capital and surplus) by taking into account the risk characteristics of different aspects of the insurer’s business. The BSCR formulae establish capital requirements for eight categories of risk: fixed income investment risk, equity investment risk, interest rate/liquidity risk, premium risk, reserve risk, credit risk, catastrophe risk and operational risk. For each category, the capital requirement is determined by applying factors to asset, premium, reserve, creditor, probable maximum loss and operation items, with higher factors applied to items with greater underlying risk and lower factors for less risky items.
 
While not specifically referred to in the Insurance Act, the Authority has also established a target capital level (“TCL”) for each Class 4 insurer equal to 120% of its ECR. While a Class 4 insurer is not currently required to maintain its statutory capital and surplus at this level, the TCL serves as an early warning tool for the Authority and failure to maintain statutory capital at least equal to the TCL will likely result in increased regulatory oversight.
 
The BSCR imposes capital requirements on Platinum Bermuda and adds an additional constraint on the amount of dividends that Platinum Bermuda is able to pay without regulatory approval.
 
The Insurance Act mandates certain actions and filings with the Authority if Platinum Bermuda fails to meet and maintain its ECR or solvency margin, including the filing of a written report detailing the circumstances giving rise to the failure and the manner and time within which the insurer intends to rectify the failure.  Platinum Bermuda is prohibited from declaring or paying a dividend if it is in breach of its ECR, solvency margin or minimum liquidity ratio or if the declaration or payment of such dividend would cause such breach.  Where Platinum Bermuda fails to meet its solvency margin or minimum liquidity ratio on the last day of any financial year, it is prohibited from declaring or paying any dividends during the next financial year without the approval of the Authority.  Further, Platinum Bermuda, as a Class 4 insurer, is prohibited from declaring or paying in any financial year dividends of more than 25% of its total statutory capital and surplus (as shown on its previous financial year’s statutory balance sheet) unless it files (at least seven days before payment of such dividends) with the Authority an affidavit stating that it will continue to meet its solvency margin and minimum liquidity ratio.  Platinum Bermuda must obtain the Authority’s prior approval for a reduction by 15% or more of the total statutory capital as set forth in its previous year’s statutory financial statements.  These restrictions on declaring or paying dividends and distributions under the Insurance Act are in addition to those under the Companies Act 1981, which apply to all Bermuda companies.
 
All Bermuda companies must comply with the provisions of the Companies Act 1981 regulating the payment of dividends and making distributions from contributed surplus.  A company may not declare or pay a dividend, or make a distribution out of contributed surplus, if there are reasonable grounds for believing that:  (a) the company is, or would after the payment be, unable to pay its liabilities as they become due or (b) the realizable value of the company’s assets would thereby be less than its liabilities.
 
Supervision and Intervention.  The Authority may appoint an inspector with powers to investigate the affairs of an insurer if the Authority believes that an investigation is required in the interest of the insurer’s policyholders or potential policyholders.  In order to verify or supplement information otherwise provided to the inspector, the Authority may direct an insurer to produce documents or information relating to matters connected with the insurer’s business.
 
If it appears to the Authority that there is a risk of the insurer becoming insolvent, or that it is in breach of the Insurance Act or any conditions imposed upon its registration, the Authority may, among other things, direct the insurer (i) not to take on any new insurance business; (ii) not to vary any insurance contract if the effect would be to increase the insurer’s liabilities; (iii) not to make certain investments; (iv) to realize certain investments; (v) to maintain, or transfer to the custody of a specified bank, certain assets; (vi) not to declare or pay any dividends or other distributions or to restrict the making of such payments; (vii) to limit its premium income; (viii) not to enter into any specified transaction with any specified persons or persons of a specified class; (ix) to provide such written particulars relating to the financial circumstances of the insurer as the Authority thinks fit; (x) to obtain the opinion of a loss reserve specialist and to submit it to the Authority and (xi) to remove a controller or officer.
 
 
- 14 -

 
 
In addition to powers under the Insurance Act to investigate the affairs of an insurer, the Authority may require certain information from an insurer (or certain other persons) to be produced to the Authority.  Further, the Authority has been given powers to assist other regulatory authorities, including foreign insurance regulatory authorities, with their investigations involving insurance and reinsurance companies in Bermuda but subject to restrictions.  For example, the Authority must be satisfied that the assistance being requested is in connection with the discharge of regulatory responsibilities of the foreign regulatory authority.  Further, the Authority must consider whether cooperation is in the public interest.  The grounds for disclosure are limited and the Insurance Act provides for sanctions for breach of the statutory duty of confidentiality.
 
Code of Conduct.  Platinum Bermuda is subject to the Insurance Code of Conduct (the “Code of Conduct”), promulgated by the Authority, which establishes duties and standards that must be complied with by all insurers registered under the Insurance Act, including the procedures and sound principles to be observed by such insurers. Failure to comply with the Code of Conduct will be a factor taken into account by the Authority in determining whether an insurer is conducting its business in a sound and prudent manner as prescribed by the Insurance Act and could result in the Authority exercising its powers of intervention (see “Supervision and Intervention” above) and will be a factor in calculating the operational risk charge applicable in accordance with that insurer’s BSCR model.
 
Group Supervision.  The Authority may, in respect of an insurance group, determine whether it is appropriate for it to be the group supervisor of that group. For purposes of the Insurance Act, an insurance group is defined as a group of companies that conducts exclusively, or mainly, insurance business.  The Authority has determined that it will act as the group supervisor of the Platinum group of companies (the “Platinum Group”) and has designated Platinum Bermuda as the designated insurer.
 
As group supervisor, the Authority performs a number of supervisory functions including (i) coordinating the gathering and dissemination of information which is of importance for the supervisory task of other competent authorities; (ii) carrying out a supervisory review and assessment of the insurance group; (iii) carrying out an assessment of the insurance group’s compliance with the rules on solvency, risk concentration, intra-group  transactions and good governance procedures; (iv) planning and coordinating, through regular meetings (to be held at least annually) with other competent authorities, supervisory activities in respect of the insurance group, both as a going concern and in emergency situations; (v) coordinating any enforcement action that may need to be taken against the insurance group or any of its members; and (vi) planning and coordinating meetings of colleges of supervisors in order to facilitate the carrying out of the functions described above.
 
In carrying out its functions, the Authority may make rules for (i) assessing the financial situation and the solvency position of the insurance group and/or its members; and (ii) to regulate intra-group transactions, risk concentration, governance procedures, risk management and regulatory reporting and disclosure.
 
Certain specified entities may be excluded from group supervision on the application of the designated insurer, or on the Authority’s initiative. Companies may be excluded where (i) the company is situated in a country or territory where there are legal impediments to co-operation and information exchange; (ii) the company’s financial operations would have a negligible impact on the operations of the insurance group; or (iii) inclusion of the company would be inappropriate with respect to the objectives of group supervision.
 
The Authority may withdraw from acting as group supervisor voluntarily following the request of a competent authority from an equivalent jurisdiction, or on the application of a designated insurer. For the purposes of the Insurance Act, a competent authority is a national authority that is legally empowered to supervise insurers and an equivalent jurisdiction is one possessing supervisory standards deemed equivalent by the Authority to those under the Act.
 
Group Solvency and Group Supervision Rules.  The Insurance (Group Supervision) Rules 2011 and the Insurance (Prudential Standards) (Insurance Group Solvency Requirement) Rules 2011 (together, “Group Rules”), summarized below, apply whenever the Authority has been designated as group supervisor.
 
Group Financial Statements. The Platinum Group must prepare and submit, on an annual basis, audited Group GAAP financial statements (as defined below) and group statutory financial statements.
 
The Group Rules prescribe the rules pertaining to the preparation and substance of the group statutory financial statements (which include, in statutory form, a group balance sheet, a group income statement, a group statement of capital and surplus, and notes thereto). Platinum Bermuda is required to file the group statutory financial statements with the Authority within five months of the end of the financial year (unless specifically extended).
 
In addition, the Platinum Group must prepare in each consolidated financial year financial statements which have been prepared under generally accepted accounting principles or international financial reporting standards (“Group GAAP financial statements”). The Group GAAP financial statements must be audited annually by the group’s approved auditor who must prepare an auditor’s report in accordance with generally accepted auditing standards. Platinum Bermuda is required to file with the Authority annually the audited Group GAAP financial statements within five months of the end of the financial year (unless specifically extended). The Group GAAP financial statements are available for public inspection.
 
Group Statutory Financial Return and Annual Capital and Solvency Return. The Platinum Group is required to prepare an annual group statutory financial return which must be submitted to the Authority by the designated insurer within five months of the financial year end (unless specifically extended).
 
The statutory financial return shall include, among other matters, an insurance group business solvency certificate, the opinion of a group actuary, particulars of ceded reinsurance comprising the top ten unaffiliated reinsurers for which the group has the highest recoverable balances, a list of non-insurance financial regulated entities owned by the group and summary details of all adjustments applied to the group financial statements in the form of a reconciliation of amounts reported as total assets, total liabilities, net income and total statutory capital and surplus. The group statutory financial return is not available for public inspection.
 
 
- 15 -

 
 
The Platinum Group must also prepare and submit a group capital and solvency return which comprises the group BSCR model or an approved group internal capital model, along with the returns prescribed in the applicable schedules to the Group Rules.  The group capital and solvency return is submitted by Platinum Bermuda on behalf of the group and, commencing with the 2013 filing, must include a declaration signed by one director and the chief executive and chief risk officers of the Platinum Group declaring that the return fairly represents the financial condition of the Platinum Group in all material respects.  The group capital and solvency return is not available for public inspection.
 
The Group Rules also require that the Platinum Group prepare and file quarterly financial returns no later than end of the months of May for the first quarter, August for the second quarter and November for the third quarter. The quarterly financial returns consist of (i) quarterly unaudited group financial statements for each financial quarter (which must minimally include a balance sheet and income statement and must also be recent and not reflect a financial position that exceeds two months) and (ii) a list and details of material intra-group transactions and risk concentrations, which would also include, among other things, details surrounding reinsurance and retrocession arrangements and the proportion of the group’s exposure covered by internal reinsurance and other risk transfer arrangements.  The group quarterly financial return is not available for public inspection.
 
Fit and Proper Controllers. The Authority maintains supervision over the controllers of all registered insurers in Bermuda.
 
A controller includes (i) the managing director of Platinum Bermuda or Platinum Holdings; (ii) the chief executive of Platinum Bermuda or Platinum Holdings; (iii) a 10%, 20%, 33% or 50% shareholder controller; and, (iv) any person in accordance with whose directions or instructions the directors of Platinum Bermuda or Platinum Holdings are accustomed to act.
 
The definition of shareholder controller is set out in the Insurance Act but generally refers to (i) a person who holds 10% or more of the shares carrying rights to vote at a shareholders’ meeting of the registered insurer or its parent company; or (ii) a person who is entitled to exercise 10% or more of the voting power at any shareholders’ meeting of such registered insurer or its parent company; or (iii) a person who is able to exercise significant influence over the management of the registered insurer or its parent company by virtue of its shareholding or its entitlement to exercise, or control the exercise of, the voting power at any shareholders’ meeting.
 
A shareholder controller that owns 10% or more but less than 20% of the shares as described above is defined as a 10% shareholder controller.
 
A shareholder controller that owns 20% or more but less than 33% of the shares as described above is defined as a 20% shareholder controller.
 
A shareholder controller that owns 33% or more but less than 50% of the shares as described above is defined as a 33% shareholder controller.
 
A shareholder controller that owns 50% or more of the shares as described above is defined as a 50% shareholder controller.
 
Where the shares of the shareholder of a registered insurer, or the shares of its parent company, are traded on a recognized stock exchange, and such person becomes a 10%, 20%, 33% or 50% shareholder controller of the insurer, that person shall, within 45 days, notify the Authority in writing that he has become such a controller.
 
The Authority may file a notice of objection to any person who has become a controller of any description where it appears that such person is, or is no longer, a fit and proper person to be a controller of the registered insurer. Before issuing a notice of objection, the Authority is required to serve upon the person concerned a preliminary written notice stating the Authority’s intention to issue formal notice of objection. Upon receipt of the preliminary written notice, the person served may, within 28 days, file written representations with the Authority which shall be taken into account by the Authority in making its final determination. Any person who continues to be a controller of any description after having received a notice of objection shall be guilty of an offense and shall be liable on summary conviction to a fine of $25,000 (and a continuing fine of $500 per day for each day that the offense is continuing) or, if convicted on indictment, to a fine of $100,000 and/or 2 years in prison.
 
Notification of Material Changes.  Platinum Bermuda, as a registered insurer is required to give notice to the Authority of its intention to effect a material change within the meaning of the Insurance Act. For the purposes of the Insurance Act, the following changes are material: (i) the transfer or acquisition of insurance business being part of a scheme falling under section 25 of the Insurance Act or section 99 of the Companies Act; (ii) the amalgamation with or acquisition of another firm; (iii) engaging in non-insurance business and activities related thereto where such business is not ancillary to its insurance business; and (iv) engaging in unrelated business that is retail business.  Platinum Bermuda as the designated insurer shall be required to give notice to the Authority if any member of the Platinum Group intends to give effect to any material change as defined in paragraphs (ii), (iii) and (iv) above.
 
No registered insurer shall take any steps to give effect to a material change, and no designated insurer shall, subject to the immediately following paragraph, permit any member of its group to take steps to give effect to a material change, unless it has first served notice on the Authority that it intends to effect such material change and before the end of 14 days either the Authority has notified such company in writing that it has no objection to such change or that period has lapsed without the Authority having issued a notice of objection.
 
A designated insurer shall not be required to serve notice of a material change if the member of the group in question is regulated by a competent authority in an equivalent jurisdiction and has within 90 days of the event filed written notice of the material change with the Authority.
 
Before issuing a notice of objection, the Authority is required to serve upon the person concerned a preliminary written notice stating the Authority’s intention to issue formal notice of objection. Upon receipt of the preliminary written notice, the person served may, within 28 days, file written representations with the Authority which shall be taken into account by the Authority in making its final determination.
 
Any insurer or designated insurer who fails to give the required notice or who effects a material change, or allows such material change to be effected, before the prescribed period has elapsed or after having received a notice of objection shall be guilty of an offense. The insurer shall be liable to a fine of $50,000 on summary conviction or $100,000 if convicted on indictment. A designated insurer that is guilty of an offense shall not be liable to criminal proceedings nor be liable to penalties but shall be subject to directions under the Insurance Act.
 
 
- 16 -

 
 
Notification by Registered Person and Designated Insurers of Change of Controllers and Officers.  Platinum Bermuda, as a registered insurer and as the designated insurer in respect of the Platinum Group, is required to give written notice to the Authority of the fact that a person has become, or ceased to be, a controller or officer of Platinum Bermuda or of Platinum Holdings, as the case may be, within 45 days of becoming aware of such fact. An officer in relation to Platinum Bermuda or Platinum Holdings means a director, chief executive or senior executive performing duties of underwriting, actuarial, risk management, compliance, internal audit, finance or investment matters.
 
Any registered insurer that fails to provide a list as required within the prescribed time is guilty of an offense under the Insurance Act and shall be liable on summary conviction to a fine of $50,000; except that a designated insurer who is guilty of such offense shall neither be liable to criminal proceedings nor any penalties but may be subject to directions issued by the Authority.
 
Certain Other Bermuda Law Considerations.  All Bermuda “exempted companies” are exempt from certain Bermuda laws restricting the percentage of share capital that may be held by non-Bermudians.  However,  exempted companies may not participate in certain business transactions, including: (i) the acquisition or holding of land in Bermuda except that required for their business and held by way of lease or tenancy for terms of not more than 50 years or, with the consent of the Minister of Finance, land which is used to provide accommodation or recreational facilities for officers and employees of the Company for a term not exceeding 21 years; (ii) the taking of mortgages on land in Bermuda to secure an amount in excess of $50,000 without the consent of the Minister of Finance; (iii) the acquisition of any bonds or debentures secured by any land in Bermuda, other than certain types of Bermuda government securities or securities issued by Bermuda public authorities or; (iv) the carrying on of business of any kind in Bermuda, except in furtherance of our business carried on outside Bermuda or under license granted by the Minister of Finance.  Generally, it is not permitted without a special license granted by the Minister of Finance to insure Bermuda domestic risks or risks of persons of, in or based in Bermuda although the reinsurance of risks undertaken by any company incorporated in Bermuda and authorized to engage in insurance and reinsurance business is permitted.
 
Although Platinum Holdings and Platinum Bermuda are organized, registered and domiciled in Bermuda, they are classified as a non-resident of Bermuda for exchange control purposes by the Authority.  Pursuant to their non-resident status, Platinum Holdings and Platinum Bermuda may hold any currency (other than Bermuda dollars) and convert that currency into any other currency (other than Bermuda dollars) without restriction.  Platinum Holdings and Platinum Bermuda are permitted to hold Bermuda dollars to the extent necessary to pay their expenses in Bermuda.
 
The Bermuda government actively encourages foreign investment in “exempted” entities like Platinum Holdings that are based in Bermuda but do not operate in competition with local businesses.  As well as having no restrictions on the degree of foreign ownership, Platinum Holdings and Platinum Bermuda are not currently subject to taxes on income or capital gains and they have received an assurance from the Bermuda Minister of Finance that if any legislation is enacted in Bermuda that would impose tax computed on profits or income, or computed on any capital asset, gain or appreciation, or any tax in the nature of estate duty or inheritance tax, then the imposition of any such tax will not be applicable to Platinum Holdings and Platinum Bermuda or any of their respective operations, shares, debentures or other obligations until March 31, 2035.
 
U.S. Regulation
 
Platinum US is organized, licensed and domiciled in the State of Maryland, as a property and casualty insurer, and is licensed, authorized or accredited to write reinsurance in all 50 states of the United States and the District of Columbia.  Although Platinum US is regulated by state insurance departments and applicable state insurance laws in each state where it is licensed, authorized or accredited, the principal insurance regulatory authority of Platinum US is the Maryland Insurance Administration.
 
U.S. Insurance Holding Company Regulation of Platinum Holdings, Platinum Regency and Platinum Finance.  Platinum Holdings and Platinum Regency as the indirect parent companies of Platinum US, and Platinum Finance as the direct parent company of Platinum US, are subject to the insurance holding company laws of Maryland.  These laws generally require an authorized insurer that is a member of a holding company system to register with the Maryland Insurance Administration and to furnish annually financial and other information about the operations of companies within the holding company system.  Generally, all transactions between Platinum US and another company in the holding company system, including sales, loans, reinsurance agreements and service agreements, must be fair and reasonable and, if material or of a specified category, require prior notice and approval or non-disapproval by the Maryland Insurance Commissioner (the “Commissioner”).
 
The insurance laws of Maryland prohibit any person from acquiring control of Platinum Holdings, Platinum Regency, Platinum Finance or Platinum US unless that person has filed a notification with specified information with the Commissioner and has obtained the Commissioner’s prior approval.  Under the Maryland statutes, acquiring 10% or more of the voting securities of an insurance company or its parent company is presumptively considered an acquisition of control of the insurance company, although such presumption may be rebutted.  Accordingly, any person or entity that acquires, directly or indirectly, 10% or more of the voting securities of Platinum Holdings without the prior approval of the Commissioner will be in violation of these laws and may be subject to injunctive action requiring the disposition or seizure of those securities by the Commissioner or prohibiting the voting of those securities, or to other actions that may be taken by the Commissioner.  In addition, many U.S. state insurance laws require prior notification to state insurance departments of an acquisition of control of a non-domiciliary insurance company doing business in that state.  While these pre-notification statutes do not authorize the state insurance departments to disapprove the acquisition of control, they authorize regulatory action in the affected state if particular conditions exist, such as undue market concentration.  In addition, any transactions that would constitute an acquisition of control of Platinum Holdings, Platinum Regency or Platinum Finance may require prior notification in those states that have adopted pre-acquisition notification laws.  These laws may discourage potential acquisition proposals and may delay, deter or prevent an acquisition of control of Platinum Holdings (in particular through an unsolicited transaction), even if the shareholders of Platinum Holdings might consider such transaction to be desirable.
 
U.S. Insurance Regulation of Platinum US.  The rates, forms, terms and conditions of our reinsurance agreements generally are not subject to regulation by any state insurance department in the United States.  This contrasts with primary insurance where the policy forms and premium rates are generally closely regulated by state insurance departments.
 
 
- 17 -

 
 
State insurance authorities have broad administrative powers with respect to various aspects of the reinsurance business, including licensing to transact business, admittance of assets, establishing reserve requirements and solvency standards, and regulating investments and dividends.  State insurance laws and regulations require Platinum US to file statutory basis financial statements with insurance departments in each state where it is licensed, authorized or accredited to do business.  The operations of Platinum US are subject to examination by those state insurance departments at any time.  Platinum US prepares and files statutory basis financial statements in accordance with accounting practices prescribed or permitted by these insurance departments.  State insurance departments conduct periodic examinations of the books and records of insurance companies domiciled in their states as well as perform market conduct examinations of insurance companies doing business in their states.  State insurance departments generally conduct their various examinations at least once every three to five years.  Examinations are generally carried out in cooperation with the insurance departments of other states under guidelines promulgated by the National Association of Insurance Commissioners (“NAIC”).
 
Under Maryland insurance law, Platinum US must notify the Commissioner within five business days after the declaration of any dividend or distribution, other than an extraordinary dividend or extraordinary distribution, and notify the Commissioner at least ten days’ prior to the payment or distribution thereof.  The Commissioner has the right to prevent payment of such a dividend or such a distribution if the Commissioner determines, in the Commissioner’s discretion, that after the payment thereof, the policyholders’ surplus of Platinum US would be inadequate or could cause Platinum US to be in a hazardous financial condition.  Platinum US must give at least 30 days’ prior notice to the Commissioner before paying an extraordinary dividend or making an extraordinary distribution out of earned surplus.  Extraordinary dividends and extraordinary distributions are dividends or distributions which, together with any other dividends and distributions paid during the immediately preceding twelve-month period, would exceed the lesser of:
 
 
(1)
10% of the insurer's statutory policyholders’ surplus (as determined under statutory accounting principles) as of December 31 of the prior year; or
 
 
(2)
the insurer's net investment income excluding realized capital gains (as determined under statutory accounting principles) for the twelve-month period ending on December 31 of the prior year and pro rata distributions of any class of the insurer's securities, plus any amounts of net investment income (subject to the foregoing exclusions) in the three calendar years prior to the preceding year which have not been distributed.
 
The NAIC uses a risk-based capital (“RBC”) model to monitor and regulate the solvency of licensed life, health, and property and casualty insurance and reinsurance companies.  Maryland has adopted the NAIC’s model law.  The RBC calculation is used to measure an insurer’s capital adequacy with respect to: the risk characteristics of the insurer’s premiums written and unpaid losses and LAE, rate of growth and quality of assets, among other measures.  Depending on the results of the RBC calculation, insurers may be subject to varying degrees of regulatory action depending upon the level of their capital inadequacy.
 
The ability of a primary insurer to take credit for the reinsurance purchased from reinsurance companies is a significant component of reinsurance regulation.  Typically, a primary insurer will only enter into a reinsurance agreement if it can obtain credit to its reserves on its statutory basis financial statements for the reinsurance ceded to the reinsurer.  With respect to U.S. domiciled reinsurers that reinsure U.S. insurers, credit is usually granted when the reinsurer is licensed or accredited in the state where the primary insurer is domiciled.  States also generally permit primary insurers to take credit for reinsurance if the reinsurer: (i) is domiciled in a state with a credit for reinsurance law that is substantially similar to the credit for reinsurance law in the primary insurer’s state of domicile, and (ii) meets certain financial requirements.  Credit for reinsurance purchased from a reinsurer that does not meet the foregoing conditions is generally allowed to the extent that such reinsurer secures its obligations with qualified collateral.  Some states impose requirements that make it difficult to become licensed or accredited as a reinsurer.
 
Platinum Bermuda has provided, and may in the future provide, reinsurance to Platinum US in the normal course of business.  Platinum Bermuda is not licensed, accredited or approved in any state in the United States and, consequently, Platinum Bermuda must collateralize its obligations to Platinum US in order for Platinum US to obtain credit to its reserves on its statutory basis financial statements.
 
The Dodd-Frank Wall Street Reform and Consumer Protection Act of 2010 (the “Dodd-Frank Act”), which became effective on July 21, 2011, provides that only the state in which a primary insurer is domiciled may regulate the financial statement credit for reinsurance taken by that primary insurer; other states are no longer able to require additional collateral from unauthorized reinsurers or otherwise impose their own credit for reinsurance laws on primary insurers that are only licensed in such other states.
 
The Dodd-Frank Act also created the Federal Insurance Office (the “FIO”) within the Department of Treasury headed by a Director appointed by the Treasury Secretary.  Under the Dodd-Frank Act, the Treasury Secretary and U.S. Trade Representative are jointly authorized to enter into certain agreements with foreign governments relating to prudential supervision of the business of insurance or reinsurance.  In implementing such agreements, the FIO has the authority to preempt state law if it is determined that the state law is inconsistent with the international agreement and treats a non-U.S. insurer or reinsurer less favorably than a U.S. insurer or reinsurer.  The FIO’s implementation authority over international agreements could potentially result in the preemption of contrary state law, and this authority might be used to affect reinsurance collateral requirements, to the potential benefit of Platinum Bermuda.  It is unknown whether and when any such changes will occur.
 
In November 2011, the NAIC adopted amendments to its Credit for Reinsurance Model Law and Regulation (the “NAIC Credit for Reinsurance Model Law”) to implement reinsurance collateral reform.  Under the amended NAIC Credit for Reinsurance Model Law, collateral requirements may be reduced for international reinsurers meeting certain criteria as to financial strength and reliability that are domiciled in countries that are found to have strong systems of domestic insurance regulation.  Once a state legislature enacts the amendments to the NAIC Credit for Reinsurance Model Law and the standards become operative in that state, such reinsurers would be eligible to apply for “certified reinsurer” status and reinsurers that become so certified would be permitted to post collateral at reduced levels in that state.  The new collateral levels will apply on a prospective basis only.  Prior to the adoption of the amendments to the NAIC Credit for Reinsurance Model Law, four states (Florida, Indiana, New Jersey and New York) enacted the necessary legislative amendments, building on proposals of the NAIC and the credit for reinsurance provisions in the Dodd-Frank Act.  (Indiana is in the process of developing a regulation with the application requirements, and it is currently accepting applications based on the NAIC Credit for Reinsurance Model Law requirements.)  Nevertheless, any immediate practical effect will be limited, because most states have yet to act, and the changes are not mandatory – any state has the option of retaining a 100% collateralization requirement if it chooses to do so.  It remains to be seen which states will introduce the amendments during their 2012 legislative sessions.  Platinum Bermuda is certified to post reduced collateral in Florida and New York.
 
 
- 18 -

 
 
In December 2010, the NAIC adopted amendments to the Insurance Holding Company System Regulatory Model Act and Regulation (the “Amended Holding Company Model Act”).  The Amended Holding Company Model Act introduces the concept of “enterprise risk” within an insurance holding company system.  If and when adopted by a particular state, the Amended Holding Company Model Act would impose more extensive informational requirements on parents and other affiliates of licensed insurers or reinsurers with the purpose of protecting the licensed companies from enterprise risk, including requiring an annual enterprise risk report by the ultimate controlling person identifying the material risks within the insurance holding company system that could pose enterprise risk to the licensed companies.  The Amended Holding Company Model Act must be adopted by the individual states for the new requirements to apply to U.S. domestic insurers and reinsurers, and specifically in Maryland for the changes to apply to Platinum US.  To date, only three states (Rhode Island, Texas and West Virginia) have enacted legislation adopting the Amended Holding Company Model Act.  It is not clear if and when Maryland or other states will adopt these changes; however, the NAIC is seeking to make the amendments part of its accreditation standards for state solvency regulation, which would motivate states to adopt the amendments promptly.
 
In addition to reinsurance collateral and insurance holding company system reforms, government involvement in the insurance and reinsurance markets, both in the United States and worldwide, continues to evolve.  For example, in 2007, Florida enacted legislation that, among other things, increased the access of primary Florida insurers to the Florida Hurricane Catastrophe Fund (“FHCF”).  The purpose of the FHCF is to maintain insurance capacity in Florida by providing below market rate reinsurance to insurers for a portion of their catastrophic hurricane losses.  The legislation may have the effect of reducing the role of the private reinsurance market in Florida-based risks.  The Florida legislation and any similar state or U.S. federal legislation could have a material adverse impact on our business, financial condition or results of operations.
 
The U.S. federal government generally does not directly regulate the insurance industry except for certain areas of the market, such as insurance for crop, flood, nuclear and terrorism risks.  However, the federal government has undertaken initiatives or considered legislation in several areas that may impact the reinsurance industry, including tort reform, corporate governance and the taxation of reinsurance companies.  In addition, legislation has been introduced from time to time in recent years that, if enacted, could result in the federal government assuming a more direct role in the regulation of the reinsurance industry, including federal licensing in addition to, or in lieu of, state licensing and reinsurance for natural catastrophes.  We are unable to predict whether any legislation will be enacted or any regulations will be adopted, or the effect these developments could have on our business, financial condition or results of operations.
 
Ireland Regulation
 
Platinum Regency is incorporated in Ireland.  As a holding company, Platinum Regency is not subject to Irish insurance regulation.  Irish law prohibits Platinum Regency from declaring a dividend to its shareholders unless it has “profits available for distribution.”  The determination of whether a company has profits available for distribution is based on its accumulated realized profits less its accumulated realized losses.
 
Solvency II
 
The European Union has introduced a new regime for the regulation of the insurance and reinsurance sector known as “Solvency II.”  Solvency II is a principles-based regulatory regime which seeks to promote financial stability, enhance transparency and facilitate harmonization among insurance and reinsurance companies within the European Community (“EC”).  Solvency II is currently expected to be fully implemented on January 1, 2014 subject to agreement on implementation legislation.
 
Solvency II employs a risk-based approach to setting capital requirements for insurers and reinsurers.  One aspect of Solvency II concerns the treatment of reinsurance obtained by EC insurers from reinsurers headquartered in a country outside the EC, including Bermuda and the United States, where our reinsurance subsidiaries are headquartered.  The issue is whether such reinsurance can be taken into account by the EC insurers for capital purposes in the same way as reinsurance obtained from EC reinsurers, or whether the non-EC reinsurers must instead maintain certain minimum credit ratings or provide collateral to the EC insurers.  The Solvency II directive proposes that EC and non-EC reinsurers shall be treated in the same way provided that the non-EC jurisdiction is found to have a regulatory regime “equivalent” to that of Solvency II in that it provides a similar level of policyholder and beneficiary protection with respect to reinsurance, group solvency and group supervision.  In July 2010, a committee of the European Union recommended that Bermuda be included in the first group of countries (along with Japan and Switzerland) that will be assessed for equivalence with Solvency II by the European Commission.  The European Commission has stated that its decision on third country equivalence is likely to be made in the first half of 2013, based on its current timetable.  Transitional arrangements for eligible countries not included in the first group of equivalence assessments, such as the United States, could be adopted as part of a directive that is yet to be proposed by the European Commission.  A country included in the transitional arrangements potentially would be treated as if it were found to have a regulatory regime “equivalent” to Solvency II.

Available Information
 
Our annual reports on Form 10-K, quarterly reports on Form 10-Q, current reports on Form 8-K, and any amendments to those reports, are available free of charge on our Internet website at www.platinumre.com as soon as reasonably practicable after such reports are electronically filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission (the “SEC”).  We also post on our website the charters of our Audit, Compensation, Governance and Executive Committees, our Corporate Governance Guidelines, our Code of Business Conduct and Ethics and any amendments or waivers thereto, and any other corporate governance materials required to be posted by SEC or New York Stock Exchange (“NYSE”) regulations.  These documents are also available in print to any shareholder requesting a copy from our corporate secretary at our principal executive offices.  Information contained on the Platinum Holdings website is not part of this Form 10-K.
 
Item 1A.
Risk Factors
 
Numerous factors could cause our actual results to differ materially from those in the forward-looking statements set forth in this Form 10-K and in other documents that we file with the SEC.  Those factors include the following:
 
 
- 19 -

 
 
Risks Related to Our Business
 
The occurrence of severe catastrophic events could have a material adverse effect on our financial condition or results of operations.
 
We underwrite property and casualty reinsurance and have large aggregate exposures to natural and man-made disasters and, consequently, we expect that our loss experience generally will include infrequent events of great severity.  The frequency and severity of catastrophe losses are inherently difficult to predict, therefore, the occurrence of losses from a severe catastrophe or series of catastrophes could have a material adverse effect on our ability to write new business and on our results of operations and financial condition, possibly to the extent of eliminating our shareholders' equity.  Increases in the values and geographic concentrations of insured property and the effects of inflation have historically resulted in increased severity of industry losses in recent years and, although we seek to limit our overall exposure to risk by limiting the amount of reinsurance we write by geographic zone, we expect that those factors will increase the severity of catastrophe losses in the future.  Global climate change may increase the frequency and severity of losses from hurricanes, tornadoes, windstorms, hailstorms, freezes, floods and other weather-related disasters.
 
If the loss limitation methods and loss and pricing models we employ are not effective, our financial condition or results of operations could be materially adversely affected.
 
Our property and casualty reinsurance contracts cover unpredictable events such as hurricanes, windstorms, hailstorms, earthquakes, volcanic eruptions, fires, industrial explosions, freezes, riots, floods and other natural or man-made disasters.  Underwriting requires significant judgment, involving assumptions about matters that are inherently difficult to predict and beyond our control, and for which historical experience and probability analysis may not provide sufficient guidance.  Reinsurance contracts generally contain limits that restrict the amount that we may be required to pay in the event of a loss.  Our contracts typically contain a per risk limit or an occurrence limit and may contain both.  Some of our contracts contain an aggregate limit.  Property and marine reinsurance contracts with natural catastrophe exposure generally contain occurrence limits.  In addition, our high layer property and marine reinsurance contracts generally contain aggregate limits.  Casualty reinsurance contracts generally contain either a per risk or an occurrence limit.  Casualty clash contracts generally contain an aggregate limit.  Few of our other casualty contracts contain an aggregate limit.  We seek to manage our risk by limiting our estimated probable maximum loss from a catastrophic event in any geographic zone that could be expected to occur once in every 250 years to a specified percentage of total capital.  One or more catastrophic or other events could result in claims that substantially exceed our expectations and could have a material adverse effect on our results of operations and financial condition, possibly to the extent of eliminating our shareholders' equity.
 
We believe that the computer-based loss and pricing models we use to assess each ceding company’s potential for catastrophe losses is an important part of the underwriting process for catastrophe exposure pricing.  However, these models depend on the quality of the information obtained from our ceding companies and the independent data we obtain from third parties and may prove inadequate for determining the pricing for certain catastrophe exposures.  Our models may not accurately predict changes in weather patterns related to climate change or the impact of these changes.  If climate change causes more severe or frequent weather-related disasters than we anticipate, our losses may exceed our expectations, which could have a material adverse effect on our financial condition and results of operations.  Our models include assumptions with respect to the frequency and severity of various sources of loss, including but not limited to damage vulnerability, location of fault lines, demand surge, liquefaction, and tsunami.  If such factors for actual events differ from our assumptions, our losses may exceed our expectations, which could have a material adverse effect on our financial condition and results of operations.
 
For our property and casualty reinsurance underwriting, we depend on the policies, procedures and expertise of ceding companies; these companies may fail to accurately assess the risks they underwrite, which may lead us to inaccurately assess the risks we assume.
 
Because we participate in property and casualty reinsurance markets, the success of our underwriting efforts depends, in part, upon the policies, procedures and expertise of the ceding companies making the original underwriting decisions.  As is common among reinsurers, we do not separately evaluate each of the individual risks assumed under reinsurance treaties.  We face the risk that these ceding companies may fail to accurately assess the risks that they assume initially, which, in turn, may lead us to inaccurately assess the risks we assume.  If we fail to establish and receive appropriate premium rates or fail to contractually limit our exposure to such risks, we could face significant losses on these contracts.
 
If we are required to increase our liabilities for losses and LAE, our operating results may be adversely affected.
 
We establish liabilities for losses and LAE that we are or will be liable to pay for reinsured claims for events that have occurred on or before the balance sheet date.  At any time, these liabilities may prove to be inadequate to cover our actual losses and LAE.  To the extent these liabilities are determined to be insufficient to cover actual losses or LAE, we will have to increase these liabilities and incur a charge to our earnings, which could have a material adverse effect on our financial condition and results of operations.  In accordance with laws, regulations and accounting principles generally accepted in the United States (“U.S. GAAP”), we do not establish liabilities until an event occurs which may give rise to a loss.  Once such an event occurs, liabilities are established based upon estimates of the total losses incurred by the ceding companies and an estimate of the portion of such loss we have reinsured.
 
The liabilities established on our consolidated balance sheet do not represent an exact calculation of liability, but rather are estimates of the expected cost of the ultimate settlement of losses.  We do not separately evaluate each of the individual insurance or reinsurance contracts assumed under our treaties and we are largely dependent on the original underwriting decisions made by ceding companies.  All of our liability estimates are based on actuarial and statistical projections at a given time, facts and circumstances known at that time and estimates of trends in loss severity and other variable factors, including new concepts of liability and general economic conditions.  Changes in these trends or other variable factors could result in claims in excess of the liabilities that we have established.
 
 
- 20 -

 
 
The effects of emerging claim and coverage issues on our business are uncertain.
 
As industry practices and legal, judicial, social and other environmental conditions change, unexpected and unintended issues related to claims and coverage may emerge.  Various provisions of our contracts, such as limitations or exclusions from coverage or choice of forum, may be difficult to enforce in the manner we intend, due to, among other things, disputes relating to coverage and choice of legal forum.  These issues may adversely affect our business by either extending coverage beyond our underwriting intent or by increasing the number or size of claims.  In some instances, these changes may not become apparent until some time after we have issued reinsurance contracts that are affected by the changes.  As a result, the full extent of liability under our reinsurance contracts may not be known for many years after a contract is issued.  The effects of unforeseen developments or substantial government intervention could adversely impact our ability to achieve our goals.  Examples of emerging coverage and claims issues include larger settlements and jury awards against professionals and corporate directors and officers covered by professional liability and directors’ and officers’ liability insurance and whether the substantial losses from hurricanes, including Hurricanes Katrina and Ike, were the result of storm surge, which is sometimes covered by insurance, or flood, which generally is not covered.
 
A downgrade in our financial strength ratings could adversely affect our ability to write new business.
 
Financial strength ratings are used by ceding companies and reinsurance intermediaries to assess the financial strength and quality of reinsurers.  In addition, a ceding company’s own rating may be adversely affected by a downgrade in the rating of its reinsurer.  Therefore, a downgrade of our financial strength rating may dissuade a ceding company from reinsuring with us and may influence a ceding company to reinsure with a competitor that has a higher rating.
 
A.M. Best has assigned a financial strength rating of “A” (Excellent) with a stable outlook to each of our reinsurance subsidiaries.  This rating is the third highest of sixteen rating levels.  According to A.M. Best, a rating of “A” indicates A.M. Best’s opinion that a company has an excellent ability to meet its ongoing obligations to policyholders.  S&P has assigned a financial strength rating of “A-” (Strong) with a stable outlook to each of our reinsurance subsidiaries.  This rating is the seventh highest of twenty-two levels.  According to S&P, a rating of   “A-” indicates S&P’s opinion that an insurer has strong capacity to meet financial commitments, but is somewhat more susceptible to the adverse effects of changes in circumstances and economic conditions than obligors in higher-rated categories.  These ratings are subject to periodic review by A.M. Best and S&P and may be revised downward or revoked at the sole discretion of A.M. Best or S&P.  A.M. Best and S&P may increase their scrutiny of rated companies, revise their rating standards or take other action that could lead to changes in our ratings. If A.M. Best or S&P revise their rating standards associated with our current rating, our rating may be downgraded or we may need to raise additional capital to maintain our rating.
 
Our reinsurance contracts commonly contain terms that would allow a ceding company to cancel the contract or require us to collateralize all or part of our obligations if our financial strength rating was downgraded below a certain rating level.  Whether a client would exercise a cancellation right would depend on, among other factors, the reason for such downgrade, the extent of the downgrade, the prevailing market conditions and the pricing and availability of replacement reinsurance coverage.  Any such cancellation could have a material adverse effect on our financial condition or results of operations.
 
Losses from operations may deplete our capital base and create a need to obtain additional capital that may not be readily available in the capital markets or may only be available on unfavorable terms.
 
Losses from operations, including severe catastrophic events, could cause a material decline in our shareholders’ equity.  We are dependent on our financial strength and ratings, as evaluated by independent rating agencies, to underwrite reinsurance.  A material decline in our existing capital below a level necessary to maintain our ratings may require us to raise additional capital through private financings or the capital markets.  Certain of our contracts provide that a cedant may cancel the contract if there is a decline in our capital below specified levels.  To the extent that our existing capital is insufficient to fund our future operating requirements, we may need to raise additional funds through financings or limit our growth.  Any equity or debt financing, if available at all, may be on terms that are unfavorable to us.  Equity financings could result in dilution to our shareholders.  We may issue securities that have rights, preferences and privileges that are senior to those of our outstanding securities.  If we are not able to obtain adequate capital, our business, results of operations, financial condition and financial strength and credit ratings could be adversely affected.
 
We have exposure to credit loss from counterparties in the normal course of business.
 
We may from time to time collateralize our obligations under our various reinsurance contracts by delivering letters of credit to the ceding company, depositing assets into trust for the benefit of the ceding company or permitting the ceding company to withhold funds that would otherwise be delivered to us under the reinsurance contract.  We have entered into reinsurance contracts with several ceding companies that require us to provide varying levels of collateral for our obligations under certain circumstances, including when our obligations to these ceding companies exceed negotiated amounts.  These amounts may vary depending on our rating from A.M. Best, S&P or other rating agencies and the level of statutory equity of our reinsurance subsidiaries.  The amount of collateral we are required to provide typically represents a portion of the obligations we may owe the ceding company, often including estimates of unpaid losses made by the ceding company.  Since we may be required to provide collateral based on the ceding company’s estimate, we may be obligated to provide collateral that exceeds our estimates of the ultimate liability to the ceding company.  It is also unclear what, if any, the impact would be in the event of the liquidation of a ceding company with which we have a collateral arrangement.
 
Reinsurance premiums receivable from ceding companies are subject to credit risk.  To mitigate credit risk related to reinsurance premiums receivable, we have established standards for ceding companies and, in most cases, have a contractual right of offset thereby allowing us to settle claims net of any such reinsurance premiums receivable.
 
We also have credit exposure with respect to retrocessionaires and certain derivative counterparties.  Our retrocessionaires and counterparties to our derivative contracts may be affected by economic events which could adversely affect their ability to meet their obligations to us.
 
 
- 21 -

 
 
The availability and cost of security arrangements for reinsurance transactions may materially impact our ability to provide reinsurance from Bermuda to insurers domiciled in the United States.
 
Platinum Bermuda is not licensed, approved or accredited as a reinsurer in any state in the United States and, therefore, under the terms of most of its contracts with U.S. ceding companies, it is required to provide collateral to its ceding companies for unpaid liabilities in a form acceptable to applicable state insurance commissioners.  Typically, this type of collateral takes the form of letters of credit issued by a bank, the establishment of a trust, or funds withheld.  We have the ability to issue up to $300.0 million in letters of credit under a three-year syndicated credit facility that consists of a $100.0 million unsecured senior credit facility available for revolving borrowings and letters of credit and a $200.0 million secured senior credit facility available for letters of credit.  We also have the ability to increase the lender commitments by up to $150.0 million subject to the participation of lenders.  Our reinsurance subsidiaries entered into a letter of credit facility in the maximum aggregate amount of $100.0 million that expires on December 31, 2013.  Under the terms of the letter of credit facility, up to $100.0 million is available for the issuance of letters of credit to support reinsurance obligations of our reinsurance subsidiaries. We also have the ability to request a supplemental letter of credit facility for up to $150.0 million subject to agreement with the lender. If these credit facilities are not sufficient or if our lenders fail to perform or if we are unable to renew them or to arrange for other types of security on commercially acceptable terms, Platinum Bermuda’s ability to provide reinsurance to U.S. based clients may be severely limited.
 
The property and casualty reinsurance business is historically cyclical, and we expect to experience periods with excess underwriting capacity and unfavorable pricing.
 
Historically, property and casualty reinsurers have experienced significant fluctuations in operating results.  Demand for reinsurance is influenced significantly by underwriting results of primary insurers and prevailing general economic and market conditions, all of which affect ceding companies’ decisions as to the amount or portion of risk that they retain for their own accounts and consequently reinsurance premium rates.  The supply of reinsurance is related to prevailing prices, the levels of insured losses and levels of industry surplus which, in turn, may fluctuate in response to changes in rates of return on investments being earned in the reinsurance industry and general economic and market conditions.  As a result, the property and casualty reinsurance business historically has been a cyclical industry, characterized by periods of intense price competition due to excessive underwriting capacity as well as periods when shortages of capacity have permitted favorable pricing.  We can expect to experience the effects of such cyclicality.
 
The cyclical trends in the industry and the industry’s profitability can also be affected significantly by volatile and unpredictable developments, including what management believes to be a trend of courts to grant increasingly larger awards for certain damages, natural disasters (such as catastrophic hurricanes, windstorms, tornadoes, earthquakes and floods), acts of terrorism, fluctuations in interest rates, changes in the investment environment that affect market prices of and income and returns on investments and inflationary pressures that may tend to affect the size of losses experienced by primary insurers.  Periods of severe inflation or deflation or prolonged periods of recession may adversely impact our results of operations or financial condition.  Unfavorable market conditions may affect our ability to write reinsurance at rates that we consider appropriate relative to the risk assumed.  If we cannot write property and casualty reinsurance at appropriate rates, our business would be significantly and adversely affected.
 
Increased competition could adversely affect our profitability.
 
The property and casualty reinsurance industry is highly competitive.  Some of our competitors are large financial institutions that have reinsurance operations, while others are specialty reinsurance companies.  Many of our competitors have greater financial, marketing and management resources than we do.  We compete with reinsurers worldwide on the basis of many factors, including premium charges and other terms and conditions offered, services provided, ratings assigned by independent rating agencies, speed of claims payment, claims experience, perceived financial strength and experience and reputation of the reinsurer in the line of reinsurance to be underwritten.  We may not be successful in competing with others on any of these bases, and the intensity of competition in our industry may erode profitability and result in less favorable policy terms and conditions for insurance and reinsurance companies generally, including us.
 
Traditional as well as new capital market participants from time to time produce alternative products (such as reinsurance securitizations, catastrophe bonds and various derivative instruments such as swaps) that may compete with certain types of reinsurance, such as property catastrophe.  Over time, these numerous initiatives could significantly affect supply, pricing and competition in our industry and partially displace our traditional reinsurance products.
 
We could face losses from terrorism, political unrest and war.
 
We have exposure to losses resulting from acts of terrorism, political unrest and acts of war.  It is difficult to predict the occurrence of these events or to estimate the amount of loss an occurrence will generate.  Accordingly, it is possible that actual losses from such an event will exceed our probable maximum loss estimate.  We closely monitor the amount and types of coverage that we provide for terrorism risk under reinsurance treaties.  If we think we can reasonably evaluate the risk of loss and charge an appropriate premium for such risk we will write some terrorism exposure on a stand-alone basis.  Otherwise, we generally seek to exclude terrorism from non-terrorism treaties.  If we cannot exclude terrorism, we will evaluate the risk of loss and attempt to charge an appropriate premium for such risk.  Even in cases where we have deliberately sought to exclude coverage, we may not be able to completely eliminate our exposure to terrorist acts.  Thus, it is possible that these acts will have a material adverse effect on us.
 
We are dependent on the business provided to us by reinsurance brokers and we may be exposed to liability for brokers' failure to make premium payments to us or claim payments to our clients.
 
We market substantially all of our reinsurance products through reinsurance brokers.  The reinsurance brokerage industry generally, and our sources of business specifically, are concentrated.  The loss of business relationships with any of our top brokers could have a material adverse effect on our business.
 
In accordance with industry practice, we frequently pay amounts in respect of claims under contracts to reinsurance brokers for payment to the ceding companies.  In the event that a broker fails to make such a payment, we may remain liable to the ceding company for the payment.  When ceding companies remit premiums to reinsurance brokers, such premiums may be deemed to have been paid to us and the ceding company may no longer be liable to us for those amounts whether or not we actually receive the funds.  Consequently, we assume a degree of credit risk associated with our brokers during the premium and loss settlement process.
 
 
- 22 -

 
 
Catastrophic loss protection may become unavailable to us on acceptable terms.
 
We buy retrocessional reinsurance and use derivative instruments to reduce liability on individual risks, protect against catastrophic losses and obtain additional underwriting capacity.  Catastrophic loss protection capacity may be limited or unavailable or may be available only on terms that we find unacceptable.  If we are unable or unwilling to obtain such protection on acceptable terms, our financial position and results of operations may be materially adversely affected, especially by catastrophic losses.  Elimination of all or portions of our catastrophic loss protection could subject us to increased, and possibly material, exposure to losses or could cause us to underwrite less business.
 
Any retrocessional reinsurance we purchase that is uncollateralized subjects us to credit risk because the ceding of risk to retrocessionaires does not relieve a reinsurer of its liability to the ceding companies.  Therefore, a retrocessionaire’s insolvency or its inability or unwillingness to make payments under the terms of its reinsurance contract with us could have a material adverse effect on us.  Likewise, counterparties to our derivative contracts may be affected by economic events that could adversely affect their ability to meet their obligations to us.
 
Foreign currency exchange rate fluctuation may adversely affect our financial results.
 
We routinely transact business in various currencies other than the U.S. dollar, our financial reporting currency.  Our principal exposure to foreign currency exchange rate risk is the transaction of business in foreign currencies.  We may incur foreign currency exchange gains or losses as we ultimately settle claims required to be paid in foreign currencies.  To the extent we do not seek to hedge our foreign currency risk or our hedges prove ineffective, the resulting impact of a movement in foreign currency exchange rate could materially adversely affect our financial condition and results of operations.

Our success will depend on our ability to maintain and enhance effective operating procedures and internal controls over financial reporting.
 
Our management does not expect that our disclosure controls and procedures or our internal controls over financial reporting will prevent all errors and all fraud. A control system, no matter how well conceived and operated, can provide only reasonable, not absolute, assurance that the objectives of the control system are met. Further, the design of a control system must reflect the fact that there are resource constraints, and the benefits of controls must be considered relative to their costs.  Because of the inherent limitations in all control systems, no evaluation of controls can provide absolute assurance that all control issues and instances of fraud, if any, within the Company have been detected. These inherent limitations include the realities that judgments in decision-making can be faulty, and that breakdowns can occur because of simple error or mistake. Additionally, controls can be circumvented by the individual acts of some persons or by collusion of two or more people. The design of any system of controls also is based in part upon certain assumptions about the likelihood of future events, and there can be no assurance that any design will succeed in achieving its stated goals under all potential future conditions; over time, controls may become inadequate because of changes in conditions, or the degree of compliance with the policies or procedures may deteriorate.  Our disclosure controls and procedures and our internal controls over financial reporting were designed to provide reasonable assurances that their objectives would be met.
 
The preparation of our financial statements requires us to make many estimates and judgments.
 
The preparation of consolidated financial statements requires us to make many estimates and judgments that affect the reported amounts of assets, liabilities (including reserves), revenues and expenses, and related disclosures of contingent liabilities.  On an ongoing basis, we evaluate our estimates, including those related to premiums written and earned, insurance and other reserves, reinsurance recoverable, investment valuations, bad debt, income taxes, contingencies and litigation.  We base our estimates on historical experience, where possible, and on various other assumptions that we believe to be reasonable under the circumstances, which form the basis for our judgments about the carrying values of assets and liabilities that are not readily apparent from other sources. We utilize actuarial models as well as historical insurance industry loss development patterns to establish our initial loss reserves.  Over time, other common reserving methodologies have begun to be employed. Actual claims and claim expenses paid may deviate, perhaps materially, from the reserve estimates reflected in our financial statements.
 
The covenants in our debt and credit facilities limit our financial and operational flexibility, which could have an adverse effect on our financial condition.
 
We have incurred indebtedness, and may incur additional indebtedness in the future.  Our indebtedness primarily consists of publicly traded notes and credit facilities consisting of letter of credit and revolving credit facilities.  For more details on our indebtedness, see Item 7, “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations – Financial Condition – Liquidity,” in this Form 10-K.
 
Our credit facilities contain covenants that limit our ability, among other things, to borrow money, make particular types of investments or other restricted payments, sell assets, merge or consolidate.  The credit facilities also require us to maintain specific financial ratios.  If we fail to comply with these covenants or meet these financial ratios, the lenders under our credit facilities could declare a default and demand immediate repayment of all amounts owed to them, cancel their commitments to lend or issue letters of credit, or both, and require us to pledge additional or a different type of collateral.
 
We could be adversely affected by the loss of one or more key executives, by an inability to retain or replace qualified senior management or by an inability to renew the Bermuda work permits of any of our key executives or other key personnel.  
 
Our success depends on our ability to retain the services of key executives and to attract and retain additional qualified personnel in the future.  Under Bermuda law, non-Bermudians (other than spouses of Bermudians) may not engage in any gainful occupation in Bermuda without the specific permission of the appropriate governmental authority.  None of our executive officers is a Bermudian, and all such officers employed in Bermuda, including our Chief Executive Officer, Chief Financial Officer and the Chief Executive Officer of Platinum Bermuda, are employed pursuant to work permits granted by Bermuda authorities.  These permits expire at various times during the next several years.  The Bermuda government limits the term of work permits to six years, subject to certain exceptions for key employees.  The loss of the services of our key executives or the inability to hire and retain other highly qualified personnel in the future, including as a result of our inability to renew the Bermudian work permits of such individuals, could adversely affect our business plans and strategies or cause us to lose clients.
 
 
- 23 -

 
 
Risks Related to Our Investments
 
Our investment performance may adversely affect our results of operations, financial position and ability to conduct business.  
 
Our operating results depend in part on the performance of our investment portfolio.  Our investments are subject to market-wide risks and fluctuations.  In addition, we are subject to risks inherent in particular securities or types of securities, such as the ability of issuers to repay their debt.  Adverse developments in the financial markets, such as disruptions, uncertainty or volatility in the capital and credit markets, may result in realized and unrealized capital losses that could have a material adverse effect on our results of operations, financial position and ability to conduct business, and may also limit our access to capital required to operate our business.  Severe disruptions in the public debt and equity markets, including, among other things, widening of credit spreads, lack of liquidity and bankruptcies, may result in significant realized and unrealized losses in our investment portfolio.  Depending on market conditions, we could incur additional realized and unrealized losses on our investment portfolio in future periods, which could have a material adverse effect on our results of operations, financial condition and ability to conduct business.
 
Fluctuations in the mortgage-backed and asset-backed securities markets could result in decreases in the fair value of our commercial mortgage-backed, non-agency residential mortgage-backed and asset-backed securities.
 
The commercial mortgage-backed, non-agency residential mortgage-backed and asset-backed securities markets have experienced reductions in liquidity as a result of the recent financial crisis.  When financial markets experience a reduction in liquidity, the ability to conduct orderly transactions may be limited and may result in declines in fair values.  We have significant investments in these asset classes.  As of December 31, 2011, approximately 8% of our total investments were invested in commercial mortgage-backed, non-agency residential mortgage-backed and asset-backed securities.  The fair value, unrealized gain or loss and average rating of our investments in commercial mortgage-backed, non-agency residential mortgage-backed and asset-backed securities is set forth in Item 7, “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations - Financial Condition,” in this Form 10-K.  Decreases in the fair value of our commercial mortgage-backed, non-agency residential mortgage-backed and asset-backed securities could have a material adverse effect on our financial condition and results of operations.
 
Changes in market interest rates could have a material adverse effect on our investment portfolio, investment income and results of operations.
 
Our principal invested assets are fixed maturity securities.  Increasing market interest rates reduce the value of our fixed maturity securities, and we may realize a loss if we sell fixed maturity securities whose value has fallen below their amortized cost prior to maturity.  Declining market interest rates can have the effect of reducing our investment income, as we invest proceeds from positive cash flows from operations and reinvest proceeds from maturing and called investments in new lower-yielding investments.  Interest rates are highly sensitive to many factors, including governmental monetary policies, domestic and international economic and political conditions and other factors beyond our control.  We may use derivative instruments to reduce potential material adverse effects of interest rate changes on our investment portfolio.  Any measures we take that are intended to manage the risks of operating in a changing interest rate environment may not effectively mitigate such interest rate sensitivity.  Accordingly, changes in interest rates could have a material adverse effect on our investment portfolio, investment income and results of operations and financial condition.
 
Concentration in any particular industry, asset class or geographic region may adversely affect our investment portfolio.
 
Concentration of our investment portfolio in any particular industry, asset class or geographic region may have a material adverse effect on our investment portfolio, financial condition and results of operations.  While we seek to mitigate this risk by having a broadly diversified portfolio, events or developments that have a negative effect on any particular industry, asset class or geographic region may have a greater adverse effect on our investment portfolio to the extent that the portfolio is concentrated rather than diversified at certain periods of time.  Further, the ability to sell such investments may be limited if other market participants are seeking to sell similar investments at the same time.
 
Risks Related to Taxation
 
The imposition of U.S. corporate income tax on Platinum Holdings and its non-U.S. subsidiaries could adversely affect our results of operations.
 
We believe that Platinum Holdings, Platinum Bermuda, Platinum UK Services Company Limited and Platinum Regency each operate in such a manner that none of these companies should be subject to U.S. corporate income tax because they are not engaged in a trade or business in the United States.  Nevertheless, because definitive identification of activities that constitute being engaged in a trade or business in the United States has not been established by the tax authorities, the U.S. Internal Revenue Service (the “IRS”) may successfully assert that any of these companies is engaged in a trade or business in the United States, or, if applicable, engaged in a trade or business in the United States through a permanent establishment.  If any of these companies were characterized as being so engaged, such company would be subject to U.S. tax at regular corporate rates on its income that is effectively connected (“ECI”) with its U.S. trade or business, plus an additional 30% “branch profits” tax on its dividend equivalent amount (generally ECI with certain adjustments) deemed withdrawn from the United States.  Any such tax could materially adversely affect our results of operations.
 
U.S. Persons who hold our shares will be subject to adverse U.S. federal income tax consequences if we are considered to be a passive foreign investment company for U.S. federal income tax purposes.
 
The term “U.S. Person” means:  (i) an individual citizen or resident of the United States, (ii) a partnership or corporation, created or organized in or under the laws of the United States, or organized under the laws of any State thereof (including the District of Columbia), (iii) an estate, the income of which is subject to U.S. federal income taxation regardless of its source, (iv) a trust if either a court within the United States is able to exercise primary supervision over the administration of such trust and one or more U.S. Persons have the authority to control all substantial decisions of such trust, or the trust has a valid election in effect to be treated as a U.S. Person for U.S. federal income tax purposes or (v) any other person or entity that is treated for U.S. federal income tax purposes as if it were one of the foregoing.
 
 
- 24 -

 
 
If Platinum Holdings is considered a passive foreign investment company (“PFIC”) for U.S. federal income tax purposes, a U.S. Person who owns directly or, in some cases, indirectly (e.g., through a non-U.S. partnership) any of our shares will be subject to adverse U.S. federal income tax consequences including subjecting the investor to a greater tax liability than might otherwise apply and subjecting the investor to tax on amounts in advance of when tax would otherwise be imposed.  In addition, if we were considered a PFIC, upon the death of any U.S. individual owning shares, such individual's heirs or estate would not be entitled to a “step-up” in the basis of the shares that might otherwise be available under U.S. federal income tax laws.  Although there is an exception for purposes of the PFIC rules for non-U.S. insurance companies predominantly engaged in the active conduct of an insurance business, there are currently no regulations regarding the application of the PFIC provisions to an insurance company and there is no other guidance to explain what constitutes the “active conduct of an insurance business for U.S. federal income tax purposes.”  New regulations or pronouncements interpreting or clarifying these rules may be forthcoming.  We believe we should not be characterized as a PFIC; however, we cannot assure an investor that we will not be characterized as a PFIC for U.S. federal income tax purposes.  If we are considered a PFIC, it could have material adverse tax consequences for an investor that is subject to U.S. federal income taxation.
 
Under certain circumstances, a U.S. person may be required to pay taxes on its pro rata share of the related person insurance income of Platinum Bermuda.
 
If (i) U.S. Persons are treated as owning 25% or more of our shares, (ii) the related person insurance income (“RPII”) of Platinum Bermuda were to equal or exceed 20% of the gross insurance income of Platinum Bermuda in any taxable year, and (iii) direct or indirect insureds (and persons related to such insureds) own (or are treated as owning) 20% or more of the voting power or value of the shares of Platinum Bermuda, a U.S. Person who owns our shares directly, or indirectly through non-U.S. entities, on the last day of the taxable year would be required to include in its income for U.S. federal income tax purposes the shareholder's pro rata share of the RPII of Platinum Bermuda for the entire taxable year, determined as if such RPII were distributed proportionately to such U.S. Persons at that date regardless of whether such income is distributed.  RPII generally represents premium and related investment income from the direct or indirect insurance or reinsurance of any direct or indirect U.S. holder of our shares or any person related to such holder.  In addition, any RPII that is includible in the income of a U.S. tax-exempt organization generally will be treated as unrelated business taxable income.  The amount of RPII earned by Platinum Bermuda will depend on a number of factors, including the geographic distribution of the business of Platinum Bermuda and the identity of persons directly or indirectly insured or reinsured by Platinum Bermuda.  Some of the factors which determine the extent of RPII in any period may be beyond the control of Platinum Bermuda.  Although we expect that either (i) the gross RPII of Platinum Bermuda will not exceed 20% of its gross insurance income for the taxable year or (ii) direct or indirect insureds (and persons related to those insureds) will not own directly or indirectly through entities 20% or more of the voting power or value of our shares for the foreseeable future, we cannot be certain that this will be the case because some of the factors which determine the extent of RPII may be beyond our control.
 
U.S. Persons who dispose of our shares may be subject to U.S. federal income taxation at the rates applicable to dividends on all or a portion of their gains, if any.
 
The RPII rules provide that if a U.S. Person disposes of shares in a non-U.S. insurance corporation in which U.S. Persons own 25% or more of the shares (even if the amount of gross RPII is less than 20% of the corporation's gross insurance income and the ownership of its shares by direct or indirect insureds and related persons is less than the 20% threshold), any gain from the disposition will generally be treated as a dividend to the extent of the shareholder's share of the corporation's undistributed earnings and profits that were accumulated during the period that the shareholder owned the shares (whether or not such earnings and profits are attributable to RPII).  In addition, such a shareholder will be required to comply with certain reporting requirements, regardless of the amount of shares owned by the shareholder.  These RPII rules should not apply to dispositions of our shares because Platinum Holdings will not be directly engaged in the insurance business.  The RPII provisions, however, have never been interpreted by the courts or the U.S. Treasury Department in the form of final regulations.  Regulations interpreting the RPII provisions of the U.S. Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended (the “Code”), exist only in proposed form.  It is not certain whether these proposed regulations will be adopted in their present form or what changes or clarifications might ultimately be made thereto or whether any such changes, as well as any interpretation or application of the RPII rules by the IRS, the courts, or otherwise, might have retroactive effect.
 
Holders of 10% or more of our shares may be subject to U.S. income taxation under the “controlled foreign corporation” rules.
 
A U.S. Person that is a “10% U.S. Shareholder” of a non-U.S. corporation (defined as a U.S. Person who owns or is treated as owning at least 10% of the total combined voting power of all classes of stock entitled to vote of the non-U.S. corporation) that is a controlled foreign corporation (“CFC”) for an uninterrupted period of 30 days or more during a taxable year, that owns shares in the CFC directly, or indirectly through non-U.S. entities, on the last day of the CFC's taxable year, must include in its gross income for U.S. federal income tax purposes its pro rata share of the CFC's “subpart F income,” even if the subpart F income is not distributed.  “Subpart F income” of a non-U.S. insurance corporation typically includes foreign personal holding company income (such as interest, dividends and other types of passive income), as well as insurance and reinsurance income (including underwriting and investment income).  A non-U.S. corporation is considered a CFC if “10% U.S. Shareholders” own (directly, indirectly through non-U.S. entities or by attribution by application of the constructive ownership rules of section 958(b) of the Code (i.e., “constructively”)) more than 50% of the total combined voting power of all classes of stock of that foreign corporation, or the total value of all stock of that foreign corporation.
 
For purposes of taking into account insurance income, a CFC also includes a non-U.S. insurance company in which more than 25% of the total combined voting power of all classes of stock (or more than 25% of the total value of the stock) is owned directly, indirectly through non-U.S. entities or constructively by 10% U.S. Shareholders on any day during the taxable year of such corporation, if the gross amount of premiums or other consideration for the reinsurance or the issuing of insurance or annuity contracts (other than certain insurance or reinsurance related to same country risks written by certain insurance companies not applicable here) exceeds 75% of the gross amount of all premiums or other consideration in respect of all risks.
 
We believe that because of the anticipated dispersion of our share ownership, and provisions in our organizational documents that limit voting power, no U.S. Person should be treated as owning (directly, indirectly through non-U.S. entities or constructively) 10% or more of the total voting power of all classes of our shares.  However, the IRS could successfully challenge the effectiveness of these provisions in our organizational documents.  Accordingly, no assurance can be given that a U.S. Person who owns our shares will not be characterized as a 10% U.S. Shareholder.
 
Changes in U.S. federal income tax law could materially adversely affect an investment in our shares.
 
Legislation was introduced in the U.S. Congress intended to eliminate certain perceived tax advantages of companies (including insurance companies) that have legal domiciles outside the United States but have certain U.S. connections.  For example, legislation was introduced in Congress to limit the deductibility of reinsurance premiums paid by U.S. companies to non-U.S. affiliates.  A similar provision was included as part of the federal budget proposed by the President of the United States for 2012. It is possible that this or similar legislation could be introduced in and enacted by the current Congress or future Congresses that could have a material adverse impact on us or our shareholders.  In addition, existing interpretations of U.S. federal income tax law could change, also resulting in a material adverse impact on us or our shareholders.
 
We may become subject to taxes in Bermuda.
 
We have received a standard assurance from the Minister of Finance, under Bermuda's Exempted Undertakings Tax Protection Act 1966, as amended, that if any legislation is enacted in Bermuda that would impose tax computed on profits or income, or computed on any capital asset, gain or appreciation, or any tax in the nature of estate duty or inheritance tax, then the imposition of any such tax will not be applicable to us or to any of our operations or our shares, debentures or other obligations until March 31, 2035.  Consequently, if our Bermuda tax exemption is not extended past March 31, 2035, we may be subject to any Bermuda tax after that date.
 
 
- 25 -

 
 
Risks Related to Laws and Regulations
 
The regulatory system under which we operate and potential changes thereto could significantly and adversely affect our business.
 
The business of reinsurance is regulated in most countries, although the degree and type of regulation varies significantly from one jurisdiction to another.  Reinsurers are generally subject to less direct regulation than primary insurers.  Reinsurers licensed in the United States and Bermuda are regulated and must comply with financial supervision standards comparable to those governing primary insurers.  For additional discussion of the regulatory requirements to which Platinum Holdings, as a holding company, and its subsidiaries are subject, see Item 1 “Business – Regulation,” in this Form 10-K.  Any failure to comply with applicable laws could result in the imposition of significant restrictions on our ability to do business, and could also result in fines and other sanctions, any or all of which could materially adversely affect our financial condition and results of operations.  In addition, these statutes and regulations may, in effect, restrict the ability of our subsidiaries to write new business or, as indicated below, distribute funds to Platinum Holdings.
 
In recent years, the Bermuda and some U.S. state legislatures have considered or enacted laws that may alter or increase authority to regulate insurance companies and insurance holding companies.  Moreover, the Bermuda and some U.S. state governments, the NAIC and state insurance regulators regularly re-examine existing laws and regulations and interpretations of existing laws and develop new laws.  The new interpretations or laws may be more restrictive or may result in higher costs to us than current statutory requirements.  In addition, the U.S. federal government has undertaken initiatives or considered legislation in several areas that may impact the reinsurance industry, including tort reform, corporate governance and the taxation of reinsurance companies.  The Dodd-Frank Act, which became effective on July 21, 2011, has changed the regulation of reinsurance in the United States, as described below.
 
The European Union has introduced Solvency II, a new regime for the regulation of insurers and reinsurers operating in the EC.  Solvency II is currently expected to be fully implemented on January 1, 2014, subject to agreement on implementation legislation.  The Solvency II directive proposes that reinsurance obtained by EC insurers from reinsurers headquartered in a country outside the EC be treated the same for capital purposes as reinsurance obtained from EC reinsurers, provided that the non-EC country is found to have a regulatory regime “equivalent” to that of Solvency II in terms of policyholder and beneficiary protection.  Our reinsurance subsidiaries are headquartered in Bermuda and the United States, which are non-EC countries.  The European Commission has stated that its decision on third country equivalence is likely to be made in the first half of 2013, based on its current timetable.   The timing of a determination regarding the equivalence of the United States’ regulatory regime is not yet known.  If the regulatory regimes of Bermuda and the United States are found not be equivalent to that of Solvency II and if our reinsurance subsidiaries fall below a certain minimum credit rating, then EC insurers may be prevented from recognizing the reinsurance provided to them by our reinsurance subsidiaries for the purpose of meeting their capital requirements unless we provide collateral for our obligations to EC insurers.  This could have a material adverse impact on our ability to conduct our business.
 
The insurance and reinsurance regulatory framework has become subject to increased scrutiny in many jurisdictions, including the U.S. federal and various state jurisdictions.  In the past, there have been congressional and other proposals in the United States regarding increased supervision and regulation of the insurance industry, including proposals to supervise and regulate reinsurers domiciled outside the United States.  For example, if Platinum Bermuda were to become subject to any insurance laws and regulations of the United States or any U.S. state, which are generally more restrictive than those applicable to it in Bermuda, Platinum Bermuda might be required to post deposits or maintain minimum surplus levels and might be prohibited from engaging in lines of business or from writing specified types of policies or contracts.  Complying with those laws could have a material adverse effect on our ability to conduct our business.
 
Regulatory regimes and changes to accounting rules may adversely impact financial results irrespective of business operations.
 
Accounting standards and regulatory changes may require modifications to our accounting principles, both prospectively and for prior periods and such changes could have an adverse impact on our financial results. In particular, the SEC has formally proposed a plan to first allow and then require companies to file financial statements in accordance with International Financial Reporting Standards rather than U.S. GAAP. Such changes, if ultimately adopted, could have a significant impact on our financial reporting, impacting key matters such as our loss reserving policies and premium and expense recognition. Also, both the Financial Accounting Standards Board (the “FASB”) and the International Accounting Standards Board are considering adopting accounting standards for all reinsurance and insurance contracts that are considered to be more closely related to fair value than the current measurement basis.  We are currently evaluating how these initiatives will impact us, including with respect to our loss reserving policy and the effect it might have on recognizing premium revenue and policy acquisition costs.  Required modification of our existing principles, either with respect to these issues or other issues in the future, could have an impact on our results of operations, including changing the timing of the recognition of underwriting income, increasing the volatility of our reported earnings and changing our overall financial statement presentation.
 
The Dodd-Frank Act may adversely impact our business.
 
The Dodd-Frank Act became effective on July 21, 2011.  In addition to introducing sweeping reform of the U.S. financial services industry, the Dodd-Frank Act has changed the regulation of reinsurance in the United States.  The Dodd-Frank Act prohibits a state from denying credit for reinsurance if the state of domicile of the insurer purchasing the reinsurance recognizes credit for reinsurance.  At present, it appears the changes specific to reinsurance in the Dodd-Frank Act will not have a material adverse effect for non-U.S. reinsurers such as Platinum Bermuda, however, there is still significant uncertainty as to how these and other provisions of the Dodd-Frank Act will be implemented in practice.
 
Platinum Holdings is a holding company and, consequently, its cash flow is dependent on dividends, interest and other permissible payments from its subsidiaries.
 
Platinum Holdings is a holding company that conducts no reinsurance operations of its own.  All operations are conducted by its wholly owned reinsurance subsidiaries, Platinum Bermuda and Platinum US.  As a holding company, Platinum Holdings’ sources of cash flow consists primarily of dividends, interest and other permissible payments from its subsidiaries.  Platinum Holdings depends on such payments for general corporate purposes, for its capital management activities and payment of any dividends to its common shareholders.
 
Additionally, under the Companies Act, Platinum Holdings may not declare or pay a dividend, or make a distribution out of contributed surplus, if there are reasonable grounds for believing that:  (a) the company is, or would after the payment be, unable to pay its liabilities as they become due; or (b) the realizable value of the company’s assets would thereby be less than its liabilities.
 
 
- 26 -

 
 
A shareholder of our Company may have greater difficulty in protecting its interests than as a shareholder of a U.S. corporation.
 
The Companies Act differs in certain material respects from laws generally applicable to U.S. corporations and their shareholders.  These differences include the manner in which directors must disclose transactions in which they have an interest, the rights of shareholders to bring class action and derivative lawsuits and the scope of indemnification available to directors and officers.
 
In addition, a substantial portion of our assets and certain of our officers and directors are or may be located in jurisdictions outside the United States.  It may be difficult for investors to effect service of process within the United States on our directors and officers who reside outside the United States or to enforce against us or our directors and officers judgments of U.S. courts predicated upon civil liability provisions of the U.S. federal securities laws.
 
There are limitations on the ownership, transfer and voting rights of our common shares.
 
Under our Amended and Restated Bye-laws, our directors are required to decline to issue, repurchase, or register any transfer of shares if they determine in their sole discretion that such action may result in a person owning, directly or beneficially, and in some cases indirectly through non-U.S. entities or constructively, 10% or more of the voting power of all our issued shares.  The directors also may refuse to issue, repurchase or register any transfer of shares if they determine in their sole discretion that such action may result in a non-de minimis adverse tax, legal or regulatory consequence.
 
In addition, our Amended and Restated Bye-laws generally provide that any person owning, directly or beneficially, and in some cases indirectly through non-U.S. entities or constructively, shares carrying 9.5% or more of the total voting rights attached to all of our outstanding shares, will have the voting rights attached to such shares reduced so that it may not exercise 9.5% or more of such total voting rights of the shares.  Because of the attribution provisions of the Code and the rules of the SEC regarding determination of beneficial ownership, this requirement may have the effect of reducing the voting rights of a shareholder whether or not such shareholder directly holds 9.5% or more of our shares while other shareholders may have their voting rights increased.  Further, the directors have the authority to require from any shareholder certain information for the purpose of determining whether that shareholder's voting rights are to be reduced.  Failure to respond to such a notice, or submitting incomplete or inaccurate information, gives the directors discretion to disregard all votes attached to that shareholder's shares.
 
The Authority maintains supervision over the controllers of all registered insurers in Bermuda.  Where the shares of the shareholder of a registered insurer, or the shares of its parent company, are traded on a recognized stock exchange, and such person becomes a 10%, 20%, 33% or 50% shareholder controller of the insurer, that person shall, within 45 days, notify the Authority in writing that he has become such a controller.
 
The Authority may file a notice of objection to any person who has become a controller of any description where it appears that such person is, or is no longer, a fit and proper person to be a controller of the registered insurer. Before issuing a notice of objection, the Authority is required to serve upon the person concerned a preliminary written notice stating the Authority’s intention to issue formal notice of objection. Upon receipt of the preliminary written notice, the person served may, within 28 days, file written representations with the Authority which shall be taken into account by the Authority in making their final determination. Any person who continues to be a controller of any description after having received a notice of objection shall be guilty of an offense and shall be liable on summary conviction to a fine of $25,000 (and a continuing fine of $500 per day for each day that the offense is continuing) or, if convicted on indictment, to a fine of $100,000 and/or 2 years in prison.
 
The insurance laws of Maryland, the domiciliary state of Platinum US, prohibit any person from acquiring control of us or of Platinum US unless that person has filed a notification with specified information with the Commissioner and has obtained the Commissioner’s prior approval.  Under the Maryland statutes, acquiring 10% or more of the voting securities of an insurance company or its parent company is presumptively considered an acquisition of control of the insurance company, although such presumption may be rebutted.  Accordingly, any person who acquires, directly or indirectly, 10% or more of the voting securities of Platinum Holdings without the prior approval of the Commissioner will be in violation of this law and may be subject to injunctive action requiring the disposition or seizure of those securities by the Commissioner or prohibiting the voting of those securities and to other actions determined by the Commissioner.  In addition, many U.S. state insurance laws require prior notification of state insurance departments of an acquisition of control of a non-domiciliary insurance company doing business in that state.  While these pre-notification statutes do not authorize the state insurance departments to disapprove the acquisition of control, they authorize regulatory action in the affected state if particular conditions exist such as undue market concentration.  In addition, any transactions that would constitute an acquisition of control of us or Platinum US may require prior notification in those states that have adopted pre-acquisition notification laws.
 
Common shares may be offered or sold in Bermuda only in compliance with the provisions of the Investment Business Act 2003 of Bermuda.  In addition, sales of common shares to persons resident in Bermuda for Bermuda exchange control purposes may require the prior approval of the Authority.  Consent under the Exchange Control Act 1972 of Bermuda (and its related regulations) has been obtained from the Authority for the issue and transfer of the common shares between non-residents of Bermuda for exchange control purposes, provided our shares remain listed on an appointed stock exchange, which includes the NYSE.  In giving such consent, neither the Authority nor the Registrar of Companies accepts any responsibility for the financial soundness of any proposal or for the correctness of any of the statements made or opinions expressed herein or therein.
 
The foregoing provisions of our Amended and Restated Bye-laws and legal and regulatory restrictions will have the effect of rendering more difficult or discouraging unsolicited takeover bids from third parties or the removal of incumbent management.
 
Item 1B.
Unresolved Staff Comments
 
None.
 
Item 2.
Properties
 
Platinum Holdings and Platinum Bermuda lease office space in Pembroke, Bermuda, where our principal executive office is located.  Platinum US and Platinum Administrative Services, Inc. are located in office space we lease in New York, New York.  In addition, Platinum US leases office space in Chicago, Illinois and Platinum Administrative Services, Inc. leases office space in Stamford, Connecticut.  Platinum UK Services Company Limited leases office space in London, England.  We renew and enter into new leases in the ordinary course of business and anticipate no difficulty in extending our leases or obtaining comparable office facilities in suitable locations.  We consider our facilities to be adequate for our current needs.
 
Item 3.
Legal Proceedings
 
In the normal course of business, we may become involved in various claims and legal proceedings.  We are not currently aware of any pending or threatened material litigation or arbitration other than in the ordinary course of our reinsurance business.  Estimated losses related to claims arising in the normal course of our reinsurance business, including the anticipated outcome of any pending arbitration or litigation, are included in unpaid losses and LAE in our consolidated balance sheets.
 
 
- 27 -

 
 
Item 4.
Mine Safety Disclosures

Not applicable.
 
 
PART II
 
Item 5.
Market For Registrant’s Common Equity, Related Shareholder Matters and Issuer Purchases of Equity Securities
 
Market Information, Holders and Dividends
 
At January 31, 2012, there were approximately 62 holders of record of our common shares, not including beneficial owners of shares registered in nominee or street name, which are listed on the NYSE under the symbol “PTP”.  On February 14, 2012, the last reported sale price for our common shares on the NYSE was $36.02 per share.  The following table shows the high and low per share trading prices of our common shares during each quarter, as reported on the NYSE for the periods indicated:

     
Price Range of
Common Shares
 
     
High
   
Low
 
Year
             
2011:
             
 
Fourth Quarter
  $ 35.36     $ 27.53  
 
Third Quarter
  $ 35.78     $ 28.05  
 
Second Quarter
  $ 38.94     $ 32.02  
 
First Quarter
  $ 46.42     $ 34.70  
                   
2010:
                 
 
Fourth Quarter
  $ 45.80     $ 42.10  
 
Third Quarter
  $ 44.04     $ 35.63  
 
Second Quarter
  $ 39.28     $ 35.06  
 
First Quarter
  $ 38.89     $ 34.60  

During the years ended December 31, 2011 and 2010, we paid quarterly cash dividends of $0.08 per common share.  Our Board of Directors has declared a dividend for the first quarter of 2012 of $0.08 per common share, payable on March 30, 2012 to shareholders of record at the close of business on March 1, 2012.  The declaration and payment of common share dividends is at the discretion of the Board of Directors and depends upon our results of operations and cash flows, the financial positions and capital requirements of Platinum Bermuda and Platinum US, general business conditions, legal, tax and regulatory restrictions on the payment of dividends and other factors the Board of Directors deems relevant.
 
The laws of the various jurisdictions in which our subsidiaries are organized restrict the ability of our subsidiaries to pay dividends to Platinum Holdings.  See Item 1, “Business – Regulation”, in this Form 10-K.
 
Purchases of Equity Securities by Us
 
The following table summarizes our purchases of our common shares during the three months ended December 31, 2011:

Period
 
Total Number of Shares Purchased
   
Average Price Paid per Share (1)
   
Total Number of Shares Purchased as Part of a Publicly Announced Program (2)
   
Maximum Dollar Value of Shares that May Yet Be Purchased Under the Program
 
October 1, 2011 – October 31, 2011
    959,500     $ 33.50       959,500     $ 205,252,932  
November 1, 2011 – November 30, 2011
    794,588       33.80       794,588       178,398,016  
December 1, 2011 – December 31, 2011
    52,980       33.81       52,980       176,606,995  
Total
    1,807,068     $ 33.64       1,807,068     $ 176,606,995  

 
(1)
Including commissions.
 
(2)
On August 4, 2004, our Board of Directors established a program authorizing the repurchase of our common shares.  Since that date, our Board of Directors has approved increases in the repurchase program from time to time, most recently on February 16, 2011, to result in authority as of such date to repurchase up to a total of $250.0 million of our common shares.
 
 
- 28 -

 
 
Performance Graph
 
The following performance graph compares cumulative total return on our common shares with the cumulative total return on the S&P 500 Composite Stock Price Index (the “S&P 500 Index”) and the S&P 500 Property & Casualty Industry Insurance Group Stock Price Index (the “S&P 500 Property & Casualty Insurance Index”), for the period that commenced December 31, 2006 and ended on December 31, 2011.  The performance graph shows the value as of December 31 of each calendar year of $100 invested on December 31, 2006 in our common shares, the S&P 500 Index, and the S&P 500 Property & Casualty Insurance Index as measured by the last sale price on the last trading day of each such period.
 
Total Return to Shareholders
Comparison of Cumulative Five Year Total Return
 
   
Indexed Returns *
 
   
Years Ended December 31,
 
   
2007
   
2008
   
2009
   
2010
   
2011
 
Platinum Holdings
    116.01       118.82       127.38       150.83       115.47  
S&P 500 Index
    105.49       66.46       84.05       96.71       98.76  
S&P 500 Property & Casualty Insurance Index
    86.80       61.27       68.84       75.19       75.00  
 
* Index value as of December 31, 2006 – $100.00
 
The foregoing performance graph shall not be deemed to be “soliciting material” or “filed” with the SEC or incorporated by reference in any previous or future document filed by the Company with the SEC under the Securities Act or the Exchange Act, except to the extent that the Company specifically incorporates such performance graph by reference in any such document.
 
 
- 29 -

 
 
Item 6.
Selected Financial Data
 
The following table sets forth certain of our selected financial data as of and for the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010, 2009, 2008 and 2007.  Our data as of December 31, 2011 and 2010 and for the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009 were derived from our consolidated financial statements beginning on page F-1 of this Form 10-K.  Our data as of December 31, 2009, 2008 and 2007 and for the years ended December 31, 2008 and 2007 were derived from our audited consolidated financial statements not included in this Form 10-K.  The selected financial data should be read in conjunction with our consolidated financial statements as of December 31, 2011 and 2010 and for each of the years in the three year period ended December 31, 2011 beginning on page F-1 of this Form 10-K, and the related “Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations” beginning on page 31 of this Form 10-K.
 
Five-Year Summary of Selected Financial Data
(in thousands, except per share amounts)

   
As of and for the Years Ended December 31,
 
   
2011
   
2010
   
2009
   
2008
   
2007
 
Statement of Operations Data:
                             
Net premiums written
  $ 651,514     $ 760,589     $ 897,834     $ 1,037,565     $ 1,119,807  
Net premiums earned
    689,452       779,994       937,336       1,114,796       1,173,088  
Net investment income
    125,863       134,385       163,941       186,574       214,222  
Net realized gains (losses) on investments
    3,934       107,791       78,630       57,254       (413 )
Net impairment losses on investments
    (22,370 )     (36,610 )     (17,603 )     (30,686 )     (809 )
Net losses and LAE
    805,437       467,420       478,342       718,233       655,487  
Underwriting expenses
    180,741       203,705       240,806       306,459       294,642  
Net income (loss)
  $ (224,064 )   $ 215,498     $ 383,291     $ 226,240     $ 356,978  
                                         
Basic earnings (loss) per common share
  $ (6.04 )   $ 5.14     $ 7.71     $ 4.38     $ 5.91  
Diluted earnings (loss) per common share
    (6.04 )     4.78       7.33       3.98       5.38  
Dividends declared per common share
  $ 0.32     $ 0.32     $ 0.32     $ 0.32     $ 0.32  
                                         
Balance Sheet Data:
                                       
Total investments and cash
  $ 4,170,044     $ 4,212,498     $ 4,369,649     $ 4,259,939     $ 4,461,503  
Premiums receivable
    159,387       162,682       269,912       307,539       244,360  
Total assets
    4,551,611       4,614,313       5,021,578       4,927,163       5,078,750  
Unpaid losses and LAE
    2,389,614       2,217,378       2,349,336       2,463,506       2,361,038  
Unearned premiums
    121,164       154,975       180,609       218,890       298,498  
Debt obligations
    250,000       250,000       250,000       250,000       250,000  
Shareholders' equity
  $ 1,690,859     $ 1,895,455     $ 2,077,731     $ 1,809,397     $ 1,998,377  
                                         
Common shares outstanding
    35,526       37,758       45,943       47,482       53,780  
Common shares outstanding - diluted
    36,471       40,639       51,643       58,499       64,210  
                                         
Book value per common share
  $ 47.59     $ 50.20     $ 45.22     $ 34.58     $ 34.04  
Fully converted book value per common share
  $ 46.88     $ 47.48     $ 41.58     $ 32.27     $ 32.32  

In presenting the Company's results, management has included certain schedules containing financial measures that are not calculated under standards and rules that comprise U.S. GAAP. Such measures, including segment underwriting income or loss, related underwriting ratios, book value per common share and fully converted book value per common share, are referred to as non-GAAP. These non-GAAP measures may be defined or calculated differently by other companies.  Management believes these measures, which are used to monitor our results of operations, allow for a more complete understanding of the underlying business and are important financial measures to investors, analysts, rating agencies and others who use the Company’s financial information in evaluating the performance of our Company.  These measures should not be viewed as a substitute for those determined in accordance with U.S. GAAP.  Reconciliations of such measures to the most comparable U.S. GAAP figures are included below or are included elsewhere within this Form 10-K in accordance with Regulation G.
 
 
- 30 -

 
 
Reconciliation of Non-GAAP Financial Measures
 
Underwriting Income (Loss)
 
Underwriting income or loss measures the performance of the Company’s underwriting function and consists of net premiums earned less net losses and LAE and net underwriting expenses. Net underwriting expenses include net acquisition expenses and operating costs related to the underwriting segments.  Underwriting income or loss excludes revenues and expenses related to net investment income, net realized gains or losses on investments, net impairment losses on investments, net changes in fair value of derivatives, net foreign exchange gains or losses, corporate expenses not allocated to underwriting segments, interest expense and other revenues and expenses.  The Company believes that underwriting income or losses highlights the profitability of our reinsurance operations.
 
Underwriting Ratios
 
Underwriting ratios are calculated for net losses and LAE, net acquisition expense and net underwriting expense.  The ratios are calculated by dividing the related expense by net earned premiums.  The Company believes that underwriting ratios highlight the profitability of our reinsurance operations.
 
Book Value per Common Share
 
Book value per common share represents total shareholders’ equity divided by the number of common shares outstanding.  Management uses growth in book value per common share as an indicator of the value provided to common shareholders and believes that, over time, book value per common share is a key driver of share price.  The most significant influences on our book value per common share are net income or loss, total investment results and share repurchase activities.
 
Fully Converted Book Value per Common Share
 
Fully converted book value per common share represents total shareholders’ equity, adjusted for the assumed proceeds from exercise of share options, divided by the number of common shares outstanding, adjusted for the assumed exercise or vesting of all outstanding share options and restricted share units.  The following summary sets forth the calculation of book value and fully converted book value per common share for the years ended December 31, 2011 and 2010 ($ and amounts in thousands, except per share amounts):

   
2011
   
2010
 
Shareholders' equity
  $ 1,690,859     $ 1,895,455  
Add: Assumed exercise of share options
    18,925       34,213  
Shareholders' equity - diluted
  $ 1,709,784     $ 1,929,668  
                 
Basic common shares outstanding
    35,526       37,758  
Add: Common share options
    -       1,010  
Add: Management and directors' options
    624       1,081  
Add: Directors' and officers' restricted share units
    321       790  
Diluted common shares outstanding
    36,471       40,639  
                 
Book value per common share
               
Basic book value per common share
  $ 47.59     $ 50.20  
Fully converted book value per common share
  $ 46.88     $ 47.48  

Item 7.
Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations
 
The following discussion and analysis should be read in conjunction with the consolidated financial statements and related notes thereto included in this Form 10-K.  This Form 10-K contains forward-looking statements that involve risks and uncertainties.  Please see the “Note on Forward-Looking Statements” on page 1 of this Form 10-K.  Our consolidated financial statements have been prepared in accordance with U.S. GAAP. Management has included certain schedules containing financial measures that are not calculated under standards and rules that comprise U.S. GAAP, see Item 6. for additional information.
 
Overview
 
At December 31, 2011, our capital resources of $1.9 billion consisted of $1.7 billion of common shareholders’ equity and $250.0 million of debt obligations.  At December 31, 2010, our capital resources of $2.1 billion consisted of $1.9 billion of common shareholders’ equity and $250.0 million of debt obligations.  Our net loss was $224.1 million for the year ended December 31, 2011, and our net income was $215.5 million and $383.3 million for the years ended December 31, 2010 and 2009, respectively.  Net loss for the year ended December 31, 2011 reflects higher than expected major catastrophe activity partially offset by net investment income and net favorable development.  Our net premiums written for the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009 were $651.5 million, $760.6 million, and $897.8 million, respectively.  The decreases in net premiums written were primarily due to the non-renewal of business that fell below our minimum pricing standards.
 
 
- 31 -

 
 
Economic Conditions
 
Periods of moderate economic growth or recession tend not to adversely affect our operations.  Periods of moderate inflation or deflation also tend not to adversely affect our operations.  However, periods of severe inflation or deflation or prolonged periods of recession may adversely impact our results of operations or financial condition.  Management considers the potential impact of economic trends in the estimation process for establishing unpaid losses and LAE and in determining our investment strategies.
 
Reinsurance Industry Conditions and Trends
 
The reinsurance industry has historically been cyclical, characterized by periods of price competition due to excessive underwriting capacity as well as periods of favorable pricing due to shortages of underwriting capacity.  Cyclical trends in the industry and the industry’s profitability can also be significantly affected by volatile developments, including natural and other catastrophes.  Property and casualty reinsurance rates often rise in the aftermath of significant catastrophe losses.  To the extent that actual claim liabilities are higher than anticipated, the industry’s capacity to write new business diminishes.  The reinsurance industry is also affected by changes in the propensity of courts to expand insurance coverage and grant large liability awards.  Fluctuations in interest rates, credit spreads, liquidity, inflation and other changes in the economic environment can also affect the fair values of investments and impact the industry’s underwriting capacity.
 
In 2005, an unprecedented level of hurricane losses caused many reinsurers to report significant net losses after which rating agencies imposed higher capital requirements.  Both reinsurers and their clients reassessed their catastrophe pricing parameters and procedures.  The result was an increase in catastrophe pricing, particularly for wind exposures in the United States, in 2006 and the beginning of 2007.  A number of new companies were formed to take advantage of the improved pricing.  The combination of additional capacity and a lack of major catastrophe activity in 2006 and 2007 led to a decline in pricing for catastrophe exposed reinsurance in the second half of 2007.  After initially stabilizing, non-catastrophe pricing weakened in late 2006 and continued to decline through the first half of 2008.  During the second half of 2008, the financial markets experienced significant adverse credit events and a loss of liquidity and the 2008 hurricane season resulted in substantial losses to the insurance and reinsurance industry, which reduced the amount of capital in the insurance industry.  Many reinsurance companies reported strong financial results for 2009 reflecting the absence of major catastrophes and the favorable performance of their investment portfolios during the year.  In 2010, many reinsurance companies performed well, with significant growth in shareholders’ equity, despite increased catastrophe activity.  In 2011, despite an increase in international major catastrophes there was minimal effect on pricing.

Current Outlook
 
We anticipate that 2012 will be characterized by ample capacity for insurance risk and that, despite the recent international catastrophes, risk adjusted pricing will be flat or marginally up in all lines of business that have not recently experienced significant losses.  There have been significant insured losses from various natural catastrophes in Chile, New Zealand, Japan, Australia, the United States and other countries over the past 24 months, which may lead to price increases for certain loss-affected accounts.  In addition, the introduction of catastrophe model revisions that increase the expected loss costs for certain U.S. and European wind events may, over time, ultimately support increases in rates for certain U.S. and European property catastrophe contracts.  However, we believe that reinsurers generally remain well-capitalized and that competitive pressure will keep property catastrophe reinsurance rates from rising significantly absent major events in the insurance or capital markets.  We generally expect property catastrophe exposed reinsurance rates for peak zones and perils will remain reasonably attractive for the balance of the year.  For our U.S. property catastrophe portfolio we deployed somewhat less capacity at January 1, 2012, compared with January 1, 2011, leaving flexibility to expand our writings later in the year if desired.  We intend to reduce our portfolio of international property catastrophe contracts, which we believe carries a lower expected profit margin in light of our current views on the risks inherent in such business.  Nonetheless, we expect that our Property and Marine segment will continue to represent a large proportion of our overall book of business, which could result in significant volatility in our results of operations.
 
In the Casualty segment, we expect insurance and reinsurance capacity to remain abundant for the rest of 2012 constraining the potential for significant improvements in risk adjusted rates.  Despite low interest rates, competition in this segment remains strong and many treaties do not meet our pricing standards. While we expect that select casualty reinsurance contracts may offer adequate returns, the portfolio of business we write in our Casualty segment will likely continue to decrease in 2012 as compared with 2011 unless market conditions improve beyond our current expectations. 
 
Reflecting a continued lack of demand for finite risk covers, we expect to write a relatively small portfolio of business in our Finite Risk segment in 2012.

Absent major events in the insurance or capital markets, we expect relative stability in overall reinsurance rate adequacy in 2012.  We will continue with our strategy of responding to changes in market conditions, underwriting for profitability, not market share.
 
Critical Accounting Estimates
 
The preparation of consolidated financial statements in accordance with U.S. GAAP requires us to make estimates and assumptions that are inherently subjective in nature that affect the reported amounts of assets, liabilities, revenues and expenses, and related disclosures of contingent liabilities.  Actual results may differ materially from these estimates.  Our critical accounting estimates used in the preparation of our consolidated financial statements include premiums written and earned, unpaid losses and LAE, reinsurance recoverable, valuation of investments and income taxes.  In addition, estimates are used to evaluate risk transfer for assumed and ceded reinsurance transactions.
 
 
- 32 -

 
 
Premiums Written and Earned
 
Assumed reinsurance premiums earned are recognized as revenues, net of any ceded premiums for retrocessional coverage purchased.  Both assumed and ceded premiums written are recognized as earned generally on a basis proportionate with the coverage period.  Assumed premiums written not yet recognized as revenue are recorded on the consolidated balance sheets as unearned premiums; ceded premiums written not yet earned are recorded on the consolidated balance sheets as prepaid reinsurance premiums.
 
Due to the nature of reinsurance, ceding companies routinely report and remit premiums subsequent to the contract coverage period.  Consequently, premiums written and receivable include amounts reported and billed by the ceding companies, supplemented by our estimates of premiums that are written but not reported.  In addition, we estimate the unearned portion of the premiums.  Unearned premiums and estimated premiums receivable are estimates based on estimated written premiums and are subject to judgment and uncertainty.  Earned premiums, which are recorded in revenues, are the premiums written less the unearned premiums.  The premium estimation process considers the terms and conditions of the reinsurance contracts and assumes that the contracts will remain in-force until expiration.  The estimation of written premiums could be affected by early cancellation, election of contract provisions for cut-off and return of unearned premiums or other contract disruptions.  The time lag involved in the process of reporting premiums is shorter than the lag in reporting losses.  Premiums are generally reported in full within two years from the inception of the contract.  The potential net impact of changes in premiums earned on the results of operations is reduced by the accrual of losses and acquisition expenses related to such premiums earned.  Any adjustments to written and earned premiums, and the related losses and acquisition expenses, are accounted for as changes in estimates and are reflected in the results of operations in the period in which they are made.   Any adjustments could be material and could significantly impact earnings in the period they are recorded.
 
When estimating premiums written and unearned premiums, we segregate the business into classes by reinsurance subsidiary, by type of coverage and by type of contract (resulting in approximately 62 classes).  Within each class, business is further segregated by the year in which the contract incepted (the “Underwriting Year”), starting with 2002, our first year of operations.  Classes that are similar in both the nature of their business and estimation process may be grouped for purposes of estimating premiums.  Estimates are made for each class or group of classes and Underwriting Year.  Premiums are estimated based on ceding company estimates and our own judgment after considering factors such as:  (1) the ceding company’s historical premium versus projected premium, (2) the ceding company’s history of providing accurate estimates, (3) anticipated changes in the marketplace and the ceding company’s competitive position therein, (4) reported premiums to date and (5) the anticipated impact of proposed underwriting changes.  Estimates of ultimate premium are made by our underwriters for each contract and Underwriting Year.  Management reviews these estimates with our underwriters and actuaries and selects an ultimate premium estimate.  Estimates of premiums written and unearned premiums are based on the selected ultimate premium estimate and the structure of the reinsurance contracts. We evaluate the appropriateness of these estimates in light of the actual premium reported by the ceding companies, information obtained during audits and other information received from ceding companies.
 
The following table sets forth our estimated and reported premiums receivable as of December 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively ($ in thousands):

   
December 31,
 
   
2011
   
2010
 
Estimated premiums receivable
  $ 133,360     $ 141,818  
Reported premiums receivable
    26,027       20,864  
Total premiums receivable
  $ 159,387     $ 162,682  

Estimated premiums receivable at December 31, 2011 was lower than at December 31, 2010 due to a decrease in both the property and marine and casualty business written in 2011 as compared with 2010.
 
As of December 31, 2011, the selected estimates of premiums receivable and unearned premiums were lower than the initial estimates made by our underwriters by $14.6 million or 9.2% and by $5.2 million or 4.3%, respectively. We believe that we reasonably could have made an adjustment of between $0 and $14.6 million for premiums receivable and between $0 and $5.2 million for unearned premiums.  Key factors that affect premium estimates of our underwriters include:  (1) the increased competition and lower rate level in many classes of business that make it difficult for ceding companies to achieve their premium targets, and (2) the lack of a historical track record for some ceding companies writing new programs.
 
Certain of our reinsurance contracts include provisions that adjust premiums based upon the loss experience of the contracts.  We take these provisions into account when determining our estimate of premiums written and unearned premiums.  Reinstatement premiums are the premiums charged for the restoration of the reinsurance limit of a reinsurance contract to its full amount, generally coinciding with the payment by the reinsurer of losses.  These premiums relate to and are earned over the future coverage obtained for the remainder of the contract term.  Any unearned premiums existing at the time a contract limit is exhausted or reinstated is earned immediately.  Additional premiums are premiums that are triggered by losses and are earned immediately.  Premiums written and unearned premiums include estimates of reinstatement premiums and additional premiums based on reinsurance contract provisions and loss experience and rely on the estimates of unpaid losses and LAE.
 
An allowance for uncollectible premiums is established for possible non-payment of premiums receivable, as deemed necessary.  We analyze whether an allowance is deemed necessary based on our historical experience, the general profile of our ceding companies and our ability in most cases to contractually offset premiums receivable against losses and LAE and commission amounts payable to the same parties.
 
 
- 33 -

 
 
Unpaid Losses and Loss Adjustment Expenses
 
Overview
 
Unpaid losses and LAE are estimates of future amounts required to pay losses and LAE for claims under our assumed reinsurance contracts that have occurred at or before the balance sheet date.  Unpaid losses and LAE are estimated based upon information received from ceding companies regarding our liability for unpaid losses and LAE, adjusted for our estimates of losses and LAE for which ceding company reports have not been received, our historical experience for unreported claims and industry experience for unreported claims.  Unpaid losses and LAE include the cost of claims that were reported, but not yet paid, and IBNR.  In addition, we estimate our ULAE reserves based on our administrative costs of managing claims.
 
Our actuaries prepare estimates of our ultimate liability for unpaid losses and LAE based on various actuarial methods including the loss ratio method, the Bornhuetter-Ferguson method and the chain ladder method, which are discussed below.  We believe that the quantitative actuarial methods used to estimate our liabilities are enhanced by management’s professional judgment.  We review the actuarial estimates of our liability and determine our best estimate of the liabilities to record as unpaid losses and LAE in our consolidated financial statements.  We use the same processes and procedures for estimating unpaid losses and LAE for annual and interim periods.
 
We do not establish liabilities for unpaid losses and LAE until the occurrence of an event that may give rise to a loss.  If an event has occurred that we believe will lead to significant losses to us but has not resulted in reported losses before the balance sheet date, we will generally estimate the impact of the event and consider it when estimating our liability for unpaid losses and LAE.  When an event of significant magnitude occurs, such as a property catastrophe event that affects many of our ceding companies, we may establish liabilities specific to such an event.  Estimated ultimate losses related to a catastrophe event may be based on our estimated exposure to an industry loss and may rely on the use of catastrophe modeling software.
 
We receive information from ceding companies regarding our liability for unpaid losses and LAE.  This information varies but typically includes information regarding the ceding company’s paid losses and case reserves and may include a ceding company’s estimate of IBNR.  We may increase or decrease case reserves based on receipt of additional information from the ceding companies.  Adjustments that we make to reported case reserves are generally referred to as “additional case reserves.”
 
Unpaid losses and LAE represent management’s best estimate at a given point in time and are subject to the effects of trends in loss severity and frequency.  These estimates are reviewed regularly and adjusted as experience develops or new information becomes available.  Any adjustments are accounted for as changes in estimates and are reflected in the results of operations in the period in which they are made.  It is possible that the ultimate liability may differ materially from such estimates.
 
The liabilities recorded on our consolidated balance sheets as of December 31, 2011 and 2010 for unpaid losses and LAE were $2.4 billion and $2.2 billion, respectively.  These amounts exclude any amounts we may recover from our retrocessionaires under coverage we purchased for such losses.  We record estimates of amounts we expect to recover from retrocessionaires as assets on the consolidated balance sheets.  The following table sets forth our case reserves, additional case reserves and IBNR by segment as of December 31, 2011 and 2010 ($ in thousands):

   
Property and Marine
   
Casualty
   
Finite Risk
   
Total
 
December 31, 2011
                       
Case reserves
  $ 416,935     $ 391,013     $ 29,086     $ 837,034  
Additional case reserves
    25,455       29,727       2,187       57,369  
IBNR
    367,610       1,092,008       35,593       1,495,211  
Total unpaid losses and LAE
  $ 810,000     $ 1,512,748     $ 66,866     $ 2,389,614  
                                 
December 31, 2010
                               
Case reserves
  $ 241,142     $ 378,017     $ 37,601     $ 656,760  
Additional case reserves
    4,376       10,710       -       15,086  
IBNR
    286,577       1,209,113       49,842       1,545,532  
Total unpaid losses and LAE
  $ 532,095     $ 1,597,840     $ 87,443     $ 2,217,378  

Since we rely on information regarding paid losses, case reserves and sometimes IBNR provided by ceding companies in estimating our ultimate liability for unpaid losses and LAE, we perform certain procedures in order to help determine the completeness and accuracy of such information.  Periodically, management assesses the reporting activities of these ceding companies on the basis of qualitative and quantitative criteria.  These procedures include conferring with ceding companies or brokers on claims matters.  Our claims personnel, or consultants engaged by us, may also conduct periodic audits of our ceding companies to:  (1) review and establish validity of specific claims, (2) determine that case reserves established by the ceding company are reasonable, (3) assure that there is consistency in claim reporting from period to period, and (4) assess the overall claims practices and procedures of the ceding company.  We also monitor the claims handling and reserving practices of ceding companies in order to help establish the reinsurance premium for reinsurance contracts with such ceding companies.
 
 
- 34 -

 
 
Non-Catastrophe Reserves
 
Non-catastrophe reserves were $1.8 billion as of December 31, 2011, representing 75% of our unpaid losses and LAE.  When estimating unpaid losses and LAE, we segregate the business into classes by reinsurance subsidiary, by type of coverage and by type of contract (resulting in approximately 62 classes).  Within each class, the business is further segregated by Underwriting Year, starting with 2002, our first year of operations.
 
Our actuaries calculate multiple point estimates of our liability for losses and LAE using a variety of actuarial methods for many, but not all, of our classes for each Underwriting Year.  We do not believe that these multiple point estimates are or should be considered a range.  Our actuaries consider each class and determine the most appropriate point estimate for each Underwriting Year based on the characteristics of the particular class including:  (1) loss development patterns derived from historical data, (2) the credibility of the selected loss development pattern, (3) the stability of the loss development patterns and (4) the observed loss development of other underwriting years for the same class.  Our actuaries also consider other relevant factors, including:  (1) historical ultimate loss ratios, (2) the presence of individual large losses and (3) known occurrences that have not yet resulted in reported losses.
 
We believe that a review of individual contract information improves the loss estimates for some classes of business.  Our actuaries make their determinations of the most appropriate point estimate of loss for each class based on an evaluation of relevant information and do not ascribe any particular portion of the estimate to a particular factor or consideration.  These estimates are aggregated for review by management and, after approval, are the basis for our liability for unpaid losses and LAE.
 
Generally, estimates of ultimate losses that are not related to a specific event are initially determined based on the loss ratio method applied to each Underwriting Year and to each class of business.  The selected ultimate losses are determined by multiplying the initial expected loss ratio by the earned premium.  The initial expected loss ratios are key inputs that involve management judgment and are based on a variety of factors, including:  (1) contract by contract expected loss ratios developed during our pricing process, (2) our historical loss ratios and combined ratios (loss plus acquisition cost ratios), and (3) when available, updated and appropriately adjusted, loss information from The Travelers Companies, Inc. on business previously underwritten by the reinsurance division of The St. Paul Companies, Inc., (“St. Paul Re”), for the reasons described below.  These judgments take into account management’s view of past, current and future factors that may influence ultimate losses, including:  (1) market conditions, (2) changes in the business underwritten, (3) changes in timing of the emergence of claims and (4) other factors that may influence ultimate loss ratios and losses.
 
Over time, as a greater number of claims are reported, actuarial estimates of IBNR are based on the Bornhuetter-Ferguson and the chain ladder techniques.  The loss development pattern is a key input to these techniques.  The Bornhuetter-Ferguson technique utilizes actual reported losses, a loss development pattern and the initial expected loss ratio to determine an estimate of ultimate losses.  We believe this technique is most appropriate when there are few reported claims and a relatively less stable loss development pattern.  The chain ladder technique utilizes actual reported losses and a loss development pattern to determine an estimate of ultimate losses that is independent of the initial expected ultimate loss ratio and earned premium.  We believe this technique is most appropriate when there are a large number of reported losses with significant statistical credibility and a relatively stable pattern of reported losses.  The determination of when reported losses are sufficient and credible to warrant selection of an ultimate loss ratio different from initial expected loss ratio also requires judgment.  We generally make adjustments for reported loss experience indicating unfavorable variances from initial expected loss ratios sooner than reported loss experience indicating favorable variances.  This is because the reporting of losses in excess of expectations tends to have greater credibility than an absence or lower than expected level of reported losses.
 
While we commenced operations in 2002, the business we write is sufficiently similar to the historical reinsurance business of St. Paul Re such that we review the historical loss experience of this business when we estimate our own initial expected loss ratios and loss development patterns.  Loss development patterns can span more than a decade, therefore, the St. Paul Re data is a valuable supplement to our own and industry data.  The historical experience of St. Paul Re also included information for the administrative costs of managing claims and the related ULAE factors.  In 2010 we conducted a review of our administrative expenses of managing claims that resulted in a $13.2 million reduction of ULAE reserves.
 
Loss development patterns are determined utilizing actuarial analysis, including management’s judgment, and are based on loss development patterns of paid losses and reporting of case reserves to us, as well as industry loss development patterns.  Information that may cause future loss development patterns to differ from historical loss development patterns is considered and reflected in our selected loss development patterns as appropriate.  For property and health coverages these patterns indicate that a substantial portion of the ultimate losses are reported within two to three years after the contract is effective.  Casualty loss development patterns can vary from three years to over twenty years depending on the type of business.
 
In property lines, the loss development patterns are based on historical reported loss data.  For all lines, historical data by effective date and business type is used to determine loss development patterns that reflect each year’s reinsurance contract inception date distribution and the distribution of underlying business written on a losses occurring basis versus on a risk attaching basis.  In marine lines, the loss development patterns are primarily based on historical reported loss data.  Loss development patterns are analyzed for various reinsurance sub-classes and an overall pattern is determined by the mix of business within each Underwriting Year.
 
In the North American casualty excess-of-loss classes, the loss development patterns are primarily based on our historical reported loss data and that of St. Paul Re, both of which are supplemented by industry data from the Reinsurance Association of America (“RAA”) and Insurance Services Offices, Inc. (“ISO”).  Due to the long loss development pattern in general liability, various sources are used to estimate the end of the loss development pattern referred to as the “tail”.  To estimate the tail, we supplement our historical data, and the available St. Paul Re data, with industry data, generally from the RAA.
 
We analyze historical loss development patterns and may adjust them for observed anomalies.  For example, we observed that loss development patterns were much slower in Underwriting Years that were characterized by especially intense competition, known as the “soft market,” particularly in the North American excess-of-loss claims made class.  We believe this is due to multiple year policies written by ceding companies and the deterioration in underwriting standards during these periods.  In determining our loss development patterns for certain classes, we may exclude certain historical data from the soft market years.  However, one of the risks of excluding some of the years is that we could be obscuring trends in loss development patterns.  Our actuaries consider this when determining the credibility of indications that use these patterns.  For certain reinsurance contracts, appropriate historical loss development patterns may be developed from ceding company data or other sources.
 
 
- 35 -

 
 
Catastrophe Reserves
 
Generally, an event causing more than $1 billion of property losses to the insurance industry or $10 million of property losses to the Company is considered and tracked as a major catastrophe.  Unpaid losses and LAE related to major catastrophes were $607.1 million, which represented 25% of our total unpaid losses and LAE as of December 31, 2011.
 
Our underwriters will typically prepare an initial estimate of our ultimate losses for a catastrophe event on a contract-by-contract basis.  This estimate is typically based on the Company’s portfolio modeling, discussions with brokers and clients, market share analysis and a review of the Company’s in-force contracts, as well as claims information and analysis, if any, received from brokers and clients.  Information is typically updated as it becomes available.  Our actuaries and underwriters will also consider a variety of factors, including:  (1) the credibility of ceding company estimates, (2) whether the ceding company estimates include IBNR and (3) whether the ceding company information is current.  After reviewing loss estimates and other information with our underwriters, our actuaries make an estimate of ultimate loss.
 
As losses from catastrophes mature, our actuaries generally consider losses reported to us relative to loss development patterns from prior catastrophe events.  Our estimate of ultimate liability for losses and LAE related to a catastrophe event will generally be based on these development patterns after approximately twelve months following the event.  However, since loss development patterns may be inconsistent between events, for very large catastrophes, such as Hurricane Katrina in 2005, we will generally review information on a contract-by-contract basis for a longer period.  Ultimate losses for a catastrophe event are typically reasonably well known within 12 to 24 months following the event, although ultimate losses from an earthquake may take longer to develop. As of December 31, 2011, the paid and reported losses as a percentage of the current estimated ultimate loss were 6% and 57%, respectively, for the February 2011 earthquake in New Zealand and 28% and 65%, respectively, for the earthquake in Japan.
 
In addition to the February earthquake in New Zealand and the earthquake in Japan, in 2011 we established specific reserves for major catastrophes that included U.S. tornadoes, the June earthquake in New Zealand, Hurricane Irene, flooding in Australia, Thailand and Denmark and Cyclone Yasi.  The U.S. tornadoes included six catastrophe events referred to by Property Claim Services, a division of ISO, as Catastrophes 42, 43, 44, 46, 48, and 53.   In 2010, we established specific reserves for major catastrophes that included the earthquakes in Chile and New Zealand, flooding in Australia, Windstorm Xynthia, and two U.S. catastrophe events referred to by Property Claim Services as Catastrophes 14 and 96.  In 2009, we established specific reserves for major catastrophes that included floods in Ireland (“Irish Floods”), Hailstorm Wolfgang, Winterstorm Klaus and three U.S. catastrophe events referred to by Property Claim Services as Catastrophes 63, 68 and 78.  We also have established specific reserves for catastrophe events in prior years, including Hurricanes Ike and Katrina.
 
Uncertainty of Estimates
 
The ultimate liability for unpaid losses and LAE may vary materially from our current estimates for several reasons.  Our estimates are inherently uncertain because they are affected by factors that are highly dependent on judgment.  There are numerous other factors that add uncertainty to our estimates of losses, the more significant of which include:  (1) our estimates are based on predictions of future developments and estimates of future trends in claim severity and frequency, (2) the reliance that we necessarily place on ceding companies for claims reporting, (3) the associated time lag in reporting losses, (4) the need to estimate an initial expected loss ratio before significant loss experience is reported, (5) the low frequency/high severity nature of some of our business and (6) the varying reserving practices among ceding companies.
 
Our estimates are based on assumptions that historical loss development and trends are reasonably predictive of how losses will develop in the future when reported.  New or updated information or loss data may impact our selection of ultimate loss ratios in subsequent periods.  There are various elements of updated loss data and related information that may result in a materially different estimate of ultimate losses.  The four most significant inputs to our loss estimation process are:  (1) reported losses to date, (2) the initial expected loss ratio, (3) the loss development patterns and (4) earned premiums.
 
The frequency and severity of reported losses relative to anticipated frequency and severity of losses is one of the most influential factors and is largely dependent on the loss experience of our ceding companies.  Reported loss experience is a key input to our loss estimation process and, if loss experience reported in periods subsequent to estimating the ultimate losses are materially greater or less than anticipated, we may adjust the ultimate loss ratio accordingly.  Adjustments to increase or decrease a prior year’s ultimate loss ratio are generally referred to as unfavorable or favorable loss development.
 
The initial expected loss ratios are key inputs to our loss estimation process, are derived from historical data and involve a high degree of judgment.  The selection of the initial expected loss ratios also takes into account management’s view of past, current and future factors that may influence expected ultimate losses.  Because of the high degree of judgment required in establishing initial expected loss ratios, there is uncertainty in the resulting estimates.
 
The loss development patterns are also key inputs to our loss estimation process.  Loss development patterns reflect the time lag between the occurrence and settlement of a loss.  The time lag in reporting can be several years in some cases and may be attributed to a number of reasons, including the time it takes to investigate a claim, delays associated with the litigation process, and the deterioration, in connection with health related claims, in a claimant’s physical condition many years after an accident occurs.  As a predominantly broker market reinsurer for both excess-of-loss and proportional contracts, we are subject to potential additional time lags in the receipt of information as the primary insurer reports to the broker who in turn reports to us.  As of December 31, 2011, we did not have any significant back-log related to our processing of assumed reinsurance information.  All of the foregoing factors can impact the loss development patterns.  A key assumption that our estimates are based on is that past loss development patterns are reasonably predictive of future loss development patterns.  However, it may be difficult to identify differences in business reinsured from Underwriting Year to Underwriting Year and how such differences can affect loss development patterns.  This difficulty adds to uncertainty in estimates that use these patterns.
 
In property classes, there can be additional uncertainty in loss estimation related to large catastrophe events.  With wind events, such as hurricanes, the damage assessment process may take more than a year.  The cost of rebuilding may increase due to supply shortages for construction materials and labor.  In the case of earthquakes, the damage assessment process may take several years to discover structural weaknesses not initially detected in buildings.  The uncertainty inherent in loss estimation is particularly pronounced for casualty coverages, such as umbrella liability, general and product liability, professional liability and automobile liability, where information, such as required medical treatment and costs for bodily injury claims, emerges over time.  In the overall loss estimation process, provisions for economic inflation and changes in the social and legal environment are considered.
 
 
- 36 -

 
 
Changes in estimates of prior years’ earned premiums can also affect prior years’ ultimate losses.  Our actuaries consider factors affecting all key inputs to actuarial techniques when determining the credibility of indications.
 
Unpaid losses and LAE is an estimate that reflects many reasonable possible outcomes.  In the following two sections, we discuss two types of uncertainty with respect to loss estimation.  Under Variability of Outcomes, we discuss how estimates change over time as new information or loss data develops.  Under Sensitivity of Estimates, we demonstrate that alternative reasonable estimates can be made with current information.
 
Variability of Outcomes
 
The liability for unpaid losses and LAE as of the balance sheet date represents management’s best estimate of the ultimate liabilities as of that date.  The actuarial techniques used by our actuaries in estimating our liabilities produces a central estimate of ultimate losses and LAE for each class and underwriting year.  These techniques do not produce a range of reasonably possible outcomes.  For some classes, the ultimate value of the liability for unpaid losses and LAE will not be known for many decades.  We expect that the ultimate value will differ from current estimates as losses are reported and paid and that difference could be material as reported losses reflect the actual emergence of factors that influence claim costs.  We believe, however, that as a greater percentage of losses are reported, the likelihood of material changes to ultimate losses declines.  Each quarter, we re-estimate ultimate losses and LAE and reflect updated information in those estimates.
 
During the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009, we experienced net favorable loss development of $113.0 million, $158.9 million, and $100.8 million, respectively.  This net favorable loss development was attributable primarily to a level of cumulative losses reported to us by our ceding companies that was lower than expected and that, in our judgment, resulted in sufficient credibility in the loss experience to change our previously selected loss ratios and reduce estimated ultimate losses, as discussed further in Item 1, “Business – Unpaid Losses and Loss Adjustment Expenses”, in this Form 10-K.  During 2011, 2010, and 2009, approximately $107.4 million, $145.7 million, and $94.9 million, respectively, of the total net favorable development was attributable to lower reported loss experience than we expected.  Conditions and trends that have affected development of reserves in the past may not necessarily occur in the future.  The factors that may result in differences between our current estimates of loss liability and our ultimate loss liability are set forth above under “Uncertainty of Estimates” in this Form 10-K.
 
Sensitivity of Estimates
 
Initial expected loss ratios and loss development patterns are key inputs to our loss estimation process.  We exercise judgment in establishing key inputs at the beginning of an underwriting year and also as we modify the key inputs, as appropriate, throughout the loss development period.  During the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009, changes in the initial expected loss ratio and the loss development patterns resulted in net favorable loss development of $5.6 million, $13.2 million and $5.9 million, respectively.
 
We have selected the initial expected loss ratio and the loss development patterns for sensitivity analysis.  Ultimate loss estimates for the North American casualty excess-of-loss classes of business, which generally have the longest loss development patterns, have a higher degree of uncertainty than other reserving classes.  IBNR for these classes as of December 31, 2011 was $875.5 million, which was 59% of the total IBNR at that date.  The estimates of unpaid losses and LAE related to North American casualty excess-of-loss classes of business have a higher degree of uncertainty and, consequently, reasonable alternatives to our selected initial expected loss ratios and loss development patterns could vary significantly.  For example,  if we increased the initial expected loss ratio for these classes by 5% from 69% to 74%, we would increase the IBNR for these classes by $50.4 million, which represents approximately 4% of unpaid losses and LAE for these classes as of December 31, 2011, or if we increased the initial expected loss ratio for these classes by 10% from 69% to 79%, we would increase the IBNR for these classes by $107.2 million, which represents approximately 9% of unpaid losses and LAE for these classes as of December 31, 2011.
 
As another example of key assumption sensitivity, if we accelerated the estimated loss development patterns related to North American casualty excess-of-loss classes by 5%, we would decrease the IBNR for these classes by $35.2 million, which represents approximately 3% of unpaid losses and LAE for these classes as of December 31, 2011, or if we accelerated the loss development patterns by 10%, we would decrease the IBNR for these classes by $100.3 million, which is approximately 8% of unpaid losses and LAE for these classes as of December 31, 2011.
 
The sensitivity analysis illustrates how a reasonable alternative assumption could affect the current estimate of our ultimate loss liability.  The sensitivity analysis is not intended to present a range of reasonable possible settlement values in the future.  Actual settlement values could be materially different from the current estimates.  Over time, changes to the initial expected loss ratio and loss development patterns may vary by more than the sensitivity analysis above as new loss information and data emerges.
 
Reinsurance Recoverable
 
In order to limit the effect on our financial condition of large and multiple losses, we may buy retrocessional reinsurance, which is reinsurance for our own account.  Reinsurance recoverable, also referred to as “ceded loss reserves,” includes estimates of the recoveries from our retrocessional reinsurance that arise from unpaid losses from our assumed reinsurance business.  These assets are estimates of future amounts recoverable from retrocessionaires for losses that have occurred at or before the balance sheet date.  Each quarter, after estimating the amount of unpaid losses and LAE, our actuaries review all retrocessional contracts.  The estimate of the amount recoverable is based on the gross incurred loss and the structure of the retrocessional contracts.  In addition, we assess the financial strength of our reinsurers and their willingness and ability to pay our claims.  Based on this assessment, we may record an allowance and reduce the reinsurance recoverable and net earnings. We had reinsurance recoverable on unpaid losses and LAE of $4.0 million and $8.9 million as of December 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively.  There was no valuation allowance recorded on these amounts.
 
Valuation of Investments
 
Fixed maturity securities we own that we may not have the positive intent to hold until maturity are classified as available-for-sale and reported at fair value, with related net unrealized gains or losses excluded from earnings and included in shareholders’ equity as a component of accumulated other comprehensive income or loss, net of deferred taxes.  Fixed maturity securities we own and have the intent to sell prior to maturity, or securities for which we have elected the fair value option attributes of the FASB Accounting Standards Codification (“ASC”) 825, “Financial Instruments” (“ASC 825”), are classified as trading securities.  Trading securities are reported at fair value, with mark-to-market adjustments included in net realized gains and losses on investments and the related deferred income tax included in income tax expense or benefit in the consolidated statements of operations.
 
 
- 37 -

 

Short-term investments are comprised of securities with a maturity of 90 days or greater but one year or less from the date of acquisition.  Our U.S. dollar denominated short-term investments are accounted for as available-for-sale. Our non-U.S. dollar denominated short-term investments are accounted for in accordance with the fair value option attributes of ASC 825 and are classified as trading.
 
The fair value of our fixed maturity securities and short-term investments is based on prices generally obtained from pricing services, which include index providers, pricing vendors and broker-dealers.  Index providers utilize external sources and pricing models to value index-eligible securities across numerous sectors and asset classes.  Pricing vendors collect, edit, maintain, evaluate and model data on a large number of securities utilizing primarily market data and observable inputs.  Broker-dealers value securities through proprietary trading desks primarily based on observable inputs.  As of December 31, 2011, we valued approximately 38% of our investment securities using prices obtained from index providers, 59% using prices obtained from pricing vendors, and 3% using prices obtained from broker-dealers.  The number of prices we obtain per instrument varies based on the type of asset class and particular reporting period.  Prices are generally obtained from multiple sources when a new security is purchased and a pricing source is assigned to the particular security.  A hierarchy is maintained that prioritizes pricing sources based on availability and reliability of information, with preference generally given to prices provided by index providers and pricing vendors.  Pricing providers may be assigned to a particular security based upon the provider’s expertise.  Generally, the initial pricing source selected is consistently used for each reporting period.  We have not adjusted any prices that we have obtained from pricing services.  However, if we determine that a price appears unreasonable, we investigate and assess whether the price should be adjusted.
 
We receive pricing documentation that describes the methodologies used by various pricing services.  The prices we obtain from pricing providers are validated by performing price comparisons against multiple pricing sources for certain securities as may be available, periodic back-testing of sales to the previously reported fair value, an in-depth review of specific securities when evaluating stale prices, large price movements and other factors, as well as other validation procedures and continuously monitoring market data that relates to our investment portfolio.
 
Generally, pricing services determine prices by maximizing the use of observable inputs to determine the fair value measurement.  The inputs used by index providers may include, but are not limited to, benchmark yields, transactional data, broker-dealer quotes, security cash flows and structures, credit ratings, prepayment speeds, loss severities, credit risks and default rates.  The inputs used by pricing vendors may include, but are not limited to, benchmark yields, reported trades, broker-dealer quotes, issuer spreads, bids, offers and industry and economic events.  Broker-dealers value securities through trading desks primarily based on observable inputs.  For further discussion on fair values of investments see “Financial Condition – Liquidity – Sources of Liquidity”.
 
We routinely review our available-for-sale investments to determine whether unrealized losses represent temporary changes in fair value or are the result of an other-than-temporary impairment (“OTTI”).  The process of determining whether a security is other-than-temporarily impaired requires judgment and involves analyzing many factors.  These factors include the overall financial condition of the issuer, the length of time and magnitude of an unrealized loss, specific credit events, the collateral structure and the credit support that may be applicable.
 
In 2009, we adopted additional guidance under FASB ASC 320, “Investments – Debt and Equity Securities” (“ASC 320”).  In accordance with this additional guidance, we recognize the portion of OTTI related to a credit loss in net income and the portion of OTTI related to all other factors in other comprehensive income or loss.  The amount of the credit loss of an impaired debt security is the difference between the amortized cost and the greater of (i) the present value of expected future cash flows and (ii) the fair value of the security.  The effect of adoption resulted in a cumulative adjustment to debt securities that were impaired prior to 2009, net of deferred tax, of $14.2 million that was recorded in accumulated other comprehensive income in the consolidated statement of shareholders’ equity. 
 
In accordance with ASC 320, we also consider our intent to sell a security and the likelihood that we will be required to sell a security before an unrealized loss is recovered.  Our intent to sell a security is based, in part, on adverse changes in the creditworthiness of a debt issuer, pricing and other market conditions and our anticipated net cash flows.  If we determine that we intend to sell a security that is in an unrealized loss position, then the unrealized loss related to such a security, representing the difference between the security’s amortized cost and its fair value, is recognized as a net impairment loss in our consolidated statements of operations at the time we determine our intent is to sell.
 
Income Taxes
 
We provide for income taxes for our subsidiaries operating in income tax paying jurisdictions.  We recognize deferred tax assets and liabilities based on the temporary differences between the financial statement carrying amounts and the tax bases of assets and liabilities.  Such temporary differences are primarily due to tax basis discounts on unpaid losses and LAE and unearned premiums, deferred acquisition costs and investments.   A valuation allowance against deferred tax assets is recorded if it is more likely than not that all, or some portion, of the benefits related to deferred tax assets will not be realized.
 
Net deferred tax assets were $31.6 million and $47.8 million for the years ended December 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively.  At each balance sheet date, we evaluate the recoverability of the deferred tax assets, considering the timing of the reversal of deferred income and expense items as well as the likelihood that we will generate sufficient taxable income to realize the future tax benefits.  We believe that it is more likely than not we will generate sufficient taxable income and realize the future tax benefits in order to recover the deferred assets and accordingly, no valuation allowance was established as of December 31, 2011 and 2010.   See Note 8 to the “Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements” contained elsewhere in this Form 10-K for additional information on income taxes. 
 
Risk Transfer for Assumed and Ceded Reinsurance Transactions
 
Reinsurance accounting is used for assumed and ceded transactions when risk transfer requirements have been met.  Risk transfer analysis involves evaluating significant assumptions relating to the amount and timing of expected cash flows, as well as the interpretation of underlying contract terms.  Reinsurance contracts that do not transfer sufficient insurance risk are accounted for as deposits and assets or liabilities are initially recorded for the same amount as assets paid or received.  Interest income or expense related to the deposit is recognized as incurred.  Profit margins are earned over the settlement period of the contractual obligations.  As at December 31, 2011 and 2010, we have deposit liabilities of $9.5 million and $8.8 million, respectively, included in other liabilities related to an assumed transaction that is accounted for as a deposit.
 
 
- 38 -

 
 
Results of Operations
 
Year Ended December 31, 2011 as Compared with the Year Ended December 31, 2010
 
Net income (loss) and diluted earnings (loss) per common share for the years ended December 31, 2011 and 2010 were as follows ($ and amounts in thousands, except diluted earnings (loss) per common share):

   
2011
   
2010
   
Net change
 
Underwriting income (loss)
  $ (296,726 )   $ 108,869     $ (405,595 )
Net investment income
    125,863       134,385       (8,522 )
Net realized gains on investments
    3,934       107,791       (103,857 )
Net impairment losses on investments
    (22,370 )     (36,610 )     14,240  
Other revenues (expenses)
    (37,898 )     (55,783 )     17,885  
Income (loss) before income taxes
    (227,197 )     258,652       (485,849 )
Income tax (expense) benefit
    3,133       (43,154 )     46,287  
Net income (loss)
  $ (224,064 )   $ 215,498     $ (439,562 )
                         
Weighted average shares outstanding for diluted earnings per common share
    36,901       45,052       (8,151 )
Diluted earnings (loss) per common share
  $ (6.04 )   $ 4.78     $ (10.82 )

The net loss and diluted loss per common share for the year ended December 31, 2011 as compared with net income and diluted earnings per common share for the year ended December 31, 2010 was primarily due to a decrease in the net underwriting result attributable to an increase in major catastrophe activity and a decrease in net favorable development.  In addition, there was a decrease in net realized gains on investments and investment income for the year ended December 31, 2011 as compared with the year ended December 31, 2010.  This was partially offset by a decrease in net impairment losses on investments. During a period of loss, the basic weighted average common shares outstanding is used in the denominator of the diluted loss per common share computation.

Underwriting Results
 
Net underwriting loss was $296.7 million for the year ended December 31, 2011 and net underwriting income was $108.9 million for the year ended December 31, 2010.  The change in the net underwriting result was due to an increase in net losses arising from major catastrophes and a decrease in net favorable development in 2011.
 
Net losses arising from major catastrophes were $510.0 million and $214.8 million for the years ended December 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively. Net favorable development was $104.4 million and $151.9 million for the years ended December 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively.  Net favorable or unfavorable development is the development of prior years’ unpaid losses and LAE and the related impact of premiums and commissions.  The net favorable development for the year ended December 31, 2011 relating to prior years was substantially all in the Property and Marine and Casualty segments.
 
We conduct our worldwide reinsurance business through three operating segments: Property and Marine, Casualty and Finite Risk.  In managing our operating segments, we use measures such as underwriting income and loss and underwriting ratios to evaluate segment performance.  Segment underwriting income is reconciled to the U.S. GAAP measure of income or loss before income taxes in Note 11 to the “Consolidated Financial Statements” in this Form 10-K.  The measures we use in evaluating our operating segments should not be used as a substitute for measures determined under U.S. GAAP.
 
Property and Marine
 
The Property and Marine operating segment generated 52.9% and 54.3% of our net premiums written for the years ended December 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively.  The following table summarizes underwriting activity and ratios for the Property and Marine segment for the years ended December 31, 2011 and 2010 ($ in thousands):

   
2011
   
2010
   
Increase (decrease)
 
Gross premiums written
  $ 380,464     $ 431,612     $ (51,148 )
Ceded premiums written
    35,782       18,937       16,845  
Net premiums written
    344,682       412,675       (67,993 )
Net premiums earned
    356,976       418,763       (61,787 )
Net losses and LAE
    628,062       343,509       284,553  
Net acquisition expenses
    49,348       60,224       (10,876 )
Other underwriting expenses
    27,622       32,678       (5,056 )
Property and Marine segment underwriting income (loss)
  $ (348,056 )   $ (17,648 )   $ (330,408 )
                         
Underwriting ratios:
                       
Net loss and LAE
    175.9 %     82.0 %  
93.9 points
 
Net acquisition expense
    13.8 %     14.4 %  
(0.6) points
 
Other underwriting expense
    7.7 %     7.8 %  
(0.1) points
 
Combined
    197.4 %     104.2 %  
93.2 points
 
 
 
- 39 -

 
 
The Property and Marine segment underwriting result decreased by $330.4 million for the year ended December 31, 2011 as compared with the year ended December 31, 2010, primarily due to an increase in net losses arising from major catastrophes.  Net losses arising from major catastrophes, net of reinstatement premiums and retrocessional recoveries, were $510.0 million and $214.8 million for the years ended December 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively.  Net losses from major catastrophes for the year ended December 31, 2011 were attributable to the February and June earthquakes in New Zealand, the earthquake in Japan, U.S. tornadoes, Hurricane Irene, floods in Australia, Thailand and Denmark, and Cyclone Yasi.
 
Gross premiums written decreased by $51.1 million for the year ended December 31, 2011 as compared with the year ended December 31, 2010.  Gross premiums written included reinstatement premiums related to major catastrophes of $30.6 million and $17.7 million for the years ended December 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively.  The decrease in gross premiums written was due to decreases across most classes of business, most significantly in the catastrophe excess-of-loss classes, for the year ended December 31, 2011 as compared with the same period in 2010 and resulted from fewer opportunities that met our underwriting standards and our desire to reduce our exposure to catastrophe events.   The increase in ceded premiums written was due to an increase in our purchase of retrocessional coverage on catastrophe business for the year ended December 31, 2011 as compared with the same period in 2010 that resulted from our desire to reduce our exposure to catastrophe events.  Net premiums earned decreased by $68.0 million for the year ended December 31, 2011 as compared with the same period in 2010, primarily as a result of decreases in net premiums written in current and prior periods.  Net premiums written and earned were also affected by changes in the mix of business and the structure of the underlying reinsurance contracts.
 
Net losses and LAE increased by $284.6 million for the year ended December 31, 2011 as compared with the year ended December 31, 2010, primarily due to an increase in losses arising from major catastrophes.  The following table sets forth the components of pre-tax net losses by major catastrophe for the year ended December 31, 2011 ($ in thousands):

Major Catastrophe
 
Gross Losses and LAE
   
Retrocessional Recoveries
   
Net Losses and LAE
   
Reinstatement Premiums Earned
   
Net Losses from Major Catastrophes
 
February New Zealand earthquake
  $ (221,786 )   $ -     $ (221,786 )   $ 13,255     $ (208,531 )
Japan earthquake
    (182,488 )     35,000       (147,488 )     3,851       (143,637 )
U.S. tornadoes
    (47,289 )     -       (47,289 )     4,288       (43,001 )
June New Zealand earthquake
    (33,675 )     -       (33,675 )     -       (33,675 )
Thailand floods
    (29,694 )     -       (29,694 )     1,068       (28,626 )
Australian floods
    (18,488 )     -       (18,488 )     1,960       (16,528 )
Cyclone Yasi
    (14,353 )     -       (14,353 )     877       (13,476 )
Hurricane Irene
    (13,976 )     -       (13,976 )     1,935       (12,041 )
Denmark floods
    (13,805 )     -       (13,805 )     3,366       (10,439 )
Total
  $ (575,554 )   $ 35,000     $ (540,554 )   $ 30,600     $ (509,954 )

For the year ended December 31, 2010, net losses and LAE arising from major catastrophes of $232.4 million, excluding reinstatement premiums earned of $17.7 million, related primarily to the 2010 earthquakes in Chile and New Zealand.  Net losses and LAE arising from major catastrophes, with related premium adjustments, increased the net loss and LAE ratio by 149.1 points and 54.3 points for the years ended December 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively.
 
Net favorable loss development was $41.4 million and $36.9 million for the years ended December 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively.  Net favorable loss development and related premium adjustments decreased the net loss and LAE ratio by 11.2 points and 9.2 points for the years ended December 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively.  Net favorable loss development for the years ended December 31, 2011 and 2010 was primarily attributable to a level of cumulative losses reported by our ceding companies that was lower than expected and that, in our judgment, resulted in sufficient credibility in the loss experience to change our previously selected loss ratios.
 
The following table sets forth the net favorable (unfavorable) development for the year ended December 31, 2011 by class of business ($ in thousands):

Class of Business
 
Net Losses and LAE
   
Net Acquisition Expense
   
Net Premiums
   
Net Development
 
Major catastrophes
  $ 19,426     $ (10 )   $ (1,035 )   $ 18,381  
Property per risk excess-of-loss
    15,987       328       34       16,349  
Property proportional
    7,769       160       -       7,929  
Crop
    1,947       (164 )     -       1,783  
Marine, aviation and satellite
    822       (359 )     570       1,033  
Catastrophe excess-of-loss (non-major events)
    (4,516 )     (144 )     (317 )     (4,977 )
Total
  $ 41,435     $ (189 )   $ (748 )   $ 40,498  

Net favorable development in the major catastrophes class arose primarily from the February 2010 earthquake in Chile, the September 2010 earthquake in New Zealand and the December 2010 floods in Australia.  Net favorable development in the property per risk excess-of-loss class arose from the 2007 through 2010 underwriting years.  Net favorable development in the property proportional class arose primarily from the 2008 and 2009 underwriting years, with a change in the expected loss ratios contributing $0.7 million of the net favorable development.  Net favorable development in the crop class arose primarily from North American business in the 2010 underwriting year.  Net favorable development in the marine, aviation and satellite class arose primarily from the 2007 and 2008 underwriting years. This was partially offset by unfavorable development in the 2009 underwriting year primarily arising from the loss related to the explosion on the Deepwater Horizon oil rig. Net unfavorable development in the catastrophe excess-of-loss (non-major events) class arose primarily from an increase in loss advices from ceding companies related to fourth quarter 2010 events in Europe and Australia, partially offset by an improvement in North American business and international business prior to 2010.
 
 
- 40 -

 
 
The following table sets forth the net favorable (unfavorable) development for the year ended December 31, 2010 by class of business ($ in thousands):

Class of Business
 
Net Losses and LAE
   
Net Acquisition Expense
   
Net Premiums
   
Net Development
 
Property per risk excess-of-loss
  $ 22,016     $ (149 )   $ 1,133     $ 23,000  
Catastrophe excess-of-loss (non-major events)
    10,057       222       654       10,933  
Crop
    16,914       (4,732 )     -       12,182  
Property proportional
    5,802       (414 )     -       5,388  
Marine, aviation and satellite
    (1,776 )     (361 )     751       (1,386 )
Major catastrophes
    (16,160 )     -       (692 )     (16,852 )
Total
  $ 36,853     $ (5,434 )   $ 1,846     $ 33,265  

Net favorable development in the property per-risk excess-of-loss class arose primarily from the 2007 and 2009 underwriting years.  Net favorable development in the catastrophe excess-of-loss (non-major events) class arose primarily from the 2009 underwriting year.  Net favorable loss development in the crop class arose primarily from North American business in the 2009 underwriting year.  Net favorable development in the property proportional class arose primarily from North American business in the 2005 through 2008 underwriting years.  Net unfavorable development in the marine, aviation and satellite class arose primarily from the 2003 and 2006 underwriting years, partially offset by favorable development primarily from the 2007 and 2008 underwriting years. A change in the pattern of expected reported losses in the marine excess-of-loss class contributed $2.5 million of unfavorable development.  Net unfavorable development in the major catastrophes class arose primarily from Hurricane Ike in the 2008 underwriting year.
 
Net acquisition expenses and related net acquisition expense ratios were $49.3 million and 13.8% , respectively, for the year ended December 31, 2011 and $60.2 million and 14.4%, respectively, for the year ended December 31, 2010.  The decrease in net acquisition expenses was primarily due to the decrease in net premiums earned and a decrease in commissions related to prior years as compared with the same period in 2010.  The decrease in acquisition expense ratio for the year ended December 31, 2011 was primarily due to a decrease in commissions related to prior years as compared with the same period in 2010.   The increase in commissions related to prior years was $0.2 million and $5.4 million for the years ended December 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively.  The commissions related to prior years increased the net acquisition expense ratio by 0.1 points and 1.2 points for the years ended December 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively.  Net acquisition expenses and related net acquisition expense ratios were also affected by changes in the mix of business.
 
Other underwriting expenses were $27.6 million and $32.7 million for the years ended December 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively.  The decrease in 2011 as compared with 2010 was primarily attributable to a decrease in performance-based compensation in 2011.
 
Casualty
 
The Casualty operating segment generated 45.6% and 43.3% of our net premiums written for the years ended December 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively.  The following table summarizes underwriting activity and ratios for the Casualty segment for the years ended December 31, 2011 and 2010 ($ in thousands):

   
2011
   
2010
   
Increase (decrease)
 
Net premiums written
  $ 296,989     $ 329,397     $ (32,408 )
Net premiums earned
    318,734       343,812       (25,078 )
Net losses and LAE
    178,650       119,679       58,971  
Net acquisition expenses
    72,738       71,474       1,264  
Other underwriting expenses
    19,002       23,091       (4,089 )
Casualty segment underwriting income
  $ 48,344     $ 129,568     $ (81,224 )
                         
Underwriting ratios:
                       
Net loss and LAE
    56.0 %     34.8 %  
21.2 points
 
Net acquisition expense
    22.8 %     20.8 %  
2.0 points
 
Other underwriting expense
    6.0 %     6.7 %  
(0.7) points
 
Combined
    84.8 %     62.3 %  
22.5 points
 

The Casualty segment underwriting income decreased by $81.2 million for the year ended December 31, 2011 as compared with the year ended December 31, 2010, primarily due to a decrease in net favorable development.  Net favorable development was $59.9 million and $121.1 million for the years ended December 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively.  In addition, a review of our administrative costs of managing claims resulted in a reduction of $13.2 million in ULAE reserves in 2010.
 
 
- 41 -

 
 
Net premiums written decreased by $32.4 million for the year ended December 31, 2011 as compared with the year ended December 31, 2010, primarily due to decreases in the North American casualty excess-of-loss, international casualty and financial lines classes as a result of fewer opportunities that met our underwriting standards.  Net premiums earned decreased by $25.1 million as a result of the decreases in net premiums written in current and prior periods.  Net premiums written and earned were also affected by changes in the mix of business and the structure of the underlying reinsurance contracts.
 
Net losses and LAE increased by $59.0 million for the year ended December 31, 2011 as compared with the year ended December 31, 2010, primarily due to a decrease in net favorable loss development. Net favorable loss development was $59.4 million and $113.3 million for the years ended December 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively.  Net favorable loss development and related premium adjustments decreased the net loss and LAE ratios by 18.8 points and 33.6 points for the years ended December 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively.  Net favorable loss development for  the years ended December 31, 2011 and 2010 was primarily attributable to a level of cumulative losses reported by our ceding companies that was lower than expected and that, in our judgment, resulted in sufficient credibility in the loss experience to change our previously selected loss ratios.  The net loss and LAE ratios were also affected by changes in the mix of business. In addition, changes in our estimate of the administrative costs of managing claims decreased the net loss and LAE ratio by 3.5 points in 2010.
 
The following table sets forth the net favorable (unfavorable) development for the year ended December 31, 2011 by class of business ($ in thousands):

Class of Business
 
Net Losses and LAE
   
Net Acquisition Expense
   
Net Premiums
   
Net Development
 
North American claims made
  $ 34,503     $ (2,227 )   $ 58     $ 32,334  
North American umbrella
    12,049       304       -       12,353  
North American occurrence excess-of-loss
    10,859       222       210       11,291  
Financial lines
    9,348       (244 )     (405 )     8,699  
Accident and health
    (2,958 )     1,591       -       (1,367 )
International casualty
    (4,981 )     233       518       (4,230 )
Other
    600       (69 )     281       812  
Total
  $ 59,420     $ (190 )   $ 662     $ 59,892  

Net favorable development in the North American claims made class arose primarily from the 2003 through 2007 underwriting years.  Net favorable development in the North American umbrella class arose primarily from the 2003 through 2008 underwriting years. The net favorable development in the 2008 underwriting year resulted from improved loss experience in the current year after adverse experience led us to increase the selected loss ratio from the initial expected loss ratio in prior years.  Net favorable development in the North American occurrence excess-of-loss class arose primarily from the 2002 through 2007 underwriting years, with a change in the loss development patterns contributing approximately $2.1 million of net favorable development.  Net favorable development in the financial lines class arose primarily from North American surety business across most prior underwriting years, with a change in the loss development patterns resulting in approximately $1.5 million of net favorable development.  Net unfavorable development in the accident and health class arose primarily from the 2004 through 2006 underwriting years partially offset by favorable development on the 2008 underwriting year.  Net unfavorable development in the international casualty class arose primarily from the 2008 and 2010 underwriting years arising from wildfires in Australia and energy related claims in the United States written under global covers. This was partially offset by favorable development on the 2005 and 2006 underwriting years. Changes in the loss development patterns in this class resulted in approximately $1.6 million of net favorable development.
 
The following table sets forth the net favorable (unfavorable) development for the year ended December 31, 2010 by class of business ($ in thousands):

Class of Business
 
Net Losses and LAE
   
Net Acquisition Expense
   
Net Premiums
   
Net Development
 
North American claims made
  $ 54,054     $ 2,714     $ -     $ 56,768  
North American occurrence excess-of-loss
    35,377       (327 )     72       35,122  
North American clash
    12,748       86       140       12,974  
North American umbrella
    9,205       212       -       9,417  
Financial lines
    11,488       (13 )     (1 )     11,474  
Accident and health
    5,038       1,292       -       6,330  
International casualty
    (14,768 )     800       2,819       (11,149 )
Other
    139       -       -       139  
Total
  $ 113,281     $ 4,764     $ 3,030     $ 121,075  

Net favorable development in the North American claims made class arose primarily from the 2003 through 2007 underwriting years.  Net favorable development in the North American occurrence excess-of-loss class arose primarily from the 2002 through 2006 underwriting years.  A review of historical results in the North American clash class resulted in a change to the expected loss ratios in all prior underwriting years.  This change in expected loss ratios contributed $13.7 million to the net favorable development in this class.  Net favorable development in the North American umbrella class arose primarily from the 2003, 2004 and 2006 underwriting years, partially offset by net unfavorable development in the 2008 underwriting year.  Net favorable development in the financial lines class arose primarily from the North American surety business in the 2004 through 2008 underwriting years.  Net favorable development in the accident and health class arose primarily from the 2005 and 2008 underwriting years. The international casualty class was impacted by net unfavorable development from financial institutions business and utility companies’ exposure to wildfires in Australia in the 2008 underwriting year.  This was partially offset by net favorable development in all other underwriting years.  This class also benefited by $2.0 million of favorable development from changes in the pattern of expected reported losses and initial expected loss ratios.
 
 
- 42 -

 
 
Net acquisition expenses and related net acquisition expense ratios were $72.7 million and 22.8%, respectively, for the year ended December 31, 2011 and $71.5 million and 20.8%, respectively, for the year ended December 31, 2010.  The increase in the acquisition expense ratio was due to an increase in commissions related to prior years for the year ended December 31, 2011 as compared with the same period in 2010.  The increase in commissions related to prior years was $0.2 million and had no effect on the net acquisition expense ratio for the year ended December 31, 2011.  The decrease in commissions related to prior years was $4.8 million and decreased the net acquisition expense ratio by 1.6 points for the year ended December 31, 2010.  Net acquisition expenses and related net acquisition expense ratios were also affected by changes in the mix of business.
 
Other underwriting expenses were $19.0 million and $23.1 million for the years ended December 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively.  The decrease in 2011 as compared with 2010 was primarily attributable to a decrease in performance-based compensation in 2011.
 
Finite Risk
 
The Finite Risk segment generated 1.5% and 2.4% of our net premiums written for the years ended December 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively.  Due to the inverse relationship between losses and commissions for this segment, we believe it is important to evaluate the overall combined ratio, rather than its component parts of net loss and LAE ratio and net acquisition expense ratio.  The following table summarizes underwriting activity and ratios for the Finite Risk segment for the years ended December 31, 2011 and 2010 ($ in thousands):

   
2011
   
2010
   
Increase (decrease)
 
Net premiums written
  $ 9,843     $ 18,517     $ (8,674 )
                         
Net premiums earned
    13,742       17,419       (3,677 )
Net losses and LAE
    (1,275 )     4,232          
Net acquisition expenses
    11,091       14,978          
Net losses, LAE and acquisition expenses
    9,816       19,210       (9,394 )
Other underwriting expenses
    940       1,260       (320 )
Finite Risk segment underwriting income (loss)
  $ 2,986     $ (3,051 )   $ 6,037  
Underwriting ratios:
                       
Net loss and LAE
    (9.3 )%     24.3 %        
Net acquisition expense
    80.7 %     86.0 %        
Net loss, LAE and acquisition expense
    71.4 %     110.3 %  
(38.9) points
 
Other underwriting expense
    6.8 %     7.2 %  
(0.4) points
 
Combined
    78.2 %     117.5 %  
(39.3) points
 

During the years ended December 31, 2011 and 2010, the Finite Risk portfolio consisted of one in-force contract and we expect little or no new activity in this segment in the foreseeable future due to the relatively low level of demand for finite risk products.  Due to the decline in premium volume in recent years, current year ratios may be significantly impacted by relatively small adjustments of prior years’ reserves.  The decreases in net premiums written and net premiums earned for the year ended December 31, 2011 as compared with the year ended December 31, 2010 were primarily attributable to a decrease in the underlying premiums written relating to the one in-force contract.
 
Net losses, LAE and acquisition expenses decreased by $9.4 million for the year ended December 31, 2011 as compared with the year ended December 31, 2010, primarily due to net favorable development in 2011 as compared with net unfavorable development in 2010.  Net favorable development was $4.0 million for the year ended December 31, 2011 compared with net unfavorable development of $2.5 million for the year ended December 31, 2010.  Net favorable development for the year ended December 31, 2011 was primarily related to contracts from the 2004 underwriting year offset by net unfavorable development related to a contract from the 2003 underwriting year.  Net unfavorable development for the year ended December 31, 2010 was primarily related to a contract from the 2003 underwriting year.  The net favorable development decreased the net loss and LAE and acquisition expense ratio by 29.0 points for the year ended December 31, 2011 compared with net unfavorable development increasing the ratio by 14.3 points for the year ended December 31, 2010.
 
 
- 43 -

 
 
Non-Underwriting Results
 
Net Investment Income
 
Net investment income was $125.9 million and $134.4 million for the years ended December 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively.  Net investment income decreased during the year ended December 31, 2011, as compared with the same period in 2010, as a result of a small reduction in average investable assets and a slight decrease in average yields for the portfolio, from 3.2% to 3.1%.
 
Net Realized Gains on Investments
 
Net realized gains on investments were $3.9 million and $107.8 million for the years ended December 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively.  Sales of investments resulted in net realized gains of $1.4 million for the year ended December 31, 2011, primarily from realized gains from U.S. Treasury Inflation-Protected Securities ("TIPS") and corporate bonds partially offset by realized losses from U.S. Government securities.  The net gains from mark-to-market adjustments on trading securities of $2.5 million for the year ended December 31, 2011 were related primarily to non-U.S government securities partially offset by insurance-linked securities.  Sales of investments resulted in net realized gains of $106.4 million for the year ended December 31, 2010, primarily from U.S. Government securities, U.S. Government agency residential mortgage-backed securities ("RMBS"), and non-U.S. government securities.  The net gains from mark-to-market adjustments on trading securities of $1.4 million for the year ended December 31, 2010 were related primarily to non-U.S. government securities.
 
Net Impairment Losses on Investments
 
Net impairment losses on investments were $22.4 million and $36.6 million for the years ended December 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively.  The net impairment losses reflect other-than-temporary impairments attributable to credit losses on impaired securities that exclusively relate to investments in securitized mortgages not guaranteed by U.S. government agencies.  The net impairment losses recorded for the year ended December 31, 2011 reflect our revised assumptions regarding macroeconomic conditions in the United States, including the outlook for home prices, and included $19.0 million related to non-agency RMBS and $3.4 million related to sub-prime asset-backed securities (“ABS”).  The net impairment losses recorded for the year ended December 31, 2010 included $17.7 million related to sub-prime ABS, $11.2 million related to non-agency RMBS and $7.7 million related to commercial mortgage-backed securities (“CMBS”).
 
Net Changes in Fair Value of Derivatives
 
The net changes in the fair value of derivatives resulted in an expense of $4.3 million and $9.6 million for the years ended December 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively.  For the year ended December 31, 2011, expenses of $2.5 million related to a derivative agreement with Topiary Capital Limited (“Topiary”) that was used to manage our exposure to certain underwriting risks.  In addition, expenses of $1.6 million related to put options on treasury futures that were purchased to temporarily protect our investment portfolio against a sudden increase in interest rates.  The net changes in the fair value of derivatives for the year ended December 31, 2010 were attributable to the derivative agreement with Topiary.
 
Operating Expenses
 
Non-underwriting operating expenses were $15.6 million and $25.6 million for the years ended December 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively, and related to costs such as compensation and other corporate expenses associated with operating as a publicly-traded company.  The decrease during the year ended December 31, 2011 as compared with the same period in 2010 was primarily attributable to a decrease in performance-based compensation in 2011.
 
Interest Expense
 
Interest expense was $19.1 million and $19.0 million for the years ended December 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively, and related to our $250.0 million of debt obligations.
 
Income Taxes
 
Income tax benefit was $3.1 million and income tax expense was $43.2 million for the years ended December 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively.  Our effective tax rate was (1.4%) and 16.7% for the years ended December 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively.  Income tax expense or benefit is primarily driven by the taxable income or loss generated by our U.S.-based subsidiaries.  The income tax expense or benefit rate is driven by the portion of taxable income or loss generated by our U.S.-based subsidiaries relative to the income or loss generated by our Bermuda-based operations, which are non-taxable.  Premiums earned by our U.S. and Bermuda-based subsidiaries generally do not bear a proportionate relationship to their respective pre-tax income for a variety of reasons, including the significant impact on pre-tax income of the different mixes of business underwritten by the particular subsidiary, the presence or absence of underwriting income or loss attributable to such business, and the investment results experienced by the particular subsidiary.
 
Pre-tax loss was $235.6 million in our Bermuda companies and pre-tax income was $7.4 million in our U.S. companies for the year ended December 31, 2011.  Pre-tax income was $122.9 million and $130.3 million in our Bermuda and U.S. companies, respectively, for the year ended December 31, 2010.  In 2011, pre-tax loss in our Bermuda companies resulted primarily from an increase in losses related to major catastrophe activity.
 
See Note 8 to the "Consolidated Financial Statements" contained elsewhere in this Form 10-K for further detail on our pre-tax income by jurisdiction as well as a reconciliation of expected income taxes to our actual income tax expense or benefit.
 
 
- 44 -

 
 
Year Ended December 31, 2010 as Compared with the Year Ended December 31, 2009
 
Net income (loss) and diluted earnings (loss) per common share for the years ended December 31, 2010 and 2009 were as follows ($ and amounts in thousands, except diluted earnings (loss) per common share):

   
2010
   
2009
   
Net change
 
Underwriting income
  $ 108,869     $ 218,188     $ (109,319 )
Net investment income
    134,385       163,941       (29,556 )
Net realized gains on investments
    107,791       78,630       29,161  
Net impairment losses on investments
    (36,610 )     (17,603 )     (19,007 )
Other revenues (expenses)
    (55,783 )     (55,580 )     (203 )
Income before income taxes
    258,652       387,576       (128,924 )
Income tax expense
    (43,154 )     (4,285 )     (38,869 )
Net income
    215,498       383,291       (167,793 )
Preferred dividends
    -       (1,301 )     1,301  
  Net income attributable to common shareholders
  $ 215,498     $ 381,990     $ (166,492 )
                         
Weighted average shares outstanding for diluted earnings per common share
    45,052       52,315       (7,263 )
Diluted earnings per common share
  $ 4.78     $ 7.33     $ (2.55 )

The decrease in net income for the year ended December 31, 2010 as compared with 2009 was primarily due to decreases in net underwriting income and net investment income and an increase in net impairment losses on investments, which was partially offset by an increase in net realized gains on investments.  We also had an increase in income tax expense.  The decrease in diluted earnings per common share for the year ended December 31, 2010 as compared with 2009 was primarily due to a decrease in net income, partially offset by the repurchase of our common shares. Diluted earnings per common share for the year ended December 31, 2010 was favorably impacted by a decrease in weighted average shares outstanding used to calculate diluted earnings per common share, primarily due to the repurchase of 9,672,231 of our common shares in 2010.
 
Underwriting Results
 
Net underwriting income was $108.9 million and $218.2 million for the years ended December 31, 2010 and 2009, respectively.  The decrease was primarily due to an increase in net underwriting losses arising from major catastrophes, partially offset by an increase in net favorable development and a reduction in our ULAE reserves.
 
Net losses arising from major catastrophes were $214.8 million and $35.5 million for the years ended December 31, 2010 and 2009, respectively.  Net favorable development was $151.9 million and $101.0 million for the years ended December 31, 2010 and 2009, respectively.  The net favorable development for the year ended December 31, 2010 relating to prior years was substantially all in the Property and Marine and Casualty segments.  Additionally, we conducted a review of ULAE reserve factors across all lines of business during the third quarter of 2010.  The review involved a detailed analysis of our administrative costs of managing claims since our inception and, in our judgment, we concluded that the amounts paid had reached sufficient credibility for us to change our previously selected ULAE reserve factors.  The change in our estimate of the administrative costs of managing claims resulted in a $13.2 million reduction of ULAE reserves.
 
Property and Marine
 
The Property and Marine operating segment generated 54.3% and 57.6% of our net premiums written for the years ended December 31, 2010 and 2009, respectively.  The following table summarizes underwriting activity and ratios for the Property and Marine segment for the years ended December 31, 2010 and 2009 ($ in thousands):

   
2010
   
2009
   
Increase (decrease)
 
Gross premiums written
  $ 431,612     $ 543,851     $ (112,239 )
Ceded premiums written
    18,937       26,840       (7,903 )
Net premiums written
    412,675       517,011       (104,336 )
Net premiums earned
    418,763       528,488       (109,725 )
Net losses and LAE
    343,509       250,646       92,863  
Net acquisition expenses
    60,224       66,992       (6,768 )
Other underwriting expenses
    32,678       37,331       (4,653 )
Property and Marine segment underwriting income (loss)
  $ (17,648 )   $ 173,519     $ (191,167 )
                         
Underwriting ratios:
                       
Net loss and LAE
    82.0 %     47.4 %  
34.6 points
 
Net acquisition expense
    14.4 %     12.7 %  
1.7 points
 
Other underwriting expense
    7.8 %     7.1 %  
0.7 points
 
Combined
    104.2 %     67.2 %  
37.0 points
 
 
 
- 45 -

 
 
Property and Marine segment underwriting income decreased by $191.2 million for the year ended December 31, 2010 as compared with the year ended December 31, 2009, primarily due to an increase in net losses arising from major catastrophes, partially offset by an increase in net favorable development.  Net losses arising from major catastrophes, net of reinstatement premiums and commissions, were $214.8 million and $35.5 million for the years ended December 31, 2010 and 2009, respectively. Net losses arising from major catastrophes for the year ended December 31, 2010 were substantially attributable to the earthquakes in Chile and New Zealand and to a lesser extent flooding in Australia.  Net losses arising from major catastrophes for the year ended December 31, 2009 were primarily attributable to the Irish Floods, Hailstorm Wolfgang and Winterstorm Klaus.  Net favorable development was $33.3 million and $25.1 million for the years ended December 31, 2010 and 2009, respectively.  The change in our estimate of the administrative costs of managing claims resulted in a $1.3 million reduction of ULAE reserves.
 
Gross premiums written decreased by $112.2 million in the year ended December 31, 2010 as compared with the year ended December 31, 2009 as a result of fewer opportunities that met our underwriting standards.  Gross premiums written included reinstatement premiums of $17.7 million and $7.2 million related to major catastrophes for the years ended December 31, 2010 and 2009, respectively.  The decrease in gross premiums written was primarily due to a decrease of $88.8 million in North American crop business for the year ended December 31, 2010 as compared with the same period in 2009.  The decrease in ceded premiums written for the year ended December 31, 2010 as compared with the same period in 2009 was primarily the result of a decrease in our purchases of proportional property retrocessional coverage.  Net premiums earned decreased by $109.7 million as a result of reduced net premiums written in the current and prior underwriting years.  Net premiums written and earned were also affected by changes in the mix of business and the structure of the underlying reinsurance contracts.
 
Net losses and LAE increased by $92.9 million in the year ended December 31, 2010 as compared with the year ended December 31, 2009, primarily due to the increase in losses arising from major catastrophes in 2010.  Net losses and LAE arising from major catastrophes were $232.4 million and $42.6 million for the years ended December 31, 2010 and 2009, respectively. The increase in losses from major catastrophes was partially offset by the increase in net favorable loss development.  Net favorable loss development was $36.9 million and $14.3 million in 2010 and 2009, respectively.  Net losses arising from major catastrophes, with related premium adjustments, increased the net loss and LAE ratio by 54.3 points and 7.5 points for the years ended December 31, 2010 and 2009, respectively.  Net favorable loss development and related premium adjustments decreased the net loss and LAE ratio by 9.2 points and 3.2 points in 2010 and 2009, respectively.  The resulting loss ratio, excluding catastrophes and development, decreased due to a lower proportion of crop business, which had a higher loss ratio than the remainder of the segment, and a higher proportion of catastrophe business, which had a lower loss ratio than the remainder of the segment.  Net favorable loss development for the year ended December 31, 2010 was primarily attributable to a level of cumulative losses reported by our ceding companies that was lower than we expected and that, in our judgment, resulted in sufficient credibility in the loss experience to change our previously selected loss ratios.  The change in our estimate of the administrative costs of managing claims in the year ended December 31, 2010 decreased the net loss and LAE ratio by 0.3 points.
 
Net favorable development was $33.3 million for the year ended December 31, 2010. See "Results of Operations - Year Ended December 31, 2011 as Compared with the Year Ended December 31, 2010 - Underwriting Results - Property and Marine" above for discussion of net favorable development by class of business for the year ended December 31, 2010.
 
The following table sets forth the net favorable (unfavorable) development for the year ended December 31, 2009 by class of business ($ in thousands):

Class of Business
 
Net Losses and LAE
   
Net Acquisition Expense
   
Net Premiums
   
Net Development
 
Property per risk excess-of-loss
  $ 11,932     $ (181 )   $ 2,125     $ 13,876  
Catastrophe excess-of-loss (non-major events)
    13,877       1,284       217       15,378  
Property proportional
    5,001       (391 )     -       4,610  
Major catastrophes
    (3,474 )     -       349       (3,125 )
Crop
    (8,783 )     5,102       -       (3,681 )
Marine, aviation and satellite
    (4,294 )     330       2,027       (1,937 )
Total
  $ 14,259     $ 6,144     $ 4,718     $ 25,121  

Net favorable development in the property per-risk excess-of-loss class related primarily to the 2006 through 2008 underwriting years.  Net favorable development in the catastrophe excess-of-loss (non-major events) class related primarily to the 2008 underwriting year.  Net favorable development in the property proportional class related primarily to the 2005 through 2007 underwriting years.  Net unfavorable development in major catastrophes related primarily to marine losses related to Hurricane Rita in the 2005 underwriting year.  Net unfavorable development in the crop class related primarily to the North American business in the 2008 underwriting year.  Net unfavorable development in the marine, aviation and satellite class related primarily to the marine business in the 2007 underwriting year.
 
Net acquisition expenses and related net acquisition expense ratios were $60.2 million and 14.4%, respectively, for the year ended December 31, 2010 and $67.0 million and 12.7%, respectively, for the year ended December 31, 2009.  The decrease in net acquisition expenses in 2010 as compared with 2009 was primarily due to a decrease in net premiums earned.  The increase in the acquisition expense ratio was due to an increase in commissions related to the increase in net favorable development and was also impacted by changes in the mix of business.
 
Other underwriting expenses were $32.7 million and $37.3 million for the years ended December 31, 2010 and 2009, respectively. The decrease in 2010 as compared with 2009 was primarily due to a decrease in performance-based compensation in 2010.
 
 
- 46 -

 
 
Casualty
 
The Casualty operating segment generated 43.3% and 39.7% of our net premiums written for the years ended December 31, 2010 and 2009, respectively.  The following table summarizes underwriting activity and ratios for the Casualty segment for the years ended December 31, 2010 and 2009 ($ in thousands):

   
2010
   
2009
   
Increase (decrease)
 
Net premiums written
  $ 329,397     $ 356,488     $ (27,091 )
Net premiums earned
    343,812       388,901       (45,089 )
Net losses and LAE
    119,679       226,511       (106,832 )
Net acquisition expenses
    71,474       88,841       (17,367 )
Other underwriting expenses
    23,091       25,644       (2,553 )
Casualty segment underwriting income
  $ 129,568     $ 47,905     $ 81,663  
                         
Underwriting ratios:
                       
Net loss and LAE
    34.8 %     58.2 %  
(23.4) points
 
Net acquisition expense
    20.8 %     22.8 %  
(2.0) points
 
Other underwriting expense
    6.7 %     6.6 %  
0.1 points
 
Combined
    62.3 %     87.6 %  
(25.3) points
 

Casualty segment underwriting income increased by $81.7 million in the year ended December 31, 2010 as compared with the year ended December 31, 2009, primarily due to an increase in net favorable development, a reduction of ULAE reserves and changes in the mix of business.  Net favorable development was $121.1 million and $78.1 million for the years ended December 31, 2010 and 2009, respectively.  The change in our estimate of the administrative costs of managing claims resulted in a $13.2 million reduction of ULAE reserves. In addition, in 2009 we had $18.1 million related to two large loss events as compared with no large loss events in 2010.
 
Net premiums written decreased by $27.1 million in the year ended December 31, 2010 as compared with the year ended December 31, 2009, primarily due to decreases in business underwritten in 2010 and 2009 across most casualty classes as a result of fewer opportunities that met our underwriting standards.  Net premiums earned decreased by $45.1 million as a result of the decreases in net premiums written in current and prior underwriting years.  Net premiums written and earned were also affected by changes in the mix of business and the structure of the underlying reinsurance contracts.
 
Net losses and LAE decreased by $106.8 million in the year ended December 31, 2010 as compared with the year ended December 31, 2009, primarily due to an increase in net favorable loss development, a reduction of ULAE reserves, a reduction in large losses and a decrease in net premiums earned.  Net favorable loss development was $113.3 million and $73.6 million in 2010 and 2009, respectively.  Net favorable loss development and related premium adjustments decreased the net loss and LAE ratios by 33.6 points and 19.0 points in the years ended December 31, 2010 and 2009, respectively.  There were no large loss events for the year ended December 31, 2010.  For the year ended December 31, 2009, there were losses of $9.2 million related to an accident and health contract and $8.9 million from an international liability casualty contract related to liability arising from Australian wildfires.  Large losses increased the net loss and LAE ratio by 4.6 points for the year ended December 31, 2009.  Net favorable loss development for the years ended December 31, 2010 and 2009 was primarily attributable to a level of cumulative losses reported by our ceding companies that was lower than expected and that, in our judgment, resulted in sufficient credibility in the loss experience to change our previously selected loss ratios.  The net loss and LAE ratios were also affected by changes in the mix of business.  The change in our estimate of the administrative costs of managing claims in the year ended December 31, 2010 decreased the net loss and LAE ratio by 3.5 points.
 
Net favorable development was $121.1 million for the year ended December 31, 2010. See "Results of Operations - Year Ended December 31, 2011 as Compared with the Year Ended December 31, 2010 - Underwriting Results - Casualty" above for discussion of net favorable development by class of business for the year ended December 31, 2010.
 
The following table sets forth the net favorable (unfavorable) development for the year ended December 31, 2009 by class of business ($ in thousands):

Class of Business
 
Net Losses and LAE
   
Net Acquisition Expense
   
Net Premiums
   
Net Development
 
North American claims made
  $ 19,039     $ (705 )   $ -     $ 18,334  
North American clash
    1,882       46       368       2,296  
North American occurrence excess-of-loss
    15,613       (261 )     84       15,436  
North American umbrella
    26,349       4,684       -       31,033  
Accident and health
    (4,714 )     678       -       (4,036 )
Financial lines
    9,586       (157 )     (577 )     8,852  
International casualty
    6,238       (258 )     192       6,172  
Other
    (404 )     414       -       10  
Total
  $ 73,589     $ 4,441     $ 67     $ 78,097  
 
 
- 47 -

 
 
Net favorable development in the North American claims made class arose primarily from the 2003 and 2005 underwriting years.  This class also benefited by $2.8 million of favorable development from changes in the pattern of expected reported losses and initial expected loss ratios.  The net favorable development was partially offset by net unfavorable development in the 2007 underwriting year arising from claims related to the utilities sector.  Net favorable development in the North American clash class related primarily to a specific loss resulting from an explosion in 2005.  Net favorable development in the North American occurrence excess-of-loss class related primarily to the 2003, 2005 and 2007 underwriting years partially offset by net unfavorable development in the 2002 and 2008 underwriting years.  The net favorable development in the 2003 and 2007 underwriting years resulted from improved loss experience in the current year after adverse experience led us to increase the selected loss ratio from the initial expected loss ratio in prior years.  This class also benefited by $1.2 million of favorable development from changes in the pattern of expected reported losses and initial expected loss ratios.  Net favorable development in the North American umbrella class arose primarily from the 2003 through 2005 underwriting years and included $0.6 million related to changes in the initial expected loss ratio for the 2008 underwriting year.  The net unfavorable development in the accident and health class arose primarily from the 2007 and 2008 underwriting years and was partially offset by net favorable development in the 2004 and 2005 underwriting years.  In the financial lines class, net favorable development related primarily from the 2004 through 2007 underwriting years partially offset by net unfavorable development in the 2008 underwriting year.  Net favorable development in the international casualty class related primarily to the 2006 and prior underwriting years, partially offset by net unfavorable development in the 2007 and 2008 underwriting years.
 
Net acquisition expenses and related net acquisition expense ratios were $71.5 million and 20.8%, respectively, for the year ended December 31, 2010 and $88.8 million and 22.8%, respectively, for the year ended December 31, 2009.  The decrease in net acquisition expenses in 2010 as compared with 2009 was primarily due to the decrease in net premiums earned.  The decrease in the acquisition expense ratio was primarily due to changes in the mix of business.  In addition, the decrease was partially due to a decrease in commissions related to prior years of $4.8 million, which decreased the net acquisition ratio by 1.6% in 2010 as compared with a decrease of $4.4 million in commissions, which decreased the net acquisition ratio by 1.2% in 2009.
 
Other underwriting expenses were $23.1 million and $25.6 million for the years ended December 31, 2010 and 2009, respectively.  The decrease in 2010 as compared with 2009 was primarily due to a decrease in performance-based compensation in 2010.
 
Finite Risk
 
The Finite Risk segment generated 2.4% and 2.7% of our net premiums written for the years ended December 31, 2010 and 2009, respectively.  The following table summarizes underwriting activity and ratios for the Finite Risk segment for the years ended December 31, 2010 and 2009 ($ in thousands):

   
2010
   
2009
   
Increase (decrease)
 
Net premiums written
  $ 18,517     $ 24,335     $ (5,818 )
                         
Net premiums earned
    17,419       19,947       (2,528 )
Net losses and LAE
    4,232       1,185          
Net acquisition expenses
    14,978       20,586          
Net losses, LAE and acquisition expenses
    19,210       21,771       (2,561 )
Other underwriting expenses
    1,260       1,412       (152 )
Finite Risk segment underwriting income (loss)
  $ (3,051 )   $ (3,236 )   $ 185  
Underwriting ratios:
                       
Net loss and LAE
    24.3 %     5.9 %        
Net acquisition expense
    86.0 %     103.2 %        
Net loss, LAE and acquisition expense
    110.3 %     109.1 %  
1.2 points
 
Other underwriting expense
    7.2 %     7.1 %  
0.1 points
 
Combined
    117.5 %     116.2 %  
1.3 points
 

During the years ended December 31, 2010 and 2009, the Finite Risk portfolio consisted of one in-force contract.  Due to the decline in premium volume in recent years, current year ratios may be significantly impacted by relatively insignificant adjustments of prior years’ reserves.  The decreases in net premiums written and net premiums earned for the year ended December 31, 2010 as compared with the year ended December 31, 2009 were primarily attributable to a decrease in the underlying premiums written relating to the one in-force contract.
 
Net losses, LAE and acquisition expenses decreased by $2.6 million in the year ended December 31, 2010 as compared with the year ended December 31, 2009, primarily due to the decrease in net premiums earned.  Net unfavorable development was $2.5 million and $2.3 million for the years ended December 31, 2010 and 2009, respectively.  Net unfavorable development increased the net loss and LAE and acquisition expense ratio by 14.3 points and 11.3 points for the years ended December 31, 2010 and 2009, respectively.

Non-Underwriting Results
 
Net Investment Income
 
Net investment income was $134.4 million and $163.9 million for the years ended December 31, 2010 and 2009, respectively.  Net investment income decreased in 2010 as compared with 2009 primarily as a result of lower new money yields on invested assets and cash and cash equivalents.
 
 
- 48 -

 
 
Net Realized Gains on Investments
 
Net realized gains on investments were $107.8 million and $78.6 million for the years ended December 31, 2010 and 2009, respectively.  Sales of investments resulted in net realized gains of $106.4 million for the year ended December 31, 2010, primarily from U.S. Government securities, U.S. Government agency RMBS and non-U.S. Government securities. The net gains from mark-to-market adjustments on trading securities for the year ended December 31, 2010 included net gains of $1.4 million primarily related to non-U.S. Government securities.  Sales of investments resulted in net realized gains of $80.9 million for the year ended December 31, 2009, primarily from TIPS, U.S. Government agency securities, corporate bonds and non-agency RMBS.  The net losses from mark-to-market adjustments on trading securities for the year ended December 31, 2009 were comprised of $2.1 million related to non-U.S. dollar denominated securities and $1.2 million related to TIPS, which were partially offset by net gains of $1.0 million related to insurance-linked securities.
 
Net Impairment Losses on Investments
 
Net impairment losses on investments were $36.6 million and $17.6 million for the years ended December 31, 2010 and 2009, respectively.  The net impairment losses recorded for the year ended December 31, 2010 included $17.7 million related to sub-prime ABS, $11.2 million related to non-agency RMBS and $7.7 million related to CMBS.  The net impairment losses recorded for year ended December 31, 2009 included $8.4 million related to non-agency RMBS, $5.3 million related to sub-prime ABS and $2.7 million related to CMBS.
 
Net Changes in Fair Value of Derivatives
 
The net changes in the fair value of derivatives resulted in an expense of $9.6 million and $9.7 million for the years ended December 31, 2010 and 2009, respectively, and were attributed to the derivative agreement with Topiary that was used to manage our exposure to certain underwriting risks.
 
Operating Expenses
 
Non-underwriting operating expenses were $25.6 million and $30.3 million in 2010 and 2009, respectively, and related to costs such as compensation and other corporate expenses associated with operating as a publicly-traded company.  The decrease for the year ended December 31, 2010 as compared with the same period in 2009 was primarily attributable to a decrease in performance-based compensation expense in 2010.
 
Interest Expense
 
Interest expense was $19.0 million for each of the years ended December 31, 2010 and 2009 and related to our $250.0 million of debt obligations.
 
Income Taxes
 
Income tax expense was $43.2 million and $4.3 million for the years ended December 31, 2010 and 2009, respectively.  Our effective tax rate was 16.7% and 1.1% for the years ended December 31, 2010 and 2009, respectively.  Income tax expense or benefit is primarily driven by the taxable income or loss generated by our U.S.-based subsidiaries.  The income tax expense or benefit rate is driven by the portion of taxable income or loss generated by our U.S.-based subsidiaries relative to the income or loss generated by our Bermuda-based operations, which are non-taxable.   Premiums earned by our U.S. and Bermuda-based subsidiaries generally do not bear a proportionate relationship to their respective pre-tax income for a variety of reasons, including the significant impact on pre-tax income of the different mixes of business underwritten by the particular subsidiary, the presence or absence of underwriting income or loss attributable to such business, and the investment results experienced by the particular subsidiary.
 
Pre-tax income for the years ended December 31, 2010 and 2009 was $122.9 million and $365.5 million, respectively, in our Bermuda companies and $130.3 million and $16.0 million, respectively, in our U.S. companies.  In 2009, pre-tax income in our Bermuda companies was higher as compared with our U.S. companies due to significantly higher net underwriting income in Platinum Bermuda.

Financial Condition
 
Liquidity
 
Liquidity Requirements
 
Platinum Holdings is a holding company, the assets of which consist primarily of shares of its subsidiaries.  Platinum Holdings depends primarily on its available cash resources and liquid investments and dividends and other distributions from its subsidiaries to meet its obligations.  Such obligations, and those of Platinum Finance, may include operating expenses, debt service obligations and income taxes.  We believe that Platinum Holdings has sufficient cash resources and its subsidiaries have available dividend capacity to service our current outstanding obligations.  Our reinsurance subsidiaries’ principal cash requirements are the payment of losses and LAE, commissions, brokerage, operating expenses, income taxes and dividends to Platinum Holdings.  We consider the impact of dividends and other distributions from our reinsurance subsidiaries on their respective capital levels, which may impact the financial strength rating assigned to our subsidiaries by A.M. Best and S&P.
 
Platinum Bermuda is not licensed, approved or accredited as a reinsurer in the United States and, therefore, under the terms of most of its contracts with U.S. ceding companies, it is required to provide collateral to its ceding companies for unpaid ceded liabilities in a form acceptable to state insurance commissioners.  Typically, this type of collateral takes the form of letters of credit issued by a bank, the establishment of a trust, or funds withheld.  See “Sources of Liquidity – Credit Facilities” below for additional information on our credit facilities and the collateral required by us.
 
 
- 49 -

 
 
Platinum Bermuda and Platinum US have reinsurance and other contracts that also require them to provide collateral to ceding companies should certain events occur, such as a decline in our financial strength rating by A.M. Best or S&P below specified levels or a decline in statutory equity below specified amounts, or when certain levels of assumed liabilities are attained.  Some reinsurance contracts also have special termination provisions that permit early termination should certain events occur. As of December 31, 2011 and 2010, we held investments with a carrying value of $61.1 million and $69.8 million, respectively, and cash and cash equivalents of $9.3 million and $9.9 million, respectively, in trust to collateralize obligations under various reinsurance contracts.
 
The laws and regulations of Bermuda and the United States include certain restrictions on the amount of dividends that can be paid by Platinum Bermuda and Platinum US to their respective parent companies, Platinum Holdings and Platinum Finance, without the prior approval of the relevant regulatory authorities.  Based on regulatory restrictions, the unaudited maximum amount available for payment of dividends by our reinsurance subsidiaries during 2012 without prior regulatory approval is as follows ($ in thousands):

Platinum Bermuda
  $ 286,607  
Platinum US
    52,806  
Total
  $ 339,413  

During the year ended December 31, 2011, dividends of $300.0 million were paid by the reinsurance subsidiaries of Platinum Holdings, of which $255.0 million was paid by Platinum Bermuda to Platinum Holdings and $45.0 million was paid by Platinum US to Platinum Finance.
 
During the year ended December 31, 2011, Platinum US repaid a $100.0 million surplus note to Platinum Regency, the parent company of Platinum Finance, and Platinum Regency paid dividends of $100.0 million to Platinum Holdings.  There are no regulatory restrictions on the amount of dividends that Platinum Finance can pay to Platinum Regency. Irish law prohibits Platinum Regency from declaring a dividend to its shareholders unless it has “profits available for distribution.”  The determination of whether a company has profits available for distribution is based on its accumulated realized profits less its accumulated realized losses.
 
During the year ended December 31, 2011, Platinum Holdings repaid loans from Platinum Finance of $75.0 million, due February 1, 2011.  In March 2011, Platinum Holdings contributed an additional $120.0 million in capital to Platinum Bermuda.
 
Platinum Holdings fully and unconditionally guarantees the outstanding $250.0 million of debt obligations of Platinum Finance.  Platinum Finance pays interest at a rate of 7.5% per annum on each June 1 and December 1.
 
Platinum Holdings also may require cash to pay for share repurchases.  See “Sources of Liquidity - Share and Debt Repurchases” below for additional discussion on share repurchases.
 
Sources of Liquidity
 
Our sources of funds consist primarily of cash and cash equivalents held by us, cash from operations, proceeds from sales, redemption and maturity of investments, borrowings from our credit facilities and the issuance of securities.  As at December 31, 2011, we had cash and cash equivalents of $792.5 million and Platinum Holdings had cash and cash equivalents of $47.8 million.  We expect that our liquidity needs for the next twelve months will be met by our cash and cash equivalents, short-term investments, cash flows from operations, investment income and proceeds from the sale, redemption or maturity of our investments.

Cash Flows
 
Net cash flows used in operating activities were $33.7 million, or $65.1 million excluding trading securities, for the year ended December 31, 2011.  Net cash flows provided by operating activities were $24.7 million, or $68.3 million excluding trading securities, for the year ended December 31, 2010.  Our reinsurance subsidiaries have liquidity from premiums, which are generally received in advance of the time losses are paid.  The period of time from the occurrence of a claim through the settlement of the liability may extend many years into the future.  However, due to the nature of our reinsurance operations, cash flows are affected by claim payments that can fluctuate from year to year.  The amount and timing of actual claim payments can vary based on many factors, including the severity of individual losses, changes in the legal environment, and general market conditions.  During the year ended December 31, 2011, unpaid losses and LAE increased by $172.2 million primarily as a result of significant major catastrophe activity during 2011.  We anticipate that our future operating cash flow may be negatively impacted by the payment of these losses.
 
Net cash flows used in investing activities were $24.2 million for the year ended December 31, 2011 and net cash flows provided by investing activities were $738.3 million for the year ended December 31, 2010.  In 2011, net cash flows used in investing activities were primarily due to an increase in the acquisition of short-term investments offset by sales and maturities of fixed maturity available-for-sale and trading securities.  In 2010, net cash flows provided by investing activities were primarily due to sales and maturities of fixed maturity available-for-sale and trading securities offset by the acquisition of fixed maturity available-for-sale securities and short-term investments.  In 2011, we increased our net acquisition of short-term investments in light of the expected loss payments resulting from increased major catastrophe activity and to manage the overall duration of our investment portfolio.
 
Net cash flows used in financing activities were $153.1 million and $457.0 million for the years ended December 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively.  Net cash flows used in financing activities in 2011 primarily related to repurchases of common shares and the purchase of common share options of $94.7 million and $47.9 million, respectively, and the payment of dividends to common shareholders of $11.7 million.  Net cash flows used in financing activities in 2010 primarily related to repurchases of common shares and the purchase of common share options of $379.7 million and $98.5 million, respectively, and the payment of dividends to common shareholders of $13.4 million.
 
 
- 50 -

 
 
Investments
 
Our investable assets totaled $4.2 billion as at both December 31, 2011 and 2010.  Investable assets include investments, cash and cash equivalents, accrued investment income and net balances due to and from brokers and had a duration of 3.6 and 4.1 years as of December 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively.
 
As part of our investment strategy, we seek to establish a level of cash and liquid short-term and intermediate-term securities which, combined with expected cash flows from our operating activities, we believe to be adequate to meet our foreseeable payment obligations.  The ultimate amount and timing of claim payments could differ materially from our estimates and create significant variations in cash flows from operations between periods, which may require us to make payments from other sources of liquidity, such as sales of investments, borrowings from credit facilities or proceeds from capital market transactions.  If we need to sell investments to meet liquidity requirements, the sale of such investments may be at a material loss.
 
Our investment portfolio consists primarily of diversified, high quality, predominantly investment grade fixed maturity securities.  See Note 3 to the “Consolidated Financial Statements” in this Form 10-K for additional discussion of fair values.  The following table sets forth the fair values, net unrealized gains and losses and credit quality of our investments as of December 31, 2011 ($ in thousands):

   
Fair Value
   
Net Unrealized
Gain (Loss)
   
Credit Quality
 
Fixed maturity available-for-sale securities:
                 
U.S. Government
  $ 5,083     $ 381    
Aaa
 
U.S. Government agencies
    100,259       259    
Aaa
 
Municipal bonds:
                     
State general obligation bonds
    877,994       76,112    
Aa2
 
Essential service bonds
    425,340       39,071    
Aa3
 
State income tax and sales tax bonds
    181,751       21,120    
Aa1
 
Other municipal bonds
    136,291       11,552    
Aa2
 
Pre-refunded bonds
    39,384       2,247    
Aa2
 
Subtotal
    1,660,760       150,102    
Aa2
 
Non-U.S. governments
    71,266       1,274    
Aa1
 
Corporate bonds:
                     
Industrial
    226,364       12,183       A3  
Utilities
    70,424       5,384       A3  
Insurance
    45,292       2,387       A3  
Finance
    7,468       376    
Baa2
 
Subtotal
    349,548       20,330       A3  
Commercial mortgage-backed securities
    204,609       9,300    
Aa2
 
Residential mortgage-backed securities:
                       
U.S. Government agency residential mortgage-backed securities
    200,904       2,357    
Aaa
 
Non-agency residential mortgage-backed securities
    45,559       (11,276 )  
Caa2
 
Alt-A residential mortgage-backed securities
    5,164       (641 )  
Caa2
 
Subtotal
    251,627       (9,560 )  
Aa3
 
Asset-backed securities:
                       
Asset-backed securities
    12,710       (890 )  
Aaa
 
Sub-prime asset-backed securities
    7,712       (2,332 )  
Caa3
 
Subtotal
    20,422       (3,222 )  
Baa1
 
Total fixed maturity available-for-sale securities
    2,663,574       168,864    
Aa3
 
                         
Fixed maturity trading securities:
                       
Non-U.S. governments
    125,126       n/a    
Aaa
 
Total fixed maturity trading securities
    125,126       n/a    
Aaa
 
                         
Short-term investments:
                       
Available-for-sale
    407,709       (3 )  
Aaa
 
Trading
    181,125       n/a    
Aaa
 
Total short-term investments
    588,834       (3 )        
Total investments
  $ 3,377,534     $ 168,861    
Aa2
 
 
 
- 51 -

 
 
As of December 31, 2011, our investments had a dollar weighted average rating of Aa2, primarily measured by Moody’s.  If a particular security did not have a Moody’s rating then a rating from S&P was generally converted to a Moody’s equivalent rating.
 
Our non-U.S. government bond portfolio consists of securities issued by governments, provinces, agencies and supranationals as well as debt issued by financial institutions that is guaranteed by non-U.S. governments. 
 
The following table provides additional detail on the fair value and amortized cost of our portfolio of non-U.S. government fixed maturity available-for-sale securities, fixed maturity trading securities and short-term investments converted to U.S. dollars as of December 31, 2011 ($ in thousands):

   
Fair Value
       
Non-U.S. Government portfolio
 
Local Currency
   
Other Foreign Currencies
   
U.S. Dollar
   
Total
   
Amortized Cost
 
Germany
  $ 63,214     $ -     $ -     $ 63,214     $ 59,751  
Ireland
    -       -       4,373       4,373       4,999  
Netherlands
    -       1,498       -       1,498       1,357  
Eurozone governments
    63,214       1,498       4,373       69,085       66,107  
                                         
New Zealand
    126,434       -       -       126,434       126,360  
Australia
    56,379       -       30,843       87,222       85,966  
United Kingdom
    55,561       -       -       55,561       49,920  
Norway
    -       -       20,091       20,091       20,007  
Canada
    -       -       10,757       10,757       10,001  
Japan
    -       -       5,202       5,202       5,000  
European Investment Bank
    -       1,853       -       1,853       1,657  
Sweden
    -       1,312       -       1,312       1,207  
Other non-U.S. governments
    238,374       3,165       66,893       308,432       300,118  
Total non-U.S. governments
  $ 301,588     $ 4,663     $ 71,266     $ 377,517     $ 366,225  

When investing in a local or foreign currency it is for purposes of hedging our net foreign currency reinsurance liabilities.  All of our investments in debt issued by Eurozone financial institutions are guaranteed by their respective governments and are included in the table above.
 
In addition to the investments noted above, we hold non-U.S. dollar denominated cash and cash equivalents of $242.2 million that are also held for the purpose of hedging our net foreign currency reinsurance liabilities.
 
The net unrealized gain position of our municipal bond and corporate bond portfolios was $150.1 million and $20.3 million, respectively, as of December 31, 2011 as compared with an unrealized loss position of our municipal bond portfolio of $3.3 million and an unrealized gain position of our corporate bond portfolio of $17.5 million at December 31, 2010.  The improvement in the net unrealized position in our municipal bond portfolio was primarily attributable to a decrease in U.S. Government treasury yields.  We analyze the creditworthiness of our municipal bond and corporate bond portfolios by reviewing various performance metrics of the issuer, including financial condition, credit ratings and other public information. 
 
The net unrealized gain position of our portfolio of CMBS was $9.3 million as of December 31, 2011 as compared with $8.3 million as of December 31, 2010.  The increase in the net unrealized gain position was primarily attributable to a decrease in U.S. Government treasury yields during the year partially offset by an increase or widening of interest rate spreads. We analyze our CMBS on a periodic basis using default loss models based on the performance of the underlying loans.  Performance metrics include delinquencies, defaults, foreclosures, debt-service-coverage ratios and cumulative losses incurred.  The expected losses for a mortgage pool are compared with the current level of credit support, which generally represents the point at which our security would experience losses.  We evaluate projected cash flows as well as other factors in order to determine if a credit impairment has occurred.  Our portfolio consists primarily of senior tranches of CMBS with high credit ratings and strong credit support.
 
The net unrealized loss position of our RMBS portfolio was $9.6 million, with non-agency RMBS representing $11.3 million, as of December 31, 2011 as compared with $25.9 million, with non-agency RMBS representing $25.6 million, as of December 31, 2010.  Net impairment losses recorded in our statement of operations in 2011 significantly reduced our unrealized losses on non-agency RMBS compared with 2010.  Approximately 80% of the RMBS in our investment portfolio were issued or are guaranteed by the Government National Mortgage Association, the Federal National Mortgage Association, Federal Home Loan Mortgage Corporation, or the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation and are referred to as U.S. Government agency RMBS.  The remaining 20% of our RMBS were issued by non-agency institutions and included securities with underlying Alt-A mortgages.  The net unrealized loss position of our portfolio of sub-prime ABS was $2.3 million as of December 31, 2011 as compared with $4.4 million as of December 31, 2010.  We analyze our non-agency RMBS and sub-prime ABS on a periodic basis using default loss models based on the performance of the underlying loans.  Performance metrics include, but are not limited to, delinquencies, defaults, foreclosures, prepayment speeds and cumulative losses incurred.  The expected losses for a mortgage pool are compared with the current level of credit support, which generally represents the point at which our security would experience losses.  We evaluate projected cash flows as well as other factors in order to determine if a credit impairment has occurred.
 
We believe that the gross unrealized losses in our available-for-sale portfolio represent temporary declines in fair value.  We believe that the unrealized losses are not necessarily predictive of ultimate performance and that the provisions we have made for net impairment losses are adequate.  However, economic conditions may deteriorate more than expected and may adversely affect the expected cash flows of our securities, which in turn may lead to impairment losses recorded in future periods.  Conversely, economic conditions may improve more than expected and favorably increase the cash flows expected from these impaired securities, which would be earned through net investment income over the remaining life of the security.
 
 
- 52 -

 
 
Credit Facilities
 
On June 24, 2011, we entered into a three-year, $300.0 million credit facility (the "Syndicated Credit Facility") that amended and restated our existing credit facility, which was scheduled to expire on September 13, 2011.  The Syndicated Credit Facility consists of a $100.0 million unsecured senior credit facility available for revolving borrowings and letters of credit and a $200.0 million secured senior credit facility available for letters of credit.  Borrowings and letters of credit under the Syndicated Credit Facility are available for the working capital, liquidity and general corporate requirements of Platinum Holdings, Platinum Finance and our reinsurance subsidiaries.  Platinum Holdings and Platinum Finance have unconditionally guaranteed the obligations of our reinsurance subsidiaries under the Syndicated Credit Facility.  The Syndicated Credit Facility contains customary representations, warranties and covenants, including requirements to maintain a ratio of consolidated indebtedness to total capitalization of not greater than 0.35 to 1.0 and to maintain a consolidated tangible net worth of not less than the higher of (i) $1.25 billion or (ii) the sum of $1.258 billion plus 50% of positive net income for each fiscal year plus 75% of the aggregate increases in shareholders’ equity resulting from the issuance or sale of shares minus the amount of any extraordinary dividend payment or repurchase of shares.  Our consolidated tangible net worth was $1.54 billion, or $294.2 million greater than the minimum consolidated tangible net worth covenant of $1.25 billion as of December 31, 2011.  In addition, each of our reinsurance subsidiaries must maintain a financial strength rating from A.M. Best of at least “B++” at all times.  We are in compliance with the covenants under the Syndicated Credit Facility. The Syndicated Credit Facility provides that we may increase the lender commitments by up to $150.0 million subject to the participation of lenders.
 
In addition, on June 30, 2011, our reinsurance subsidiaries entered into a letter of credit facility in the maximum aggregate amount of $100.0 million (the “LOC Facility”) that expires on December 31, 2013.  Under the terms of the LOC Facility, up to $100.0 million is available for the issuance of letters of credit to support reinsurance obligations of our reinsurance subsidiaries.  The LOC Facility contains customary representations, warranties and covenants.  We are in compliance with the covenants under the LOC Facility.  We also have the ability to request a supplemental letter of credit facility for up to $150.0 million subject to agreement with the lender.
 
We had no cash borrowings under the Syndicated Credit Facility during the years ended December 31, 2011 and 2010.  The following table summarizes the outstanding letters of credit and the cash and cash equivalents and investments held in trust to collateralize letters of credit issued as of December 31, 2011 ($ in thousands):

   
Letters of Credit
   
Collateral
 
   
Capacity
   
Issued
   
Cash and Cash Equivalents
   
Investments
   
Total
 
Syndicated Credit Facility:
                             
Secured
  $ 200,000     $ 116,100     $ 42,960     $ 90,187     $ 133,147  
Unsecured
    100,000       -       -       -       -  
Total Syndicated Credit Facility
    300,000       116,100       42,960       90,187       133,147  
                                         
LOC Facility
    100,000       16,018       -       18,370       18,370  
Total
  $ 400,000     $ 132,118     $ 42,960     $ 108,557     $ 151,517  

Capital Resources
 
At December 31, 2011, our capital resources of $1.9 billion consisted of $1.7 billion of common shareholders’ equity and $250.0 million of debt obligations.  At December 31, 2010, our capital resources of $2.1 billion consisted of $1.9 billion of common shareholders’ equity and $250.0 million of debt obligations.  The decrease in capital during the year ended December 31, 2011 was primarily attributable to our net loss of $224.1 million, option purchases of $47.9 million and repurchases of common shares of $94.7 million, partially offset by an improvement in accumulated other comprehensive income of $171.1 million.
 
We monitor our capital adequacy on a regular basis and seek to adjust our capital according to the needs of our business.  In particular, we require capital sufficient to meet or exceed: (1) the capital adequacy ratios established by rating agencies for maintenance of appropriate financial strength ratings; (2) the surplus requirements established by our ceding companies; (3) the capital adequacy tests performed by regulatory authorities; and (4) the capital requirements under our credit facilities.  We actively manage our capital and may seek to raise additional capital or return capital to our shareholders through common share repurchases and cash dividends (or a combination of such methods).  We may also seek to manage our capital through repurchases of our outstanding debt in open market purchases, privately negotiated transactions or otherwise.  Such repurchases, if any, will depend on prevailing market conditions, our liquidity requirements, contractual restrictions or other factors.
 
To the extent that our existing capital is insufficient to fund our future operating requirements or maintain our financial strength or debt ratings, we may need to raise additional capital through financings, which may be in the form of debt securities, preferred shares, common equity, bank credit facilities providing loans and/or letters of credit, or any combination of these sources. Any equity or debt financing, if available at all, may be on terms that are unfavorable to us.  In the case of equity financings, dilution to our shareholders could result, and such securities may have rights, preferences and privileges that are senior to those of our outstanding securities. If we are not able to obtain adequate capital, our business, results of operations and financial condition could be adversely affected, which could include, among other things, the following possible outcomes: (1) potential downgrades in the financial strength ratings assigned by rating agencies to our reinsurance subsidiaries, which could place those reinsurance subsidiaries at a competitive disadvantage compared with higher-rated competitors; (2) reductions in the amount of business that our reinsurance subsidiaries are able to write in order to meet capital adequacy-based tests enforced by regulatory authorities; and (3) increases in the cost of bank credit and letters of credit.  We can provide no assurance that, if needed, we would be able to obtain additional funds through financing on satisfactory terms or at all.
 
We do not have any material commitments for capital expenditures as of December 31, 2011.
 
Financial Strength Ratings
 
Insurer financial strength ratings are current opinions of rating agencies of the financial strength of an insurance organization with respect to its ability to meet obligations under its insurance policies and contracts.   Financial strength ratings may be used by ceding companies and reinsurance intermediaries to aid in assessing the financial strength and quality of reinsurers, and thus are an important factor in evaluating and establishing their competitive positions.
 
 
- 53 -

 
 
On October 12, 2011, S&P issued a press release stating that it lowered its counterparty credit rating on Platinum Holdings from “BBB+” to “BBB” with a stable outlook and lowered its counterparty credit and financial strength ratings on our reinsurance subsidiaries, Platinum US and Platinum Bermuda, from “A” to “A-” with a stable outlook.  S&P’s press release followed our announcement on October 11, 2011 that we expected a net negative impact of approximately $112.4 million on our third quarter 2011 results due to catastrophe losses in the first nine months of the year. This action by S&P has not had a significant impact on our portfolio of existing contracts or collateral obligations, and we do not currently anticipate that it will have a material adverse impact on our business prospects, financial condition or results of operations.  Our A.M. Best ratings have not changed and remain at a financial strength rating of “A” (Excellent) with a stable outlook for each of our reinsurance subsidiaries.
 
See Item 1, “Business – Ratings” for additional discussion on our ratings.
 
Share and Debt Repurchases

Our Board of Directors has authorized the repurchase of our common shares through a share repurchase program.  Since the program was established, our Board of Directors has approved increases in the repurchase program from time to time, most recently on February 16, 2011, to result in authority as of such date to repurchase up to a total of $250.0 million of our common shares.  The following table summarizes our repurchases of common shares for the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009 ($ in thousands, except share and per share data):

Year
 
Shares Repurchased
   
Weighted Average Cost per Share (1)
   
Aggregate Amount Paid
 
2011
    2,569,068     $ 36.86     $ 94,695  
2010
    9,672,231       39.25       379,675  
2009
    7,852,498     $ 32.13     $ 252,296  

(1) Including commissions.

The shares we repurchased were canceled. In January 2011, we purchased, for an aggregate of $47.9 million in cash, the common share options issued to RenaissanceRe in connection with our initial public offering in 2002.  The options provided RenaissanceRe with the right to purchase 2,500,000 common shares from us for $27.00 per share and were subsequently amended to provide for net share settlements.  The options were purchased under our share repurchase program and were canceled.  As of December 31, 2011, the remaining amount available under the repurchase program was $176.6 million.
 
Since 2007, we have repurchased 34,791,744 shares and purchased 8,500,000 share options for a total of $1.2 billion and $146.4 million, respectively.
 
Our Board of Directors has also authorized the repurchase of up to $250.0 million of our outstanding debt obligations issued by Platinum Finance in open market purchases, privately negotiated transactions or otherwise.  We have not repurchased any of our debt obligations.
 
The timing and amount of the repurchase transactions under our repurchase programs depends on a variety of factors, including market conditions, our liquidity requirements, contractual restrictions, corporate and regulatory considerations and other factors.
 
Off-Balance Sheet Arrangements
 
We do not have any off-balance sheet arrangements, as defined for purposes of SEC rules, which are not accounted for or disclosed in the consolidated financial statements as of December 31, 2011.
 
Contractual Obligations
 
Our contractual obligations as of December 31, 2011 by estimated maturity are presented below ($ in thousands):

Contractual Obligations
 
Total
   
Less than 1 year
   
1-3 years
   
3-5 years
   
More than 5 years
 
Series B Notes due June 1, 2017 (1)
  $ 250,000     $ -     $ -     $ -     $ 250,000  
Scheduled interest payments
    103,125       18,750       37,500       37,500       9,375  
Subtotal - Debt Obligations
    353,125       18,750       37,500       37,500       259,375  
                                         
Operating Leases (2)
    4,608       2,843       1,431       297       37  
Unpaid losses and LAE (3)
  $ 2,389,614     $ 697,816     $ 814,908     $ 319,526     $ 557,364  

 
(1)
See Note 7 to the Consolidated Financial Statements contained elsewhere in this Form 10-K.
 
(2)
See Note 15 to the Consolidated Financial Statements contained elsewhere in this Form 10-K.
 
 
(3)
There are generally no notional or stated amounts related to unpaid losses and LAE.  Both the amounts and timing of future loss and LAE payments are estimates and subject to the inherent variability of legal and market conditions affecting the obligations and make the timing of cash outflows uncertain.  The ultimate amount and timing of unpaid losses and LAE could differ materially from the amounts in the table above.  Further, the unpaid losses and LAE do not represent all of the obligations that will arise under the contracts, but rather only the estimated liability incurred through December 31, 2011.  There are reinsurance contracts that have terms extending into 2012 under which additional obligations will be incurred.
 
 
- 54 -

 
 
Recently Issued Accounting Standards
 
See Note 1 to the “Consolidated Financial Statements” contained elsewhere in this Form 10-K for a discussion of recently issued accounting standards.
 
Item 7A.
Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures about Market Risk
 
We believe that we are principally exposed to the following types of market risk:  interest rate risk, credit risk, liquidity risk and foreign currency exchange rate risk.
 
Interest Rate Risk
 
We are exposed to fluctuations in interest rates.  Changes in overall interest rates, generally measured by changes in the yield on risk free investments such as U.S. Treasury securities, will influence the fair values of our fixed maturity securities portfolio.  Rising interest rates generally result in a decrease in the fair value of our fixed maturity securities portfolio.  Conversely, a decline in interest rates will generally result in an increase in the fair value of our fixed maturity securities portfolio.  Interest rate changes can also impact the timing of receipt of principal payments from mortgage-backed securities.  From time to time, we may use financial futures and options as part of a hedging strategy to manage our exposure to interest rate risk and protect our fixed maturity securities portfolio against a sudden increase in interest rates.
 
The following table shows the aggregate hypothetical impact on the fair value of our fixed maturity securities portfolio as of December 31, 2011, resulting from an immediate parallel shift in interest rates ($ in thousands):

   
Interest Rate Shift in Basis Points
 
      - 100bp       - 50bp    
Current
      + 50bp       + 100bp  
Total market value
  $ 2,929,646     $ 2,862,669     $ 2,788,700     $ 2,715,275     $ 2,644,951  
Percent change in market value
    5.1 %     2.7 %     0.0 %     (2.6 %)     (5.2 %)
Resulting net appreciation (depreciation)
  $ 140,946     $ 73,969     $ -     $ (73,425 )   $ (143,749 )

Actual shifts in interest rates may not change by the same magnitude across the maturity spectrum and, as a result, the impact on the fair value of our fixed maturity securities portfolio may be materially different from the resulting net appreciation or depreciation indicated in the table above.

Credit Risk
 
Fixed Maturity Securities
 
Our principal invested assets are fixed maturity securities, which are subject to the risk of potential losses from adverse changes in market rates and credit risk resulting from adverse changes in the borrower’s ability to meet its debt service obligations.  Credit risk is often measured by interest rate spreads representing the difference between the yield of a debt instrument and that of a U.S. Treasury security of similar maturity.  As the creditworthiness of a debt issuer declines, the interest rate spreads increase, which has the same effect on fair value as an increase in overall interest rates.  An increase or widening of interest rate spreads generally results in a decrease in the fair value of our fixed maturity securities portfolio.  Furthermore, a debt issuer may default on an interest or principal payment, in which case we may not collect all of the contractual cash flows associated with that security.
 
We manage credit risk by the selection of securities within our fixed maturity securities portfolio.  Changes in credit spreads directly affect the market value of certain fixed maturity securities, but do not necessarily result in a change in the future expected cash flows associated with holding individual securities.  Other factors, including liquidity, supply and demand, and changing risk preferences of investors, may affect market credit spreads without any change in the underlying credit quality of the security.
 
Reinsurance Premiums Receivable and Reinsurance Recoverable
 
Reinsurance premiums receivable from ceding companies are subject to credit risk.  To mitigate credit risk related to reinsurance premiums receivable, we have established standards for ceding companies and, in most cases, have a contractual right of offset thereby allowing us to settle claims net of any such reinsurance premiums receivable.  We also have reinsurance recoverable amounts from our retrocessionaires.  To mitigate credit risk related to our reinsurance recoverable amounts, we consider the financial strength of our retrocessionaires when determining whether to purchase coverage from them.  We generally obtain retrocessional coverage from companies rated “A-” or better by A.M. Best unless the retrocessionaire’s obligations are collateralized.  We routinely monitor the financial performance and rating status of all material retrocessionaires.
 
Reinsurance Brokers
 
In accordance with industry practice, we frequently pay amounts in respect of claims under contracts to reinsurance brokers for payment to the ceding companies.  In the event that a broker fails to make such a payment, we may remain liable to the ceding company for the payment.  When ceding companies remit premiums to reinsurance brokers, such premiums may be deemed to have been paid to us and the ceding company may no longer be liable to us for those amounts whether or not we actually receive the funds.  Consequently, we assume a degree of credit risk associated with our brokers during the premium and loss settlement process.
 
Liquidity Risk
 
When financial markets experience a reduction in liquidity, our ability to conduct orderly investment transactions may be limited and may result in declines in fair values of the securities in our investment portfolio.  In addition, if we require significant amounts of cash on short notice in excess of normal cash requirements (which could include claims on a major catastrophic event) in a period of market illiquidity, we may have difficulty selling our investments in a timely manner and may have to dispose of our investments for less than what may otherwise have been possible under other conditions.
 
 
- 55 -

 
 
Foreign Currency Exchange Rate Risk
 
We routinely transact business in various currencies other than the U.S. dollar, our financial reporting currency.  Our principal exposure to foreign currency exchange rate risk is the transaction of business in foreign currencies.  We may incur foreign currency exchange gains or losses as we ultimately settle claims required to be paid in foreign currencies.  To the extent we do not seek to hedge our foreign currency risk or our hedges prove ineffective, the resulting impact of a movement in foreign currency exchange rate could materially adversely affect our financial condition and results of operations.
 
We manage our exposure to large foreign currency risks by holding invested assets denominated in non-U.S. dollar currencies in amounts that generally offset liabilities denominated in the same non-U.S. dollar currencies, thereby reducing our net exposure to foreign exchange volatility.  We may, from time to time, hold more or less non-U.S. dollar denominated assets than non-U.S. dollar liabilities.  In addition, we may use foreign currency exchange contracts as part of a hedging strategy.  As of December 31, 2011 and 2010, approximately 13.2% and 6.6%, respectively, of our total investments and cash and cash equivalents were denominated in currencies other than the U.S. dollar.  Of our business written in the years ended December 31, 2011 and 2010 approximately 23.3% and 22.0%, respectively, of premiums were written in currencies other than the U.S. dollar.
 
Item 8.
Financial Statements and Supplementary Data
 
Our consolidated financial statements as of December 31, 2011 and 2010 and for each of the years in the three-year period ended December 31, 2011, together with the reports thereon by KPMG our independent registered public accounting firm for the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009, are set forth on pages F-1 through F-36 hereto.

Item 9.
Changes in and Disagreements With Accountants on Accounting and Financial Disclosure
 
None.
 
Item 9A.
Controls and Procedures
 
Disclosure Controls and Procedures
 
Our management, including the Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer, carried out an evaluation of the effectiveness of the design and operation of our disclosure controls and procedures (as such term is defined in Rules 13a-15(e) and 15d-15(e) under the Exchange Act) as of the end of the period covered by this Form 10-K.  Based on that evaluation, our management, including the Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer, concluded that our disclosure controls and procedures are effective to provide reasonable assurance that information required to be disclosed by us in reports that we file or submit under the Exchange Act is recorded, processed, summarized and timely reported as specified in the SEC’s rules and forms, and is accumulated and communicated to our management, including the Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer, as appropriate, to allow timely decisions regarding required disclosure.
 
Management’s Annual Report on Internal Control Over Financial Reporting
 
Our management, including the Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer, is responsible for establishing and maintaining adequate internal control over financial reporting (as such term is defined in Rules 13a-15(f) and 15(d)-15(f) under the Exchange Act).  Our management, under the supervision and with the participation of the Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer, conducted an evaluation of the effectiveness of our internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2011 based on the integrated framework published in September 1992 by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission.  Based on this evaluation, our management, including the Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer, concluded that our internal control over financial reporting was effective in that it provides reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America and includes those policies and procedures that provide reasonable assurance that transactions are recorded as necessary and that expenditures are being made only with proper authorization.  KPMG, the independent registered public accounting firm that audited our consolidated financial statements included in this Form 10-K, has issued an attestation report on our internal control over financial reporting, which appears below.
 
Our disclosure controls and procedures and our internal control over financial reporting were designed to provide reasonable assurances that their objectives would be met.  Our management, including the Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer, does not expect that our disclosure controls and procedures or our internal control over financial reporting will prevent all error and all fraud.  A control system, no matter how well conceived and operated, can provide only reasonable, not absolute, assurance that the objectives of the control system are met.  Further, the design of a control system must reflect the fact that there are resource constraints, and the benefits of controls must be considered relative to their costs.  Because of the inherent limitations in all control systems, no evaluation of controls can provide absolute assurance that all control issues and instances of fraud, if any, within the Company have been detected.
 
Changes in Internal Control over Financial Reporting
 
No changes occurred during the three months ended December 31, 2011 in our internal control over financial reporting that have materially affected, or are reasonably likely to materially affect, our internal control over financial reporting.
 
 
- 56 -

 

 
REPORT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM
 
The Board of Directors and Shareholders
Platinum Underwriters Holdings, Ltd.:
 
We have audited Platinum Underwriters Holdings, Ltd. and subsidiaries’ internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2011, based on criteria established in Internal Control – Integrated Framework issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (COSO). The Company’s management is responsible for maintaining effective internal control over financial reporting and for its assessment of the effectiveness of internal control over financial reporting, included in the accompanying December 31, 2011 annual report on Form 10-K. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on the Company’s internal control over financial reporting based on our audit.
 
We conducted our audit in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States). Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether effective internal control over financial reporting was maintained in all material respects. Our audit included obtaining an understanding of internal control over financial reporting, assessing the risk that a material weakness exists, and testing and evaluating the design and operating effectiveness of internal control based on the assessed risk. Our audit also included performing such other procedures as we considered necessary in the circumstances. We believe that our audit provides a reasonable basis for our opinion.
 
A company’s internal control over financial reporting is a process designed to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles. A company’s internal control over financial reporting includes those policies and procedures that (1) pertain to the maintenance of records that, in reasonable detail, accurately and fairly reflect the transactions and dispositions of the assets of the company; (2) provide reasonable assurance that transactions are recorded as necessary to permit preparation of financial statements in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles, and that receipts and expenditures of the company are being made only in accordance with authorizations of management and directors of the company; and (3) provide reasonable assurance regarding prevention or timely detection of unauthorized acquisition, use, or disposition of the company’s assets that could have a material effect on the financial statements.
 
Because of its inherent limitations, internal control over financial reporting may not prevent or detect misstatements. Also, projections of any evaluation of effectiveness to future periods are subject to the risk that controls may become inadequate because of changes in conditions, or that the degree of compliance with the policies or procedures may deteriorate.
 
In our opinion, Platinum Underwriters Holdings, Ltd. maintained, in all material respects, effective internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2011, based on criteria established in Internal Control – Integrated Framework issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission.
 
We also have audited, in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States), the consolidated balance sheets of Platinum Underwriters Holdings, Ltd. and subsidiaries as of December 31, 2011 and 2010, and the related consolidated statements of operations and comprehensive income (loss), shareholders’ equity and cash flows for each of the years in the three-year period ended December 31, 2011, and our report dated February 21, 2012 expressed an unqualified opinion on those consolidated financial statements.
 

 
/s/ KPMG
 
Hamilton, Bermuda
February 21, 2012

 
- 57 -

 
 
Item 9B. 
Other Information
 
None.

PART III
 
Item 10.
Directors, Executive Officers and Corporate Governance
 
The information required by this Item relating to our directors, executive officers and corporate governance is incorporated herein by reference to information included under the headings “Proposal 1 – Election of Directors – Information Concerning Nominees”, “Corporate Governance – Standing Committees of the Board of Directors – Governance Committee – Director Nomination Process”, “Information Concerning Executive Officers”, “Corporate Governance – Standing Committees of the Board of Directors – Audit Committee”, and “Section 16(a) Beneficial Ownership Reporting Compliance” of our definitive proxy statement to be filed pursuant to Regulation 14A of the Exchange Act for our 2012 Annual General Meeting of Shareholders (our “Proxy Statement”).  We intend to file our Proxy Statement prior to April 30, 2012.
 
Code of Ethics
 
We have adopted a written Code of Ethics within the meaning of Item 406 of Regulation S-K of the Exchange Act.  Our Code of Ethics applies to all of our directors and employees including, without limitation, our principal executive officer, our principal financial officer, our principal accounting officer and all of our employees performing financial or accounting functions.  A copy of our Code of Ethics is posted on our website at www.platinumre.com and may be found under the “Investor Relations” section by clicking on “Corporate Governance”.  In the event that we make any amendment to, or grant any waiver from, a provision of our Code of Ethics that requires disclosure under Item 5.05 of Form 8-K, in addition to filing a Form 8-K we will post such information on our website at the location specified above.  We will provide, without charge, a copy of our Code of Ethics to any person submitting such request to our corporate secretary at our principal executive offices.
 
Item 11.
Executive Compensation
 
The information required by this Item relating to executive compensation is incorporated herein by reference to information included under the headings “Director Compensation”, “Executive Compensation”, “Corporate Governance – Compensation Committee Interlocks and Insider Participation”, and “Compensation Committee Report” of our Proxy Statement.
 
Item 12.
Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners and Management and Related Shareholder Matters
 
The information required by this Item relating to security ownership of certain beneficial owners and management is incorporated herein by reference to information included under the heading “Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners and Management” of our Proxy Statement.
 
Equity Based Compensation Information
 
The following table summarizes information as of December 31, 2011 relating to our equity based compensation plans pursuant to which grants of options, restricted shares, restricted share units or other rights to acquire shares may be granted from time to time.
 
Plan Category
 
(a)
Number of Securities to be Issued Upon Exercise of Outstanding Options, Warrants and Rights(2)
   
(b)
Weighted Average Exercise Price of Outstanding Options, Warrants and Rights(3)
   
(c)
Number of Securities Remaining Available for Future Issuance Under Equity Compensation Plans (excluding securities reflected in column (a))
 
Equity compensation plans approved by security holders (1)
    1,782,229     $ 31.90       2,951,351  
Equity compensation plans not approved by security holders
    -       -       -  
Total
    1,782,229     $ 31.90       2,951,351  

(1)  
These plans consist of the 2002 Share Incentive Plan, which was approved by our shareholders at the 2004 Annual General Meeting of Shareholders; the 2006 Share Incentive Plan, which was approved by our shareholders at the 2006 Annual General Meeting of Shareholders; the 2010 Share Incentive Plan, which was approved by our shareholders at the 2010 Annual General Meeting of Shareholders; and the Share Unit Plan for Nonemployee Directors, which was approved by our sole shareholder prior to our initial public offering in 2002.  The 2010 Share Incentive Plan replaced the 2006 Share Incentive Plan, which replaced the 2002 Share Incentive Plan, and no shares remain available for issuance under the 2006 or 2002 Share Incentive Plans.  The Share Unit Plan for Nonemployee Directors was terminated on February 22, 2010 as to all future awards, and no shares remain available for issuance under such plan.
(2)  
Column (a) includes outstanding options, restricted share units, and equity accounted performance based share awards.  Performance based share awards are reflected at the maximum potential payout.  In addition, a total of 145,999 unvested restricted shares are excluded from column (a) as those shares are considered issued at the time of grant.  Unvested restricted shares are also excluded from column (c) as they are no longer available for future issuance.
(3)  
Restricted share units and performance based share awards are excluded from column (b) as there is no consideration due upon vesting of these awards.
 
 
- 58 -

 
 
Item 13.
Certain Relationships and Related Transactions, and Director Independence
 
The information required by this Item relating to certain relationships and related transactions and director independence is incorporated by reference to information contained under the headings “Transactions with Related Persons” and “Corporate Governance – Independence of Directors” of our Proxy Statement.
 
Item 14.
Principal Accountant Fees and Services
 
The information required by this Item relating to principal accountant fees and services is incorporated herein by reference to information contained under the heading “Proposal 3 – Approval of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm for the 2012 Fiscal Year” of our Proxy Statement.
 

PART IV
 
Item 15.
Exhibits and Financial Statement Schedules

Financial Statements
 
Our consolidated financial statements as of December 31, 2011 and 2010 and for each of the years in the three-year period ended December 31, 2011, together with the reports thereon by KPMG our independent registered public accounting firm for the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009, are set forth on pages F-1 through F-36 hereto.

Schedules Supporting Financial Statements
 
The schedules relating to our consolidated financial statements as of December 31, 2011 and 2010 and for each of the three years in the period ended December 31, 2011, together with the independent registered public accounting firm report thereon, are set forth on pages S-1 through S-8 hereto.  Schedules not referred to have been omitted as inapplicable or not required by Regulation S-X or information required is provided elsewhere in the consolidated financial statements.

Exhibits
 
 
Exhibit Number
 
Description
     
  2.1  
Formation and Separation Agreement dated October 28, 2002 between The St. Paul Companies, Inc. and Platinum Holdings. (2)
  3(i).1  
Memorandum of Association of Platinum Holdings. (1)
3(ii).1
 
Amended and Restated Bye-Laws of Platinum Holdings. (22)
  4.1  
Form of Certificate of the Common Shares of Platinum Holdings. (2)
  4.2  
Indenture dated October 10, 2002 among Platinum Holdings, Platinum Finance and JP Morgan Chase. (2)
  4.3  
Indenture Supplement dated November 1, 2002 among Platinum Holdings, Platinum Finance and JP Morgan Chase. (2)
  4.4  
Second Supplemental Indenture dated August 16, 2005 between Platinum Holdings, Platinum Finance and JP Morgan Chase. (10)
  4.5  
Indenture dated May 26, 2005 between Platinum Holdings, Platinum Finance and JP Morgan Chase. (8)
  4.6  
First Supplemental Indenture dated May 26, 2005 between Platinum Holdings, Platinum Finance and JP Morgan Chase. (8)
  4.7  
Second Supplemental Indenture dated as of November 2, 2005 among Platinum Finance, Platinum Holdings and JP Morgan Chase. (11)
  4.8  
Purchase Contract Agreement dated November 1, 2002 between Platinum Holdings and JP Morgan Chase. (2)
  4.9  
Form of Senior Note of Platinum Finance. (2)
  4.10  
Form of Guarantee of Platinum Holdings. (2)
  4.11  
Exchange and Registration Rights Agreement dated May 26, 2005 among Platinum  Holdings, Platinum Finance and Goldman, Sachs & Co. (8)
  4.12  
Exchange and Registration Rights Agreement dated August 16, 2005 between Platinum Holdings, Platinum Finance, and Goldman, Sachs & Co. and Merrill Lynch. (10)
  10.1 *
Amended and Restated Share Unit Plan for Nonemployee Directors. (20)
  10.2 *
Amendment of Amended and Restated Share Unit Plan for Nonemployee Directors. (19)
  10.3 *
Form of Nonemployee Director Share Unit Award Agreement. (12)
  10.4 *
Summary of Platinum Holdings’ Nonemployee Director Compensation Program. (19)
  10.5 *
2002 Share Incentive Plan (2004 Update). (4)
  10.6 *
2006 Share Incentive Plan. (14)
  10.7 *
2010 Share Incentive Plan. (22)
  10.8 *
Amended and Restated Annual Incentive Plan. (13)
  10.9 *
Form of AIP Restricted Share Unit Award Agreement. (15)
  10.10 *
Section 162(m) Performance Incentive Plan. (21)
  10.11 *
Platinum US Executive Retirement Savings Plan. (29)
  10.12 *
Arrangement for Compensation in Lieu of Participation in Executive Retirement Savings Plan. (19)
  10.13 *
Platinum Holdings International Pension Plan. (29)
  10.14 *
Amended and Restated Executive Incentive Plan. (17)
  10.15 *
Form of EIP Share Unit Award Agreement (for awards for 2008-2010 performance cycle). (16)
  10.16 *
Form of EIP Share Unit Award Agreement (for awards providing for payment in common shares). (18)
  10.17 *
Form of EIP Share Unit Award Agreement (for awards providing for payment in cash). (27)
  10.18 *
Capital Accumulation Plan. (2)
  10.19 *
Form of Nonqualified Share Option Agreement (Employee) (for awards made prior to July 23, 2008). (5)
 
 
- 59 -

 
 
 
  10.20 *
Form of Nonqualified Share Option Agreement (Employee). (18)
  10.21 *
Form of Nonqualified Share Option Agreement (New Nonemployee Director). (5)
  10.22 *
Form of Nonqualified Share Option Agreement (Annual Nonemployee Director). (5)
  10.23 *
Form of Time-Based Share Unit Award Agreement (for awards made prior to July 23, 2008). (5)
  10.24 *
Form of Time-Based Share Unit Award Agreement. (18)
  10.25 *
Form of Special Share Unit Award Agreement. (5)
  10.26 *
Form of Restricted Share Award Agreement (for awards made prior to July 23, 2008). (5)
  10.27 *
Form of Restricted Share Award Agreement. (17)
  10.28 *
Form of EIP Share Unit Award Agreement (for awards providing for payment in Common Shares) (31)
  10.29 *
Form of EIP Share Unit Award Agreement (for awards providing for payment in cash) (31)
  10.30 *
Form of Supplemental EIP Share Unit Award Agreement (for awards for the 2012-2013 performance cycle payable in Common Shares) (31)
  10.31 *
Form of Market Share Unit Award Agreement (31)
  10.32 *
Amended and Restated Change in Control Severance Plan. (17)
  10.33 *
Amended and Restated Employee Severance Plan. (17)
  10.34 *
Amended and Restated Employment Agreement dated July 22, 2010 between Michael E. Lombardozzi and Platinum Holdings and Letter Agreement dated September 1, 2011 between Michael E. Lombardozzi and Platinum Administrative Services, Inc. attached as Exhibit B thereto. (24)
  10.35 *
Amended and Restated Employment Agreement dated July 22, 2010 between Michael D. Price and Platinum Holdings. (24)
  10.36 *
Amended and Restated Employment Agreement dated October 27, 2010 between Robert S. Porter and Platinum Bermuda. (26)
  10.37 *
Amended and Restated Employment Agreement dated October 27, 2010 between H. Elizabeth Mitchell and Platinum US. (26)
  10.38  
Employment Agreement dated April 29, 2010 between Platinum Holdings and Allan C. Decleir. (23)
  10.39  
Letter Agreement dated April 29, 2010 between James A. Krantz and Platinum Holdings and Consulting Agreement dated April 29, 2010 between James A. Krantz and Platinum Administrative Services, Inc. attached as Exhibit A thereto. (23)
  10.40  
Letter Agreement dated February 22, 2006 between Kenneth A. Kurtzman and Platinum Administrative Services, Inc.
  10.41  
Letter Agreement dated October 27, 2010 between Kenneth A. Kurtzman and Platinum Administrative Services, Inc.
  10.42  
Investment  Management Agreement dated May 12, 2005 between Platinum US and Hyperion Capital Management, Inc. (6)
  10.43  
Investment  Management Agreement dated May 12, 2005 between Platinum Bermuda and Hyperion Capital Management, Inc. (6)
  10.44  
Investment Management Agreement dated May 12, 2005 between Platinum Holdings, Platinum Bermuda, Platinum Regency and BlackRock Financial Management, Inc. (6)
  10.45  
Investment Management Agreement dated May 12, 2005 between Platinum US, Platinum Finance and BlackRock Financial Management, Inc. (6)
  10.46  
Second Amended and Restated Credit Agreement, dated as of June 24, 2011, by and among the Company, Platinum Bermuda, Platinum US, Platinum Finance, the Lenders party thereto, ING Bank N.V., London Branch, as Documentation Agent, U.S. Bank National Association, as Syndication Agent, and Wells Fargo Bank, National Association, as Administrative Agent. (30)
  10.47  
List of Contents of Exhibits and Schedules to the Second Amended and Restated Credit Agreement.  The Company agrees to furnish supplementally a copy of any omitted exhibit or schedule to the SEC upon request. (30)
  10.48  
Guaranty dated December 31, 2003 between Platinum Holdings and Platinum US. (3)
  10.49  
Amendment No. 1 dated January 1, 2005 to Guaranty dated December 31, 2003 between Platinum Holdings and Platinum US. (9)
  10.50  
Purchase Agreement dated May 20, 2005 among Platinum Holdings, Platinum Finance and Goldman, Sachs & Co. (7)
  10.51  
Remarketing Agreement dated August 8, 2005 among Platinum Holdings, Platinum Finance, Goldman, Sachs & Co. and Merrill Lynch. (9)
  10.52  
Pledge Agreement dated November 1, 2002 among Platinum Holdings, State Street Bank and Trust Company and JP Morgan Chase. (2)
  10.53  
Purchase Agreement dated as of October 13, 2010 between Platinum Holdings and The Travelers Companies, Inc. (25)
  10.54  
Purchase Agreement dated January 17, 2011 between Platinum Holdings, RenaissanceRe and Renaissance Other Investments Holdings II Ltd. (28)
  10.55  
Termination Agreement dated as of January 17, 2011 between Platinum US, Platinum Bermuda and Renaissance Underwriting Managers Ltd. (28)
  10.56  
Committed Letter of Credit Issuance Facility Letter dated June 30, 2011 among Platinum Bermuda, Platinum US, the Company (solely for purposes of paragraph 9.2 thereof) and Citibank Europe plc. (30)
  10.57  
Insurance Letters of Credit Master Agreement dated June 30, 2011 among Platinum Bermuda, Platinum US and Citibank Europe plc. (30)
  14.1  
Code of Business Conduct and Ethics. (17)
  21.1  
Subsidiaries of Platinum Holdings. (21)
  23.1  
Consent of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm.
  31.1  
Certification of Michael D. Price, Chief Executive Officer of Platinum Holdings, pursuant to Rule 13a-14(a) or Rule 15d-14(a) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended.
  31.2  
Certification of Allan C. Decleir, Chief Financial Officer of Platinum Holdings, pursuant to Rule 13a-14(a) or Rule 15d-14(a) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended.
  32.1  
Certification of Michael D. Price, Chief Executive Officer of Platinum Holdings, pursuant to 18 U.S.C. Section 1350, as adopted pursuant to section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002.
  32.2  
Certification of Allan C. Decleir, Chief Financial Officer of Platinum Holdings, pursuant to 18 U.S.C. Section 1350, as adopted pursuant to section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002.
  101  
Interactive data files pursuant to Rule 405 of Regulation S-T:  (i) the Consolidated Balance Sheets as of December 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010, (ii) the Consolidated Statements of Operations and Comprehensive Income for the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009, (iii) the Consolidated Statements of Shareholders’ Equity for the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009, (iv) the Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows for years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009 and (v) the Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements for the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009.
_______________________
 
*   Items denoted with an asterisk represent management contracts or compensatory plans or arrangements.
 
 
- 60 -

 

(1)  
Incorporated by reference from the Registration Statement on Form S-1 (Registration No. 333-86906) of Platinum Holdings.
 
(2)  
Incorporated by reference from Platinum Holdings’ Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2002, filed with the SEC on March 31, 2003.
 
(3)  
Incorporated by reference from Platinum Holdings’ Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2003, filed with the SEC on March 15, 2004.
 
(4)  
Incorporated by reference from Platinum Holdings’ Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended March 31, 2004, filed with the SEC on May 10, 2004.
 
(5)  
Incorporated by reference from Platinum Holdings’ Current Report on Form 8-K, filed with the SEC on February 23, 2005.
 
(6)  
Incorporated by reference from Platinum Holdings’ Current Report on Form 8-K, filed with the SEC on May 13, 2005.
 
(7)  
Incorporated by reference from Platinum Holdings’ Current Report on Form 8-K, filed with the SEC on May 24, 2005.
 
(8)  
Incorporated by reference from Platinum Holdings’ Current Report on Form 8-K, filed with the SEC on May 27, 2005.
 
(9)  
Incorporated by reference from Platinum Holdings’ Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended June 30, 2005, filed with the SEC on August 5, 2005.
 
(10)  
Incorporated by reference from Platinum Holdings’ Current Report on Form 8-K, filed with the SEC on August 17, 2005.
 
(11)  
Incorporated by reference from Platinum Holdings’ Current Report on Form 8-K, filed with the SEC on November 3, 2005.
 
(12)  
Incorporated by reference from Platinum Holdings’ Current Report on Form 8-K, filed with the SEC on February 27, 2006.
 
(13)  
Incorporated by reference from Platinum Holding’s Current Report on Form 8-K, filed with the SEC on February 22, 2007.
 
(14)  
Incorporated by reference from the Registration Statement on Form S-8 (Registration No. 333-133521) of Platinum Holdings, filed with the SEC on April 25, 2006.
 
(15)  
Incorporated by reference from Platinum Holdings’ Current Report on Form 8-K, filed with the SEC on December 6, 2007.
 
(16)  
Incorporated by reference from Platinum Holdings’ Current Report on Form 8-K filed with the SEC on February 25, 2008.
 
(17)  
Incorporated by reference from Platinum Holdings’ Current Report on Form 8-K filed with the SEC on July 25, 2008.
 
(18)  
Incorporated by reference from Platinum Holdings’ Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended June 30, 2008, filed with the SEC on July 30, 2008.
 
(19)  
Incorporated by reference from Platinum Holdings’ Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2008, filed with the SEC on February 27, 2009.
 
(20)  
Incorporated by reference from Platinum Holdings’ Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended March 31, 2009, filed with the SEC on May 4, 2009.
 
(21)  
Incorporated by reference from Platinum Holdings’ Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2009, filed with the SEC on February 24, 2010.
 
(22)  
Incorporated by reference from the Registration Statement on Form S-8 (Registration No. 333-166368) of Platinum Holdings, filed with the SEC on April 29, 2010.
 
(23)  
Incorporated by reference from Platinum Holdings’ Current Report on Form 8-K filed with the SEC on April 30, 2010.
 
(24)  
Incorporated by reference from Platinum Holdings’ Current Report on Form 8-K filed with the SEC on July 23, 2010.
 
(25)  
Incorporated by reference from Platinum Holdings’ Current Report on Form 8-K filed with the SEC on October 14, 2010.
 
(26)  
Incorporated by reference from Platinum Holdings’ Current Report on Form 8-K filed with the SEC on October 28, 2010.
 
(27)  
Incorporated by reference from Platinum Holdings’ Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended September 30, 2010, filed with the SEC on October 29, 2010.
 
(28)  
Incorporated by reference from Platinum Holdings’ Current Report on Form 8-K filed with the SEC on January 18, 2011.
 
(29)  
Incorporated by reference from Platinum Holdings’ Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2010, filed with the SEC on February 18, 2011.
 
(30)  
Incorporated by reference from Platinum Holdings’ Current Report on Form 8-K filed with the SEC on June 30, 2011.
 
(31)  
Incorporated by reference from Platinum Holdings’ Current Report on Form 8-K filed with the SEC on February 12, 2012.
 
 
- 61 -

 
 
SIGNATURES
 
Pursuant to the requirements of Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, the Registrant has duly caused this report to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized.
 
 
PLATINUM UNDERWRITERS HOLDINGS, LTD.
 
       
Date: February 21, 2012
By:
/s/ Michael D. Price  
   
Michael D. Price
 
   
President and Chief Executive Officer
 
       
 
Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, this report has been signed below by the following persons on behalf of the registrant and in the capacities and on the dates indicated.
 
Signature
 
Title
 
Date
         
s/s Michael D. Price        
Michael D. Price
 
President, Chief Executive Officer and Director (Principal Executive Officer)
 
February 21, 2012
         
s/s Allan C. Decleir
Allan C. Decleir
 
Executive Vice President and Chief Financial Officer (Principal Financial Officer and Principal Accounting Officer)
 
February 21, 2012
         
s/s Dan R. Carmichael
Dan R. Carmichael
 
Chairman of the Board of Directors
 
February 21, 2012
         
s/s A. John Hass
A. John Hass
 
Director
 
February 21, 2012
         
s/s Antony P.D. Lancaster
Antony P.D. Lancaster
 
Director
 
February 21, 2012
         
s/s Edmund R. Megna
Edmund R. Megna
 
Director
 
February 21, 2012
         
s/s James P. Slattery
James P. Slattery
 
Director
 
February 21, 2012
         
s/s Christopher J. Steffen
Christopher J. Steffen
 
Director
 
February 21, 2012
 

 
- 62 -

 

 
PLATINUM UNDERWRITERS HOLDINGS, LTD. AND SUBSIDIARIES
 
CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
 
 
Table of Contents
 

 
Page
Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm
F-2
Consolidated Balance Sheets as of December 31, 2011 and 2010
F-3
Consolidated Statements of Operations and Comprehensive Income (Loss) for the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009
F-4
Consolidated Statements of Shareholders' Equity for the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009
F-5
Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows for the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009
F-6
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
F-7
 

 
F-1

 

 
REPORT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM
 

 
The Board of Directors and Shareholders
Platinum Underwriters Holdings, Ltd.:

 
We have audited the accompanying consolidated balance sheets of Platinum Underwriters Holdings, Ltd. and subsidiaries as of December 31, 2011 and 2010, and the related consolidated statements of operations and comprehensive income (loss), shareholders’ equity and cash flows for each of the years in the three-year period ended December 31, 2011. These consolidated financial statements are the responsibility of the Company’s management. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on these consolidated financial statements based on our audits.
 
We conducted our audits in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States).  Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material misstatement.  An audit includes examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements. An audit also includes assessing the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, as well as evaluating the overall financial statement presentation.  We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinion.
 
In our opinion, the consolidated financial statements referred to above present fairly, in all material respects, the financial position of Platinum Underwriters Holdings, Ltd. and subsidiaries as of December 31, 2011 and 2010, and the results of their operations and their cash flows for each of the years in the three-year period ended December 31, 2011, in conformity with U.S. generally accepted accounting principles.
 
As discussed in note 1 to the consolidated financial statements, the Company changed the manner in which it accounts for other-than-temporary impairments of debt securities in 2009.
 
We also have audited, in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States), Platinum Underwriters Holdings, Ltd. and subsidiaries’ internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2011, based on criteria established in Internal Control - Integrated Framework issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (COSO), and our report dated February 21, 2012 expressed an unqualified opinion on the effectiveness of the Company’s internal control over financial reporting.
 

 
/s/ KPMG
 
Hamilton, Bermuda
February 21, 2012

 
F-2

 
 
Platinum Underwriters Holdings, Ltd. and Subsidiaries
CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEETS
December 31, 2011 and 2010
($ in thousands, except share data)
 
   
2011
   
2010
 
ASSETS
           
Investments:
           
Fixed maturity available-for-sale securities at fair value (amortized cost - $2,494,710 and $2,889,502, respectively)
  $ 2,663,574     $ 2,865,827  
Fixed maturity trading securities at fair value (amortized cost - $115,156 and $174,631, respectively)
    125,126       182,146  
Short-term investments
    588,834       176,648  
Total investments
    3,377,534       3,224,621  
Cash and cash equivalents
    792,510       987,877  
Accrued investment income
    29,440       31,288  
Reinsurance premiums receivable
    159,387       162,682  
Reinsurance recoverable on unpaid and paid losses and loss adjustment expenses
    6,302       13,973  
Prepaid reinsurance premiums
    8,360       4,461  
Funds held by ceding companies
    94,546       84,078  
Deferred acquisition costs
    28,779       36,584  
Deferred tax assets
    31,613       47,777  
Other assets
    23,140       20,972  
Total assets
  $ 4,551,611     $ 4,614,313  
                 
LIABILITIES AND SHAREHOLDERS’ EQUITY
               
Liabilities
               
Unpaid losses and loss adjustment expenses
  $ 2,389,614     $ 2,217,378  
Unearned premiums
    121,164       154,975  
Debt obligations
    250,000       250,000  
Commissions payable
    62,773       59,388  
Other liabilities
    37,201       37,117  
Total liabilities
  $ 2,860,752     $ 2,718,858  
                 
Shareholders’ Equity
               
Common shares, $0.01 par value, 200,000,000 shares authorized, 35,526,400 and 37,757,926 shares issued and outstanding, respectively
  $ 355     $ 377  
Additional paid-in capital
    313,730       453,619  
Accumulated other comprehensive income (loss)
    146,635       (24,488 )
Retained earnings
    1,230,139       1,465,947  
Total shareholders' equity
  $ 1,690,859     $ 1,895,455  
                 
Total liabilities and shareholders' equity
  $ 4,551,611     $ 4,614,313  
 
 See accompanying notes to consolidated financial statements.
 
 
F-3

 
 
Platinum Underwriters Holdings, Ltd. and Subsidiaries
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF OPERATIONS AND COMPREHENSIVE INCOME (LOSS)
For the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009
($ in thousands, except per share data)

   
2011
   
2010
   
2009
 
Revenue:
                 
Net premiums earned
  $ 689,452     $ 779,994     $ 937,336  
Net investment income
    125,863       134,385       163,941  
Net realized gains on investments
    3,934       107,791       78,630  
Total other-than-temporary impairment losses
    (8,895 )     (31,028 )     (34,010 )
Portion of impairment losses recognized in accumulated other comprehensive income (loss)
    (13,475 )     (5,582 )     16,407  
Net impairment losses on investments
    (22,370 )     (36,610 )     (17,603 )
Other income (expense)
    645       (207 )     3,084  
Total revenue
    797,524       985,353       1,165,388  
                         
Expenses:
                       
Net losses and loss adjustment expenses
    805,437       467,420       478,342  
Net acquisition expenses
    133,177       146,676       176,419  
Net changes in fair value of derivatives
    4,329       9,588       9,741  
Operating expenses
    63,179       82,636       94,682  
Net foreign currency exchange losses (gains)
    (473 )     1,385       (399 )
Interest expense
    19,072       18,996       19,027  
Total expenses
    1,024,721       726,701       777,812  
                         
Income (loss) before income taxes
    (227,197 )     258,652       387,576  
Income tax expense (benefit)
    (3,133 )     43,154       4,285  
Net income (loss)
    (224,064 )     215,498       383,291  
Preferred dividends
    -       -       1,301  
Net income (loss) attributable to common shareholders
  $ (224,064 )   $ 215,498     $ 381,990  
                         
Earnings (loss) per common share:
                       
Basic earnings (loss) per common share
  $ (6.04 )   $ 5.14     $ 7.71  
Diluted earnings (loss) per common share
  $ (6.04 )   $ 4.78     $ 7.33  
                         
Comprehensive income (loss):
                       
Net income (loss)
  $ (224,064 )   $ 215,498     $ 383,291  
Other comprehensive income – net change in unrealized gains and losses on available-for-sale
securities, net of deferred taxes
    171,123       45,517       133,226  
Comprehensive income (loss)
  $ (52,941 )   $ 261,015     $ 516,517  
                         
Shareholder dividends:
                       
Preferred shareholder dividends declared
  $ -     $ -     $ 2,602  
Dividends declared per preferred share
    -       -       0.45  
Common shareholder dividends declared
    11,744       13,403       16,099  
Dividends declared per common share
  $ 0.32     $ 0.32     $ 0.32  
 
See accompanying notes to consolidated financial statements.
 
 
F-4

 
 
Platinum Underwriters Holdings, Ltd. and Subsidiaries
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF SHAREHOLDERS’ EQUITY
For the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009
($ in thousands)

   
2011
   
2010
   
2009
 
Preferred shares:
                 
Balances at beginning of year
  $ -     $ -     $ 57  
Conversion of preferred shares
    -       -       (57 )
Balances at end of year
    -       -       -  
Common shares:
                       
Balances at beginning of year
    377       459       475  
Exercise of common share options
    -       11       3  
Issuance of common shares
    -       1       1  
Settlement of equity awards
    4       3       2  
Conversion of preferred shares
    -       -       57  
Repurchase of common shares
    (26 )     (97 )     (79 )
Balances at end of year
    355       377       459  
Additional paid-in capital:
                       
Balances at beginning of year
    453,619       883,425       1,114,135  
Exercise of common share options
    1,244       34,614       6,756  
Issuance of common shares
    2       4       246  
Share based compensation
    3,819       14,338       15,629  
Settlement of equity awards
    (2,772 )     (1,012 )     (1,100 )
Repurchase of common shares
    (94,669 )     (379,578 )     (252,217 )
Purchase of common share options
    (47,900 )     (98,520 )     -  
Income tax (expense) benefit from share based compensation
    387       348       (24 )
Balances at end of year
    313,730       453,619       883,425  
Accumulated other comprehensive income (loss):
                       
Balances at beginning of year
    (24,488 )     (70,005 )     (188,987 )
Cumulative effect of accounting change, net of deferred tax
    -       -       (14,244 )
Net change in unrealized gains and losses on available-for-sale securities, net of deferred taxes:
                       
Change in unrealized gains and losses
    158,796       40,657       147,994  
Non-credit component of impairment losses
    12,327       4,860       (14,768 )
Balances at end of year
    146,635       (24,488 )     (70,005 )
Retained earnings:
                       
Balances at beginning of year
    1,465,947       1,263,852       883,717  
Cumulative effect of accounting change, net of deferred tax
    -       -       14,244  
Net income (loss)
    (224,064 )     215,498       383,291  
Preferred share dividends
    -       -       (1,301 )
Common share dividends
    (11,744 )     (13,403 )     (16,099 )
Balances at end of year
    1,230,139       1,465,947       1,263,852  
Total shareholders' equity
  $ 1,690,859     $ 1,895,455     $ 2,077,731  
 
See accompanying notes to consolidated financial statements.
 
 
F-5

 
 
Platinum Underwriters Holdings, Ltd. and Subsidiaries
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS
For the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009
($ in thousands)

   
2011
   
2010
   
2009
 
Operating Activities:
                 
Net income (loss)
  $ (224,064 )   $ 215,498     $ 383,291  
Adjustments to reconcile net income (loss) to cash provided by (used in) operations:
                       
Depreciation and amortization
    4,265       11,683       16,170  
Net realized gains on investments
    (3,934 )     (107,791 )     (78,630 )
Net impairment losses on investments
    22,370       36,610       17,603  
Net foreign currency exchange losses (gains)
    (473 )     1,385       (399 )
Share-based compensation
    3,819       14,338       15,629  
Deferred income tax expense (benefit)
    (5,250 )     10,498       (3,523 )
Net fixed maturity trading securities activities
    31,365       (43,617 )     208,197  
Changes in assets and liabilities:
                       
Decrease (increase) in accrued investment income
    1,615       (1,313 )     (471 )
Decrease in reinsurance premiums receivable
    3,825       106,409       37,361  
Decrease (increase) in funds held by ceding companies
    (11,637 )     349       51,675  
Decrease in deferred acquisition costs
    7,788       3,851       10,436  
Increase (decrease) in net unpaid and paid losses and loss adjustment expenses
    174,858       (126,942 )     (132,809 )
Decrease in net unearned premiums
    (37,938 )     (19,404 )     (39,504 )
Increase (decrease) in commissions payable
    3,379       (31,100 )     (35,235 )
Changes in other assets and liabilities
    (3,694 )     (45,725 )     27,406  
Net cash provided by (used in) operating activities
    (33,706 )     24,729       477,197  
                         
Investing Activities:
                       
Proceeds from sale of fixed maturity available-for-sale securities
    466,759       3,341,811       1,538,633  
Proceeds from sale of fixed maturity trading securities
    20,413       -       153,223  
Proceeds from sale of preferred stocks
    -       5,176       -  
Proceeds from sale of short-term investments
    52,695       17,110       365,676  
Proceeds from maturity or paydown of fixed maturity available-for-sale securities
    125,795       227,074       434,883  
Proceeds from maturity of fixed maturity trading securities
    5,000       -       -  
Proceeds from maturity of short-term investments
    583,999       459,325       67,450  
Proceeds from sale of investment-related derivatives
    7,778       -       -  
Acquisition of fixed maturity available-for-sale securities
    (223,675 )     (2,687,690 )     (2,361,313 )
Acquisition of fixed maturity trading securities
    -       -       (164,748 )
Acquisition of short-term investments
    (1,053,552 )     (624,488 )     (384,093 )
Acquisition of investment-related derivatives
    (9,423 )     -       -  
Net cash provided by (used in) investing activities
    (24,211 )     738,318       (350,289 )
                         
Financing Activities:
                       
Dividends paid to preferred shareholders
    -       -       (2,602 )
Dividends paid to common shareholders
    (11,744 )     (13,403 )     (16,099 )
Repurchase of common shares
    (94,695 )     (379,675 )     (252,296 )
Purchase of common share options
    (47,900 )     (98,520 )     -  
Proceeds from exercise of common share options
    1,246       34,625       6,759  
Net cash provided by (used in) financing activities
    (153,093 )     (456,973 )     (264,238 )
                         
Effect of foreign currency exchange rate changes on cash
    15,643       (981 )     7,097  
Net increase (decrease) in cash and cash equivalents
    (195,367 )     305,093       (130,233 )
Cash and cash equivalents at beginning of year
    987,877       682,784       813,017  
Cash and cash equivalents at end of year
  $ 792,510     $ 987,877     $ 682,784  
                         
Supplemental disclosures of cash flow information:
                       
Income taxes paid (recovered)
  $ 981     $ 40,490     $ (6,851 )
Interest paid
  $ 18,750     $ 18,750     $ 18,750  

See accompanying notes to consolidated financial statements.
 
 
F-6

 
 
Platinum Underwriters Holdings, Ltd. and Subsidiaries
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
For the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009
 
1.
Basis of Presentation and Significant Accounting Policies
 
Basis of Presentation and Consolidation
 
Platinum Underwriters Holdings, Ltd. (“Platinum Holdings”) is a holding company domiciled in Bermuda.  Through our reinsurance subsidiaries, we provide property and marine, casualty and finite risk reinsurance coverages to a diverse clientele of insurers and select reinsurers on a worldwide basis.
 
Platinum Holdings and its consolidated subsidiaries (collectively, the “Company”) includes Platinum Holdings, Platinum Underwriters Bermuda, Ltd. (“Platinum Bermuda”), Platinum Underwriters Reinsurance, Inc. (“Platinum US”), Platinum Underwriters Finance, Inc. ("Platinum Finance"), Platinum Regency Holdings ("Platinum Regency"), Platinum Administrative Services, Inc. and Platinum UK Services Company Limited.  The terms "we," "us," and "our" refer to the Company, unless the context otherwise indicates.
 
Platinum Regency is an intermediate holding company based in Ireland and a wholly owned subsidiary of Platinum Holdings.  Platinum Finance is an intermediate holding company based in the U.S. and a wholly owned subsidiary of Platinum Regency.  We operate through two licensed reinsurance subsidiaries, Platinum Bermuda, a Bermuda reinsurance company, and Platinum US, a U.S. reinsurance company.   Platinum Bermuda is a wholly owned subsidiary of Platinum Holdings and Platinum US is a wholly owned subsidiary of Platinum Finance.  Platinum Administrative Services, Inc. and Platinum UK Services Company Limited are subsidiaries that provide administrative support services to the Company.
 
The consolidated financial statements have been prepared in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America ("U.S. GAAP").   All material inter-company transactions and accounts have been eliminated in preparing these consolidated financial statements.
 
The preparation of financial statements requires us to make estimates and assumptions that affect the reported amounts of assets and liabilities and disclosure of contingent assets and liabilities at the date of the financial statements and the reported amounts of revenues and expenses during the reporting period.  Actual results may differ materially from these estimates.  The major estimates used in the preparation of the Company's consolidated financial statements, and therefore considered to be critical accounting estimates, include, but are not limited to, premiums written and earned, unpaid losses and loss adjustment expenses (“LAE”), reinsurance recoverable, valuation of investments and income taxes.  In addition, estimates are used to evaluate risk transfer for assumed and ceded reinsurance transactions. Results of changes in estimates are reflected in results of operations in the period in which the change is made.
 
Certain prior period amounts have been reclassified in the consolidated statement of cash flows to conform to the current period presentation.
 
Significant Accounting Policies
 
Investments
 
Fixed maturity securities we own that we may not have the positive intent to hold until maturity are classified as available-for-sale and reported at fair value, with related net unrealized gains or losses excluded from earnings and included in shareholders’ equity as a component of accumulated other comprehensive income or loss, net of deferred taxes.  Fixed maturity securities we own and have the intent to sell prior to maturity, or securities for which we have elected the fair value option attributes of the Financial Accounting Standards Board (the “FASB”) Accounting Standards Codification (“ASC”) 825, “Financial Instruments” (“ASC 825”), are classified as trading securities.  Trading securities are reported at fair value, with mark-to-market adjustments included in net realized gains and losses on investments and the related deferred income tax included in income tax expense or benefit in the consolidated statements of operations.

Short-term investments are comprised of securities with a maturity of 90 days or greater but one year or less from the date of acquisition.  Our U.S. dollar denominated short-term investments are accounted for as available-for-sale.
 
Our non-U.S. dollar denominated short-term investments are accounted for in accordance with the fair value option attributes of ASC 825 and are classified as trading.

The fair value of our fixed maturity securities and short-term investments is based on prices generally obtained from index providers, pricing vendors or broker-dealers.  Index providers utilize external sources and pricing models to value index-eligible securities across numerous sectors and asset classes.  Pricing vendors collect, edit, maintain, evaluate and model data on a large number of securities utilizing primarily market data and observable inputs.  Broker-dealers value securities through proprietary trading desks primarily based on observable inputs.

Premiums and discounts on fixed maturity securities are amortized into net investment income over the life or estimated life of the security using the prospective effective yield method.  Premiums and discounts on mortgage-backed and asset-backed securities that are amortized into net investment income also consider prepayment assumptions.  These assumptions are consistent with the current interest rate and economic environment.  The prospective adjustment method is used to adjust the value of mortgage-backed and asset-backed securities.  Adjustments to the amortized cost of U.S. Treasury Inflation-Protected Securities resulting from changes in the consumer price index are recognized in net investment income.  Realized gains and losses on the sale of securities are determined using the specific identification method.
 
We routinely review our available-for-sale investments to determine whether unrealized losses represent temporary changes in fair value or are the result of an other-than-temporary impairment (“OTTI”).  The process of determining whether a security is other-than-temporarily impaired requires judgment and involves analyzing many factors.  These factors include the overall financial condition of the issuer, the length of time and magnitude of an unrealized loss, specific credit events, the collateral structure and the credit support that may be applicable.
 
 
F-7

 
 
Platinum Underwriters Holdings, Ltd. and Subsidiaries
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS - (Continued)
 
In 2009, we adopted additional guidance under FASB ASC 320, “Investments – Debt and Equity Securities” (“ASC 320”).  In accordance with this additional guidance, we recognize the portion of OTTI related to a credit loss in net income and the portion of OTTI related to all other factors is recognized in other comprehensive income or loss.  The amount of the credit loss of an impaired debt security is the difference between the amortized cost and the greater of (i) the present value of expected future cash flows and (ii) the fair value of the security.  The effect of adoption resulted in a cumulative adjustment to debt securities that were impaired prior to 2009, net of deferred tax, of $14.2 million that was recorded in accumulated other comprehensive income or loss in the consolidated statement of shareholders’ equity. 
 
In accordance with ASC 320, we also consider our intent to sell a security and the likelihood that we will be required to sell a security before an unrealized loss is recovered.  Our intent to sell a security is based, in part, on adverse changes in the creditworthiness of a debt issuer, pricing and other market conditions and our anticipated net cash flows.  If we determine that we intend to sell a security that is in an unrealized loss position, then the unrealized loss related to such a security representing the difference between the security’s amortized cost and its fair value, is recognized as a net impairment loss in the consolidated statements of operations at the time we determine our intent is to sell.
 
Cash and Cash Equivalents
 
Cash and cash equivalents include investments in money market funds, time deposits and short-term obligations of governments and agencies. Cash equivalents are generally carried at amortized cost, which approximates fair value, and include all securities that, at the date of acquisition, have a maturity of less than 90 days.
 
Premiums Written and Earned
 
Assumed reinsurance premiums earned are recognized as revenue, net of any ceded premiums for retrocessional coverage purchased.  Both assumed and ceded premiums written are recognized as earned, generally on a basis proportionate with the coverage period.  Assumed premiums written not yet recognized as revenue are recorded on the consolidated balance sheets as unearned premiums; ceded premiums written not yet earned are recorded on the consolidated balance sheets as prepaid reinsurance premiums.
 
Due to the nature of reinsurance, ceding companies routinely report and remit premiums subsequent to the contract coverage period.  Consequently, premiums written and receivable include amounts reported and billed by the ceding companies, supplemented by our estimates of premiums that are written but not reported.  In addition, we estimate the unearned portion of the premiums. Unearned premiums and estimated premiums receivable are estimates based on estimated written premiums and are subject to judgment and uncertainty.   Earned premiums, which are recorded in revenue, are the premiums written less the unearned premiums.  The premium estimation process considers the terms and conditions of the reinsurance contracts and assumes that the contracts will remain in-force until expiration.  The estimation of written premiums could be affected by early cancellation, election of contract provisions for cut-off and return of unearned premiums or other contract disruptions.  The time lag involved in the process of reporting premiums is shorter than the lag in reporting losses.  Premiums are generally reported in full within two years from the inception of the contract.  The potential net impact of changes in premiums earned on the results of operations is reduced by the accrual of losses and acquisition expenses related to such premiums earned.  Any adjustments to written and earned premiums, and the related losses and acquisition expenses, are accounted for as changes in estimates and are reflected in the results of operations in the period in which they are made.  Any adjustments could be material and could significantly impact earnings in the period they are recorded.
 
Certain of our reinsurance contracts include provisions that adjust premiums based upon the loss experience of the contracts.  We take these provisions into account when determining our estimate of premiums written and unearned premiums.  Reinstatement premiums are the premiums charged for the restoration of the reinsurance limit of a reinsurance contract to its full amount, generally coinciding with the payment by the reinsurer of losses.  These premiums relate to and are earned over the future coverage obtained for the remainder of the contract term.  Any unearned premiums existing at the time a contract limit is exhausted or reinstated is earned immediately.  Additional premiums are premiums that are triggered by losses and are earned immediately.  Premiums written and unearned premiums include estimates of reinstatement premiums and additional premiums based on reinsurance contract provisions and loss experience and rely on the estimates of unpaid losses and LAE.
 
An allowance for uncollectible premiums is established for possible non-payment of premiums receivable, as deemed necessary.  We analyze whether an allowance is deemed necessary based on our historical experience, the general profile of our ceding companies and our ability, in most cases, to contractually net premiums receivable against losses and LAE and commission amounts payable to the same parties.
 
Funds Held by Ceding Companies
 
We may write business on a funds held basis from time to time.  Under these contractual arrangements, the ceding company holds the net funds that would otherwise be remitted to us and generally credits the funds held balance with interest income at a negotiated rate established in the contract.  Interest income on funds held by ceding companies is included in net investment income.
 
Deferred Acquisition Costs
 
Costs of acquiring business, consisting primarily of commissions and other underwriting expenses that vary with and are directly related to the production of business, are deferred and amortized over the period that the corresponding premiums are earned.  On a regular basis, an analysis of the recoverability of deferred acquisition costs is performed based on the estimated profitability of the underlying reinsurance contracts, including anticipated investment income.  Any adjustments are reflected in the results of operations in the period in which they are made.  A liability is established, if necessary, to provide for losses that may exceed the related unearned premiums.  Deferred acquisition costs amortized in 2011, 2010 and 2009 were $101.8 million, $113.7 million and $133.6 million, respectively.
 
 
F-8

 
 
Platinum Underwriters Holdings, Ltd. and Subsidiaries
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS - (Continued)
 
Unpaid Losses and Loss Adjustment Expenses
 
Unpaid losses and LAE are estimated based upon information received from ceding companies regarding our liability for unpaid losses and LAE, adjusted for our estimates of losses and LAE for which ceding company reports have not been received, our historical experience for unreported claims and industry experience for unreported claims.  Unpaid losses and LAE include the cost of claims that were reported, but not yet paid, and estimates of the cost of claims incurred but not yet reported.  In addition, we estimate our unallocated loss adjustment expense (“ULAE”) reserves based on our administrative costs of managing claims.
 
Unpaid losses and LAE represent management’s best estimate at a given point in time and are subject to the effects of trends in loss severity and frequency.  These estimates are reviewed regularly and adjusted as experience develops or new information becomes available.  Any adjustments are accounted for as changes in estimates and are reflected in the results of operations in the period in which they are made.  It is possible that the ultimate liability may differ materially from such estimates.
 
Retrocessional Reinsurance
 
Premiums written, premiums earned, net losses and LAE, and acquisition expenses reflect the net effects of assumed and ceded reinsurance transactions.
 
Estimated amounts recoverable from retrocessionaires on unpaid losses and LAE are determined based on our estimate of assumed ultimate losses and LAE and the terms and conditions of our retrocessional contracts.  The estimates of retroceded amounts recoverable are reflected as assets.
 
Reinsurance Deposit Assets and Liabilities
 
Reinsurance accounting is followed for assumed and ceded transactions when risk transfer requirements have been met.  Risk transfer analysis involves evaluating significant assumptions relating to the amount and timing of expected cash flows, as well as the interpretation of underlying contract terms.  Reinsurance contracts that do not transfer sufficient insurance risk are accounted for as deposits and assets or liabilities are initially recorded for the same amount as assets paid or received.  Interest income or expense related to the deposit is recognized as incurred.  Profit margins are earned over the settlement period of the contractual obligations.
 
Debt Obligations and Deferred Debt Issuance Costs
 
Costs incurred in issuing debt are capitalized and amortized over the life of the debt.  The amortization of these costs is included in interest expense.
 
Income Taxes
 
We provide for income taxes for our subsidiaries operating in income tax paying jurisdictions.  We recognize deferred tax assets and liabilities based on the temporary differences between the financial statement carrying amounts and the tax bases of assets and liabilities.  Such temporary differences are primarily due to tax basis discounts on unpaid losses and LAE and unearned premiums, deferred acquisition costs and investments.   A valuation allowance against deferred tax assets is recorded if it is more likely than not that all, or some portion, of the benefits related to deferred tax assets will not be realized.
 
Share-Based Compensation
 
We recognize the compensation expense of all share-based awards, based on fair value over their vesting period.  The fair value of option awards is determined on the grant date using the Black-Scholes option pricing model and is amortized into earnings over the vesting period.  The fair values of restricted share and restricted share unit awards are determined on the grant date and are amortized into earnings over the vesting period.  The cost of performance-based share awards is based on the estimated number of shares or restricted share units that are expected to be issued, or cash settled, at the end of the performance period, and is amortized into earnings over the performance and vesting period.
 
Foreign Currency Exchange Gains and Losses
 
Our reporting and functional currency and that of our reinsurance subsidiaries is U.S. dollars.  Transactions conducted in other than our reporting currency are re-measured into U.S. dollars and the resulting foreign exchange gains and losses are included in net foreign currency exchange gains or losses.  Foreign currency exchange gains and losses related to securities classified as trading securities are also included in net foreign currency exchange gains and losses.
 
Earnings (Loss) Per Common Share
 
Basic earnings or loss per common share is computed by dividing net income or loss available to common shareholders by the weighted average number of common shares outstanding for the period.  Diluted earnings or loss per common share reflects the basic earnings or loss per common share calculation components adjusted for the dilutive effect of the conversion of preferred shares, share options, restricted shares and restricted share units.  During a period of loss, the basic weighted average common shares outstanding is used in the denominator of the diluted loss per common share computation as the effect of including potential dilutive shares would be anti-dilutive.
 
 
F-9

 
 
Platinum Underwriters Holdings, Ltd. and Subsidiaries
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS - (Continued)
 
Recently Issued Accounting Standards
 
In December 2011, the FASB issued Accounting Standards Update (“ASU”) No 2011-12, “Comprehensive Income: Deferral of the Effective Date for Amendments to the Presentation of Reclassification of Items Out of Accumulated Other Comprehensive Income in Accounting Standards Update No. 2011-05” (“ASU 2011-12”).  ASU 2011-12 defers the presentation on the face of the financial statements the effects of reclassifications out of accumulated other comprehensive income on the components of net income and other comprehensive income for all periods.  All other requirements of ASU 2011-05, “Presentation of Comprehensive Income” (“ASU 2011-05”) issued in June 2011 are not affected.  ASU 2011-05 requires entities to report components of comprehensive income in either a continuous statement of comprehensive income or two separate but consecutive statements.  Under the continuous statement approach, the statement would include the components and total of net income, the components and total of other comprehensive income and the total of comprehensive income.  Under the two statement approach, the first statement would include the components and total of net income and the second statement would include the components and total of other comprehensive income and the total of comprehensive income.  ASU 2011-05 does not change the items that must be reported in other comprehensive income.  ASU 2011-05 is effective retrospectively for interim and annual periods beginning after December 15, 2011, with early adoption permitted.  We have evaluated the guidance and expect it to impact only the presentation and note disclosures in our financial statements.
 
In May 2011, the FASB issued ASU No. 2011-04, “Amendments to Achieve Common Fair Value Measurement and Disclosure Requirement in U.S. GAAP and IFRSs” (“ASU 2011-04”).  ASU 2011-04 does not extend the use of fair value but, rather, provides guidance about how fair value should be applied where it already is required and permitted under U.S. GAAP or International Financial Reporting Standards (“IFRS”).  For U.S. GAAP, most of the changes are clarifications of existing guidance or wording changes to align with IFRS.   ASU 2011-04 is effective on a prospective basis for interim and annual periods beginning after December 15, 2011, with early adoption not permitted.  In the period of adoption, a reporting entity will be required to disclose a change, if any, in valuation technique and related inputs that result from applying ASU 2011-04 and to quantify the total effect, if practicable.  We have evaluated the guidance and expect it to have an impact only on our note disclosures in our financial statements.
 
In October 2010, the FASB issued ASU No. 2010-26, “Accounting for Costs Associated with Acquiring or Renewing Insurance Contracts” (“ASU 2010-26”).  ASU 2010-26 modifies the types of costs that may be deferred, allowing insurance companies to only defer costs directly related to successful acquisition of new or renewal contracts.  These costs include incremental direct costs of successful contracts, the portion of employees’ salaries and benefits related to time spent on acquisition activities for successful contracts and other costs incurred in the acquisition of contracts.  Additional disclosure of the type of acquisition costs capitalized is also required.  ASU 2010-26 is effective on a prospective basis for interim and annual reporting periods beginning after December 15, 2011, with early adoption permitted as of the beginning of a company’s annual period.  We have evaluated the guidance and do not expect it to have an impact on our financial position, results of operations and note disclosures in our financial statements.

2.
Investments
 
Fixed Maturity Available-for-sale Securities
 
The following table sets forth our fixed maturity available-for-sale securities as of December 31, 2011 and 2010 ($ in thousands):

         
Included in Accumulated Other Comprehensive Income (Loss)
             
   
Amortized Cost
   
Gross Unrealized Gains
   
Gross Unrealized Losses
   
Fair Value
   
Non-credit portion of OTTI (1)
 
December 31, 2011:
                             
U.S. Government
  $ 4,702     $ 381     $ -     $ 5,083     $ -  
U.S. Government agencies
    100,000       259       -       100,259       -  
Municipal bonds
    1,510,658       150,280       178       1,660,760       -  
Non-U.S. governments
    69,992       1,929       655       71,266       -  
Corporate bonds
    329,218       21,093       763       349,548       -  
Commercial mortgage-backed securities
    195,309       11,884       2,584       204,609       196  
Residential mortgage-backed securities
    261,187       2,866       12,426       251,627       8,397  
Asset-backed securities
    23,644       489       3,711       20,422       2,821  
Total fixed maturity available-for-sale securities
  $ 2,494,710     $ 189,181     $ 20,317     $ 2,663,574     $ 11,414  
                                         
December 31, 2010:
                                       
U.S. Government
  $ 408,843     $ 267     $ 17,807     $ 391,303     $ -  
U.S. Government agencies
    100,000       547       -       100,547       -  
Municipal bonds
    1,540,701       25,591       28,860       1,537,432       -  
Non-U.S. governments
    74,990       1,859       543       76,306       -  
Corporate bonds
    349,370       18,589       1,059       366,900       -  
Commercial mortgage-backed securities
    195,050       9,656       1,393       203,313       43  
Residential mortgage-backed securities
    192,345       3,601       29,488       166,458       15,794  
Asset-backed securities
    28,203       289       4,924       23,568       4,644  
Total fixed maturity available-for-sale securities
  $ 2,889,502     $ 60,399     $ 84,074     $ 2,865,827     $ 20,481  

(1)
The non-credit portion of OTTI represents the amount of unrealized losses on impaired securities that were not realized in earnings as of the reporting date.  These unrealized losses are included in gross unrealized losses as of December 31, 2011 and 2010.
 
 
F-10

 
 
Platinum Underwriters Holdings, Ltd. and Subsidiaries
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS - (Continued)
 
Our fixed maturity available-for-sale securities are U.S. dollar denominated securities.  U.S. Government agencies consist of securities issued by financial institutions under the Temporary Liquidity Guarantee Program guaranteed by the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation.  Non-U.S. governments consist primarily of securities issued by governments and financial institutions that are explicitly guaranteed by the respective government.
 
Fixed Maturity Trading Securities
 
The following table sets forth the fair value of our fixed maturity trading securities as of December 31, 2011 and 2010 ($ in thousands):

   
December 31,
 
   
2011
   
2010
 
Non-U.S. dollar denominated securities:
           
   Non-U.S. governments
  $ 125,126     $ 140,089  
   U.S. Government agencies
    -       15,903  
   Corporate bonds
    -       68  
Insurance-linked securities
    -       26,086  
Total fixed maturity trading securities
  $ 125,126     $ 182,146  

We elected to record our investments in insurance-linked securities at fair value.  We use insurance-linked securities to actively manage our exposure to catastrophe loss.  We believe that the various risk elements of insurance-linked securities are more appropriately accounted for in accordance with the fair value option attributes of ASC 825.  The mark-to-market adjustments on securities recognized under ASC 825 contributed $1.2 million of net realized losses on investments and $0.2 million of net realized gains on investments for the years ended December 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively.
 
At acquisition, we determine our trading intent in the near term of our fixed maturity trading securities accounted for in accordance with ASC 825. If we do not intend to sell these securities in the near term, the purchases and sales are included in investing activities in our consolidated statements of cash flows, otherwise they are included in operating activities.  For the year ended December 31, 2011, we had proceeds from sales and maturities of $20.4 million and $5.0 million, respectively, and no purchases of trading securities accounted for in accordance with ASC 825 that were included in investing activities on the statements of cash flows.  For the year ended December 31, 2010, we had no purchases, sales or maturities of trading securities accounted for in accordance with ASC 825.  For the year ended December 31, 2009, purchases of $164.7 million and sales of $153.2 million of securities were classified as investing activities and net sales of $208.2 million were classified as net fixed maturity trading securities activities and included in operating activities in the consolidated statements of cash flows.
 
Short-term Investments

The following table sets forth the fair value of our short-term investments as of December 31, 2011 and 2010 ($ in thousands):

   
December 31,
 
   
2011
   
2010
 
Available-for-sale:
           
U.S. Government
  $ 322,320     $ 130,054  
U.S. Government agencies
    85,389       -  
Time deposits
    -       250  
Trading:
               
Non-U.S. governments
    181,125       46,344  
Total short-term investments
  $ 588,834     $ 176,648  

Our U.S. dollar denominated short-term investments are accounted for as available-for-sale and our non-U.S. dollar denominated short-term investments are accounted for in accordance with the fair value option attributes of ASC 825.  The mark-to-market adjustments on short-term investments recognized under ASC 825 contributed less than $0.1 million of net realized gains on investments in each of the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009.

For the year ended December 31, 2011, we had purchases of $301.7 million, no proceeds from sales and proceeds from maturities of $162.1 million from non-U.S. dollar denominated short-term investments accounted for in accordance with ASC 825 that were included in investing activities on the statements of cash flows.  For the year ended December 31, 2010, we had purchases of $44.3 million and no proceeds from sales and maturities of non-U.S. dollar denominated short-term investments accounted for in accordance with ASC 825 that were included in investing activities on the statements of cash flows.  For the year ended December 31, 2009, we had no purchases, sales or maturities of non-U.S. dollar denominated short-term investments.
 
 
F-11

 
 
Platinum Underwriters Holdings, Ltd. and Subsidiaries
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS - (Continued)
 
Other-Than-Temporary Impairments
 
We analyze the creditworthiness of our investment portfolio by reviewing various performance metrics of the issuer, including financial condition, credit ratings and other public information.  We determined that none of our government bonds, municipal bonds or corporate bonds were other-than-temporarily impaired for the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009.
 
We analyze our commercial mortgage-backed securities (“CMBS”) on a periodic basis using default loss models based on the performance of the underlying loans.  Performance metrics include delinquencies, defaults, foreclosures, debt-service-coverage ratios and cumulative losses incurred.  The expected losses for a mortgage pool are compared with the current level of credit support, which generally represents the point at which our security would experience losses.  We evaluate projected cash flows as well as other factors in order to determine if a credit impairment has occurred.  We recorded no net impairment losses related to CMBS for the year ended December 31, 2011 and net impairment losses related to CMBS of $7.7 million and $2.7 million for the years ended December 31, 2010 and 2009, respectively.  As of December 31, 2011, the single largest unrealized loss within our CMBS portfolio was $0.9 million related to a security with an amortized cost of $2.9 million.
 
Residential mortgage-backed securities (“RMBS”) include U.S. Government agency RMBS and non-agency RMBS.  Securities with underlying sub-prime mortgages as collateral are included in asset-backed securities (“ABS”).  We analyze our non-agency RMBS and sub-prime ABS on a periodic basis using default loss models based on the performance of the underlying loans.  Performance metrics include delinquencies, defaults, foreclosures, prepayment speeds and cumulative losses incurred.  The expected losses for a mortgage pool are compared with the current level of credit support, which generally represents the point at which our security would experience losses.  We evaluate projected cash flows as well as other factors in order to determine if a credit impairment has occurred.  We recorded net impairment losses related to non-agency RMBS of $19.0 million, $11.2 million and $8.4 million for the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009, respectively.  As of December 31, 2011, the single largest unrealized loss within our RMBS portfolio was $2.2 million related to a non-agency RMBS security with an amortized cost of $2.6 million.
 
We also recorded net impairment losses related to sub-prime ABS of $3.4 million, $17.7 million and $5.3 million for the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009, respectively.  As of December 31, 2011, the single largest unrealized loss within our sub-prime ABS portfolio was $2.2 million related to a security with an amortized cost of $4.4 million.
 
The following table sets forth a summary of the cumulative credit losses recognized on our fixed maturity available-for-sale securities for the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009 ($ in thousands):

   
2011
   
2010
   
2009
 
Beginning balance, January 1
  $ 48,845     $ 18,695     $ -  
Cumulative effect of accounting change
    -       -       2,300  
Credit losses on securities not previously impaired
    6,080       18,141       11,133  
Additional credit losses on securities previously impaired
    16,290       18,469       5,262  
Reduction for paydowns and securities sold
    (8,713 )     (6,104 )     -  
Reduction for increases in cash flows expected to be collected
    (661 )     (356 )     -  
Ending balance, December 31
  $ 61,841     $ 48,845     $ 18,695  

As of December 31, 2011, total cumulative credit losses related to CMBS, non-agency RMBS and sub-prime ABS.  The cumulative credit losses we recorded on CMBS of $4.8 million were on four securities issued from 2006 to 2007.  As of December 31, 2011, 6.7% of the mortgages backing these securities were 90 days or more past due and 0.4% of the mortgages had incurred cumulative losses.  For these securities, the expected losses for the underlying mortgages were greater than the remaining credit support of 19.0%.   The cumulative credit losses we recorded on non-agency RMBS and sub-prime ABS of $57.0 million were on thirty securities issued from 2004 to 2007.  As of December 31, 2011, 17.0% of the mortgages backing these securities were 90 days or more past due and 4.6% of the mortgages had incurred cumulative losses.  For these securities, the expected losses for the underlying mortgages were greater than the remaining credit support of 7.7%.   
 
 
F-12

 
 
Platinum Underwriters Holdings, Ltd. and Subsidiaries
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS - (Continued)
 
Unrealized Gains and Losses
 
The following table sets forth the net changes in unrealized gains and losses on our available-for-sale fixed maturity securities and short-term investments for the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009 ($ in thousands):

   
2011
   
2010
   
2009
 
Gross change in unrealized investment gains and losses
  $ 192,537     $ 50,335     $ 129,999  
Less: deferred tax
    (21,414 )     (4,818 )     (11,017 )
Cumulative effect of accounting change, net of deferred tax
    -       -       14,244  
Net change in unrealized investment gains and losses
  $ 171,123     $ 45,517     $ 133,226  
 
The following table sets forth our gross unrealized losses on securities classified as fixed maturity available-for-sale aggregated by investment category and length of time that individual securities have been in a continuous unrealized loss position as of December 31, 2011 and 2010 ($ in thousands):

   
December 31, 2011
   
December 31, 2010
 
   
Fair Value
   
Unrealized Loss
   
Fair Value
   
Unrealized Loss
 
Less than twelve months:
                       
U.S. Government
  $ -     $ -     $ 388,087     $ 17,807  
Municipal bonds
    4,751       131       670,592       28,773  
Non-U.S. governments
    9,988       29       4,455       543  
Corporate bonds
    12,526       763       37,334       1,059  
Commercial mortgage-backed securities
    19,797       1,047       -       -  
Residential mortgage-backed securities
    131,574       2,112       17,103       431  
Asset-backed securities
    580       84       -       -  
Total
  $ 179,216     $ 4,166     $ 1,117,571     $ 48,613  
                                 
Twelve months or more:
                               
U.S. Government
  $ -     $ -     $ -     $ -  
Municipal bonds
    3,002       47       2,032       87  
Non-U.S. governments
    4,373       626       -       -  
Corporate bonds
    -       -       -       -  
Commercial mortgage-backed securities
    6,171       1,537       22,016       1,393  
Residential mortgage-backed securities
    43,704       10,314       56,297       29,057  
Asset-backed securities
    16,854       3,627       21,816       4,924  
Total
  $ 74,104     $ 16,151     $ 102,161     $ 35,461  
                                 
Total unrealized losses:
                               
U.S. Government
  $ -     $ -     $ 388,087     $ 17,807  
Municipal bonds
    7,753       178       672,624       28,860  
Non-U.S. governments
    14,361       655       4,455       543  
Corporate bonds
    12,526       763       37,334       1,059  
Commercial mortgage-backed securities
    25,968       2,584       22,016       1,393  
Residential mortgage-backed securities
    175,278       12,426       73,400       29,488  
Asset-backed securities
    17,434       3,711       21,816       4,924  
Total
  $ 253,320     $ 20,317     $ 1,219,732     $ 84,074  

The fair values of fixed maturity available-for-sale securities included in the table above relate only to securities in an unrealized loss position as of the reporting date.
 
 
F-13

 
 
Platinum Underwriters Holdings, Ltd. and Subsidiaries
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS - (Continued)
 
We believe that the gross unrealized losses in our available-for-sale portfolio represent temporary declines in fair value.  We believe that the unrealized losses are not necessarily predictive of ultimate performance and that the provisions we have made for net impairment losses are adequate.  However, economic conditions may deteriorate more than expected and may adversely affect the expected cash flows of our securities, which in turn may lead to impairment losses being recorded in future periods.  Conversely, economic conditions may improve more than expected and favorably increase the expected cash flows of our impaired securities, which would be earned through net investment income over the remaining life of the security.
 
Net Investment Income
 
The following table sets forth our net investment income for the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009 ($ in thousands):

   
2011
   
2010
   
2009
 
Fixed maturity securities
  $ 120,836     $ 135,394     $ 162,786  
Short-term investments and cash and cash equivalents
    7,622       1,855       1,732  
Funds held
    1,967       1,815       4,192  
Subtotal
    130,425       139,064       168,710  
Less: investment expenses
    4,562       4,679       4,769  
Net investment income
  $ 125,863     $ 134,385     $ 163,941  
 
Net Realized Gains on Investments
 
The following table sets forth our net realized gains on investments for the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009 ($ in thousands):

   
2011
   
2010
   
2009
 
Gross realized gains on the sale of investments
  $ 8,319     $ 115,679     $ 86,512  
Gross realized losses on the sale of investments
    (6,900 )     (9,285 )     (5,588 )
Net realized gains on the sale of investments
    1,419       106,394       80,924  
Mark-to-market adjustments on trading securities
    2,515       1,397       (2,294 )
Net realized gains on investments
  $ 3,934     $ 107,791     $ 78,630  

Maturities
 
The actual maturities of our fixed maturity available-for-sale and trading securities could differ from stated maturities due to call or prepayment provisions.  The following table sets forth the amortized cost and fair value of our fixed maturity available-for-sale and trading securities by stated maturity as of December 31, 2011 ($ in thousands):

   
Amortized Cost
   
Fair Value
 
Due in one year or less
  $ 167,705     $ 168,831  
Due from one to five years
    518,176       547,692  
Due from five to ten years
    593,892       645,104  
Due in ten or more years
    849,953       950,415  
Mortgage-backed and asset-backed securities
    480,140       476,658  
Total
  $ 2,609,866     $ 2,788,700  
 
Restricted Investments
 
Certain of our investments are restricted to support our reinsurance operations.  Investments with a carrying value of $5.3 million were on deposit with U.S. regulatory authorities as of December 31, 2011.  Investments with a carrying value of $61.1 million and cash and cash equivalents of $9.3 million as of December 31, 2011 were held in trust to collateralize obligations under various reinsurance contracts.  We also utilize letters of credit under our credit facilities, see Note 7 for a description of our assets held in trust to secure those letters of credit.
 
 
F-14

 
 
Platinum Underwriters Holdings, Ltd. and Subsidiaries
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS - (Continued)
 
3.
Fair Value Measurements
 
The fair values of our financial assets and liabilities are determined primarily through the use of observable inputs.  Observable inputs reflect the assumptions market participants would use in pricing the asset or liability based on market data obtained from external independent sources.   Unobservable inputs reflect management’s assumptions about what market participants’ assumptions would be in pricing the asset or liability based on the best information available.   We classify our financial assets and liabilities in the fair value hierarchy based on the lowest level input that is significant to the fair value measurement.  This classification requires judgment in assessing the market and pricing methodologies for a particular security.  The fair value hierarchy is comprised of the following three levels:
 
 
Level 1:
Valuations are based on unadjusted quoted prices in active markets for identical financial assets or liabilities;
 
 
Level 2:
Valuations of financial assets and liabilities are based on prices obtained from independent index providers, pricing vendors or broker-dealers using observable inputs; and
 
 
Level 3:
Valuations are based on unobservable inputs for assets and liabilities where there is little or no market activity.  Management’s assumptions and/or internal valuation pricing models may be used to determine the fair value of financial assets or liabilities.
 
The following table presents the fair value measurement levels for all financial assets and liabilities which the Company has recorded at fair value as of December 31, 2011 and 2010 ($ in thousands):

         
Fair Value Measurement Using:
 
   
Total
   
Level 1
   
Level 2
   
Level 3
 
December 31, 2011:
                       
Financial assets:
                       
Investments:
                       
U.S. Government
  $ 5,083     $ 5,083     $ -     $ -  
U.S. Government agencies
    100,259       -       100,259       -  
Municipal bonds
    1,660,760       -       1,660,760       -  
Non-U.S. governments
    196,392       55,561       140,831       -  
Corporate bonds
    349,548       -       349,548       -  
Commercial mortgage-backed securities
    204,609       -       204,609       -  
Residential mortgage-backed securities
    251,627       -       243,481       8,146  
Asset-backed securities
    20,422       -       18,555       1,867  
Insurance-linked securities
    -       -       -       -  
Short-term investments
    588,834       34,894       553,940       -  
Total
  $ 3,377,534     $ 95,538     $ 3,271,983     $ 10,013  
                                 
Financial liabilities:
                               
Derivative instruments
    -       -       -       -  
Total
  $ -     $ -     $ -     $ -  
                                 
December 31, 2010:
                               
Financial assets:
                               
Investments:
                               
U.S. Government
  $ 391,303     $ 391,303     $ -     $ -  
U.S. Government agencies
    116,450       -       116,450       -  
Municipal bonds
    1,537,432       -       1,537,432       -  
Non-U.S. governments
    216,395       57,643       158,752       -  
Corporate bonds
    366,968       -       366,968       -  
Commercial mortgage-backed securities
    203,313       -       203,313       -  
Residential mortgage-backed securities
    166,458       -       164,009       2,449  
Asset-backed securities
    23,568       -       22,499       1,069  
Insurance-linked securities
    26,086       -       26,086       -  
Short-term investments
    176,648       -       176,648       -  
Total
  $ 3,224,621     $ 448,946     $ 2,772,157     $ 3,518  
                                 
Financial liabilities:
                               
Derivative instruments
    4,871       -       -       4,871  
Total
  $ 4,871     $ -     $ -     $ 4,871  
 
 
F-15

 
 
Platinum Underwriters Holdings, Ltd. and Subsidiaries
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS - (Continued)
 
Our financial assets and liabilities recorded at fair value include fixed maturity securities, short-term investments and derivative instruments.  The fair values of our fixed maturity securities and short-term investments are generally based on prices obtained from independent index providers, pricing vendors or broker-dealers using observable inputs.  Fixed maturity securities and short-term investments are generally valued using the market approach.  The inputs used to determine the fair value of our financial assets and liabilities are as follows:
 
U.S. Government
The fair values of U.S. Government securities were based on quoted prices in active markets for identical assets.  The fair value measurements were classified as Level 1.
   
U.S Government agencies
Our U.S. Government agencies portfolio consisted of securities issued by financial institutions guaranteed by the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation.  The observable inputs used to price these securities may include the spread above the risk-free yield curve, reported trades and broker-dealer quotes.  The fair value measurements were classified as Level 2.
   
Municipal bonds
The fair values of municipal bonds were determined based on observable inputs that may include the spread above the risk-free yield curve, reported trades, broker-dealer quotes, benchmark securities, bids, credit risks and economic indicators.  The fair value measurements were classified as Level 2.
   
Non-U.S. governments
Our non-U.S. government bond portfolio consisted of securities issued primarily by governments, provinces, agencies and supranationals as well as debt issued by financial institutions that is guaranteed by non-U.S. governments.  The fair values of non-U.S. government securities were determined based on observable inputs that may include the spread above the risk-free yield curve, reported trades and broker-dealer quotes.  The fair value measurements were classified as Level 1 or Level 2.
   
Corporate bonds
The observable inputs used to price corporate issues may include the spread above the risk-free yield curve, reported trades, broker-dealer quotes, benchmark securities, bids, credit risks and industry and economic indicators.  The fair value measurements were classified as Level 2.
   
Commercial mortgage-backed securities
The fair values of CMBS were determined based on observable inputs that may include the spread above the risk-free yield curve, reported trades, broker-dealer quotes, bids, security cash flows and structures, delinquencies, loss severities and default rates.  The fair value measurements were classified as Level 2.
   
Residential mortgage-backed securities
Our RMBS portfolio was comprised of securities issued by U.S. Government agencies and by non-agency institutions.  The observable inputs used to price U.S. Government agency RMBS may include the spread above the risk-free yield curve, reported trades, broker-dealer quotes, bids, loan level information and prepayment speeds.  The observable inputs used to price non-agency RMBS may include the spread above the risk-free yield curve, reported trades, broker-dealer quotes, bids, security cash flows and structures, prepayment speeds, delinquencies, loss severities and default rates.  The fair value measurements were classified as Level 2 or Level 3.
   
Asset-backed securities
The fair values of ABS were determined based on observable inputs that may include the spread above the risk-free yield curve, reported trades, broker-dealer quotes, bids, security cash flows and structures, type of collateral, prepayment speeds, delinquencies, loss severities and default rates.  The fair value measurements were classified as Level 2 or Level 3.
   
Insurance-linked securities
The fair values of insurance-linked securities were determined based on observable inputs that may include the spread above the risk-free yield curve, reported trades, broker-dealer quotes, benchmark securities, bids, credit risks and specific catastrophic events.  The fair value measurements were classified as Level 2.
   
Short-term investments
Short-term investments were carried at fair value based on observable inputs or carried at amortized cost, which approximates fair value.  The fair value measurements were classified as Level 1 or Level 2.
   
Derivative instruments
Our derivative instruments may include interest rate options, commodity options and other derivative instruments.  The fair value of our other derivative instrument was determined by management primarily using unobservable inputs through the application of our own assumptions and internal valuation pricing models.  Unobservable inputs used in the internal valuation pricing model included the unpaid contract premiums, probability of losses triggered under the covered perils for first and second events, the remaining time to the end of the annual contract period and the seasonality of risks.  The valuation was based on the use of significant unobservable inputs and therefore the fair value measurement was classified as Level 3.  See Note 6 for additional disclosure on our derivative instruments.
 
 
 
F-16

 
 
Platinum Underwriters Holdings, Ltd. and Subsidiaries
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS - (Continued)
 
The following tables reconcile the beginning and ending balance for our Level 3 financial assets and liabilities for the years ended December 31, 2011 and 2010 ($ in thousands):

   
Year Ended December 31, 2011
 
   
Residential mortgage-backed securities
   
Asset-backed securities
   
Derivatives
   
Total
 
Beginning balance, January 1
  $ 2,449     $ 1,069     $ (4,871 )   $ (1,353 )
Purchases
    -       -       -       -  
Issuances
    -       -       -       -  
Settlements
    -       -       7,389       7,389  
Sales, maturities and paydowns
    (258 )     -       -       (258 )
Total net realized gains included in earnings
    -       -       -       -  
Total increase (decrease) in fair value of the derivative instrument included in earnings
    -       -       (2,518 )     (2,518 )
Total net unrealized gains (losses) included in comprehensive income (loss)
    738       407       -       1,145  
Transfers in and/or out of Level 3
    5,217       391       -       5,608  
Ending balance, December 31
  $ 8,146     $ 1,867     $ -     $ 10,013  
                                 
Total increase (decrease) in fair value of the financial assets and liabilities included in earnings for the year
  $ -     $ -     $ (2,518 )   $ (2,518 )
 
   
Year Ended December 31, 2010
 
   
Residential mortgage-backed securities
   
Asset-backed securities
   
Derivatives
   
Total
 
Beginning balance, January 1
  $ -     $ -     $ (4,677 )   $ (4,677 )
Purchases
    -       -       -       -  
Issuances
    -       -       -       -  
Settlements
    -       -       9,394       9,394  
Sales, maturities and paydowns
    -       -       -       -  
Total net realized gains included in earnings
    -       -       -       -  
Total increase (decrease) in fair value of the derivative instrument included in earnings
    -       -       (9,588 )     (9,588 )
Total net unrealized gains (losses) included in comprehensive income (loss)
    -       -       -       -  
Transfers in and/or out of Level 3
    2,449       1,069       -       3,518  
Ending balance, December 31
  $ 2,449     $ 1,069     $ (4,871 )   $ (1,353 )
                                 
Total increase (decrease) in fair value of the financial assets and liabilities included in earnings for the year
  $ -     $ -     $ (9,588 )   $ (9,588 )

Transfers of assets and liabilities into or out of Level 3 are recorded at their fair values as of the end of each reporting period, consistent with the date of the determination of fair value.  During the year ended December 31, 2011, we transferred $2.9 million of non-agency RMBS and $2.0 million of sub-prime ABS from Level 3 to Level 2.  During the year ended December 31, 2011 we transferred $8.1 million of non-agency RMBS and $2.4 million of sub-prime ABS from Level 2 to Level 3.  During the year ended December 31, 2010 we transferred $2.4 million of non-agency RMBS and $1.1 million of sub-prime ABS from Level 2 to Level 3.  The transfers into and out of Level 3 during the years ended December 31, 2011 and 2010 were due to the sufficiency of evidence available to corroborate significant observable inputs with market observable information.  There were no transfers between Levels 1 and 2 during the years ended December 31, 2011 and 2010.
 
The carrying amounts of our financial assets and liabilities were equal to fair values at December 31, 2011 and 2010, except for the debt obligations on our consolidated balance sheets.  The debt obligations were recorded at cost with a carrying value of $250.0 million at December 31, 2011 and 2010, and had a fair value of $269.0 million and $260.9 million at December 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively.
 
 
F-17

 
 
Platinum Underwriters Holdings, Ltd. and Subsidiaries
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS - (Continued)
 
4.
Unpaid Losses and Loss Adjustment Expenses
 
The following table sets forth the changes in our liability for unpaid losses and LAE for the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009 ($ in thousands):

   
2011
   
2010
   
2009
 
Net unpaid losses and LAE as of January 1,
  $ 2,208,466     $ 2,335,008     $ 2,452,045  
Net incurred losses and LAE related to:
                       
Current year
    905,595       625,250       579,304  
Prior years
    (100,158 )     (157,830 )     (100,962 )
Net incurred losses and LAE
    805,437       467,420       478,342  
Net paid losses and LAE related to:
                       
Current year
    155,534       96,245       67,693  
Prior years
    477,755       497,968       539,517  
Net paid losses and LAE
    633,289       594,213       607,210  
Net effects of foreign currency exchange rate changes
    5,045       251       11,831  
Net unpaid losses and LAE as of December 31,
    2,385,659       2,208,466       2,335,008  
Reinsurance recoverable on unpaid losses and LAE
    3,955       8,912       14,328  
Gross unpaid losses and LAE as of December 31,
  $ 2,389,614     $ 2,217,378     $ 2,349,336  
 
The following table sets forth the components of net incurred losses and LAE related to prior years for the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009 ($ in thousands):

   
2011
   
2010
   
2009
 
Net favorable loss development
  $ (112,984 )   $ (158,939 )   $ (100,793 )
Effect of changes in premium estimates
    10,857       14,331       (169 )
Change in unallocated loss adjustment expense reserves
    1,969       (13,222 )     -  
Net incurred losses and LAE - prior years
  $ (100,158 )   $ (157,830 )   $ (100,962 )
 
Net favorable loss development was primarily the result of favorable adjustments in ultimate loss ratios.  Prior years’ incurred losses and LAE included losses associated with changes in premium estimates and the patterns of their earnings.  The effect on net income of changes in premium estimates, after considering corresponding changes in related losses, LAE and acquisition expenses, was not significant.  During the year ended December 31, 2010, a review of our administrative expenses of managing claims resulted in a $13.2 million reduction of ULAE reserves.
 
The net favorable loss development for the year ended December 31, 2011 emerged primarily from the Property and Marine and Casualty segments.  The Property and Marine segment had $41.4 million of net favorable loss development, including $19.4 million of net favorable loss development related to major catastrophe events, primarily from 2010 events, and an additional $22.0 million of net favorable loss development unrelated to major catastrophe events.  The Casualty segment had $59.4 million of net favorable loss development, of which $52.7 million was attributable to the long-tailed casualty classes.  The majority of the long-tailed casualty net favorable loss development was attributable to the 2007 and prior underwriting years of the claims made, casualty occurrence excess-of-loss and umbrella classes, partially offset by net unfavorable loss development in the international casualty class in the 2008 and 2010 underwriting years.  The Finite Risk segment experienced net favorable loss development of $12.1 million, which was partially offset by $8.2 million of additional profit commissions on these contracts.
 
The net favorable loss development for the year ended December 31, 2010 emerged primarily from the Property and Marine and Casualty segments.  The Property and Marine segment had $36.9 million of net favorable loss development, including $53.0 million of net favorable loss development unrelated to major catastrophe events and net unfavorable loss development of $16.2 million related to major catastrophe events, primarily Hurricane Ike.  The Casualty segment had $113.3 million of net favorable loss development, of which $96.4 million was attributable to the long-tailed casualty classes in the 2006 and prior underwriting years.  The majority of the long-tailed casualty net favorable loss development was attributable to the claims made, casualty occurrence excess-of-loss, clash and umbrella classes, partially offset by net unfavorable loss development in the international casualty class in the 2008 underwriting year.  The Finite Risk segment experienced net favorable loss development of $8.8 million, which was substantially offset by adjustments relating to profit commissions on these contracts.
 
The net favorable loss development for the year ended December 31, 2009 emerged primarily from the Property and Marine and Casualty segments and was unrelated to major catastrophe events.  The Property and Marine segment had $14.3 million of net favorable loss development, including $17.7 million of net favorable loss development unrelated to major catastrophe events and net unfavorable loss development of $3.5 million related to major catastrophe events.  The Casualty segment had $73.6 million of net favorable loss development, of which $68.2 million was attributable to the long-tailed casualty classes.  The majority of the long-tailed casualty net favorable loss development was attributable to the umbrella, claims made and casualty occurrence excess-of-loss classes.  The Finite Risk segment experienced net favorable loss development of $12.9 million, which was substantially offset by adjustments relating to profit commissions on these contracts.
 
 
F-18

 
 
Platinum Underwriters Holdings, Ltd. and Subsidiaries
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS - (Continued)
 
The net favorable loss development for the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009 was primarily attributable to a level of cumulative losses reported by our ceding companies that was lower than expected, and that, in our judgment, resulted in sufficient credibility in the loss experience to change our previously selected loss ratios and reduce estimated ultimate losses.
 
We do not believe that the net favorable loss development in 2011, 2010 and 2009 is indicative of prospective net loss development of unpaid losses and LAE as of December 31, 2011 because conditions and trends that affected the net favorable loss development of prior years’ unpaid losses and LAE may not necessarily exist in the future.
 
Because many of the reinsurance coverages we offer will likely involve claims that may not ultimately be settled for many years after they are incurred, subjective judgments as to ultimate exposure to losses are an integral and necessary component of the process of estimating unpaid losses and LAE.  With respect to reinsurers, the inherent uncertainties of estimating unpaid losses and LAE are further exacerbated by the significant amount of time that often elapses between the occurrence of an insured loss, the reporting of that loss to the primary insurer and then to the reinsurer, and the primary insurer's payment of that loss to the insured and subsequent payment by the reinsurer to the primary insurer.  Unpaid losses and LAE are reviewed quarterly using a variety of statistical and actuarial techniques to analyze current claim costs, frequency and severity data and prevailing economic, social and legal factors.  Unpaid losses and LAE established in prior years are evaluated as loss experience develops and new information becomes available.  Adjustments to previously estimated unpaid losses and LAE are reflected in financial results in the periods in which they are made.  Unpaid losses and LAE represent our best estimate of the costs of claims incurred, and it is possible that our ultimate liability may differ materially from such estimates.

5.
Retrocessional Reinsurance
 
Reinsurance is the transfer of risk, by contract, from an insurance company to a reinsurer for consideration of premium.  Retrocessional reinsurance is reinsurance ceded by a reinsurer to another reinsurer, referred to as a retrocessionaire, to reinsure against all or a portion of its reinsurance written.  Retrocessional reinsurance agreements provide us with increased capacity to write larger risks, limit our maximum loss arising from any one occurrence and maintain our exposure to loss within our capital resources.  Retrocessional agreements do not relieve us from our obligations to the insurers and reinsurers from whom we assume business.  The failure of retrocessionaires to honor their obligations would result in losses to us.  Consequently, we consider the financial strength of retrocessionaires when determining whether to purchase retrocessional coverage from them.  We generally obtain retrocessional coverage from companies rated “A-” or better by A.M. Best unless the retrocessionaire’s obligations are collateralized.  We routinely monitor the financial performance and rating status of all material retrocessionaires.
 
During 2011, 2010 and 2009, Platinum Bermuda entered into various industry loss warranty reinsurance agreements with third-party retrocessionaires.  These reinsurance contracts provided retrocessional coverage for Platinum Bermuda for catastrophic events in North America, Europe and Japan.  During 2009, Platinum US obtained excess-of-loss retrocession coverage with respect to its crop business from third-party retrocessionaires.
 
The following table sets forth the effects of retrocessional reinsurance on premiums, losses and LAE for the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009 ($ in thousands):

   
Assumed
   
Ceded
   
Net
 
As of and for the year ended December 31, 2011:
                 
Premiums written
  $ 687,296     $ 35,782     $ 651,514  
Premium earned
    721,335       31,883       689,452  
Losses and LAE
    839,323       33,886       805,437  
Unpaid losses and LAE
    2,389,614       3,955       2,385,659  
As of and for the year ended December 31, 2010:
                       
Premiums written
    779,526       18,937       760,589  
Premium earned
    804,890       24,896       779,994  
Losses and LAE
    472,089       4,669       467,420  
Unpaid losses and LAE
    2,217,378       8,912       2,208,466  
As of and for the year ended December 31, 2009:
                       
Premiums written
    924,674       26,840       897,834  
Premium earned
    964,677       27,341       937,336  
Losses and LAE
    494,312       15,970       478,342  
Unpaid losses and LAE
  $ 2,349,336     $ 14,328     $ 2,335,008  

Inter-company Retrocessional Reinsurance Arrangements
 
Effective July 1, 2011, Platinum Bermuda provided retrocessional coverage to Platinum US for $50.0 million in excess of $50.0 million with respect to crop losses. On December 31, 2011, the agreement expired without any recoveries to Platinum US and was not renewed.
 
 
F-19

 
 
Platinum Underwriters Holdings, Ltd. and Subsidiaries
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS - (Continued)
 
Effective March 17, 2011, Platinum US provided retrocessional coverage to Platinum Bermuda on an excess of loss basis.  Platinum US signed a 50% participation on a contract that covered each loss occurrence in excess of $50.0 million, subject to (i) an annual aggregate deductible of $50.0 million otherwise recoverable and (ii) a limit of liability of $100.0 million per occurrence.  On December 31, 2011, the agreement expired without any recoveries to Platinum Bermuda and was not renewed.
 
Effective August 5, 2009, Platinum Bermuda provided retrocessional coverage to Platinum US for $45.0 million per occurrence in excess of $20.0 million with respect to catastrophe losses.  This agreement expired without any recoveries and was not renewed in 2010.
 
In 2003, Platinum US entered into a quota share retrocession agreement with Platinum Bermuda on a risks-attaching basis, with various amendments made from time to time.  Platinum US continued its participation in its agreement with Platinum Bermuda until December 31, 2007.  Although the agreement was terminated on December 31, 2007, premiums and losses associated with this agreement continued to be earned and retroceded through 2011.
 
The following table sets forth a summary of the premiums earned and losses ceded related to the foregoing agreements between Platinum Bermuda and Platinum US for the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009 ($ in thousands):

   
2011
   
2010
   
2009
 
Retroceded by Platinum US to Platinum Bermuda:
                 
Premiums earned by Platinum Bermuda
  $ (70 )   $ 16,621     $ 37,433  
Losses and LAE (benefit) to Platinum Bermuda
    (43,880 )     (76,632 )     (41,501 )
                         
Retroceded by Platinum Bermuda to Platinum US:
                       
Premiums earned by Platinum US
    13,500       -       -  
Losses and LAE (benefit) to Platinum US
  $ -     $ -     $ -  
 
6.
Derivative Instruments
 
Our derivative instruments are recorded in the consolidated balance sheets at fair value as other assets or other liabilities, with changes in fair values and realized gains and losses recognized in net changes in fair value of derivatives in the consolidated statements of operations.  None of our derivatives were designated as hedges under current accounting guidance. Our objectives for entering into derivative agreements are as follows:
 
Interest Rate Options
 
We use interest rate options within our portfolio of fixed maturity investments to manage our exposure to interest rate risk.
 
Commodity Options
 
We use commodity options to hedge certain underwriting risks.
 
Other Derivative Instrument
 
We use other derivatives to hedge certain underwriting risks.
 
In August 2008, we entered into a derivative agreement with Topiary Capital Limited (“Topiary”), a Cayman Islands special purpose vehicle, that provided us with the ability to recover up to $200.0 million if two catastrophic events involving U.S. wind, U.S. earthquake, European wind or Japanese earthquake occurred that met specified loss criteria during any of three annual periods commencing August 1, 2008.  The derivative agreement with Topiary expired on July 31, 2011 and no recovery was made.
 
At December 31, 2011, we did not hold any derivative instruments.  At December 31, 2010, we held a derivative instrument with a notional value of $200.0 million and a fair value of $4.9 million that was recorded in other liabilities on the consolidated balance sheets.
 
 
F-20

 
 
Platinum Underwriters Holdings, Ltd. and Subsidiaries
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS - (Continued)
 
The following table sets forth the net changes in fair value of derivatives in the consolidated statements of operations for the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009  ($ in thousands):

   
2011
   
2010
   
2009
 
Interest rate options
  $ 1,646     $ -     $ -  
Commodity options
    165       -       -  
Other derivative instrument
    2,518       9,588       9,741  
Net changes in fair value of derivatives
  $ 4,329     $ 9,588     $ 9,741  

7.
Debt Obligations and Credit Facilities
 
Debt Obligations
 
At December 31, 2011, Platinum Finance had outstanding an aggregate principal amount of $250.0 million of Series B 7.5% Notes due June 1, 2017 (the “debt obligations”), unconditionally guaranteed by Platinum Holdings.  Interest is payable on the debt obligations per annum on each June 1 and December 1.  Platinum Finance may redeem the debt obligations, at its option, at any time in whole, or from time to time in part, prior to maturity, subject to a “make-whole” provision.
 
Syndicated Credit Facility
 
On June 24, 2011, we entered into a three-year, $300.0 million credit facility (the "Syndicated Credit Facility") that amended and restated our existing credit facility, which was scheduled to expire on September 13, 2011.  The Syndicated Credit Facility consists of a $100.0 million unsecured senior credit facility available for revolving borrowings and letters of credit and a $200.0 million secured senior credit facility available for letters of credit.  Borrowings and letters of credit under the Syndicated Credit Facility are available for the working capital, liquidity and general corporate requirements of Platinum Holdings, Platinum Finance and our reinsurance subsidiaries.  Platinum Holdings and Platinum Finance have unconditionally guaranteed the obligations of our reinsurance subsidiaries under the Syndicated Credit Facility.  The Syndicated Credit Facility contains customary representations, warranties and covenants, including requirements to maintain a ratio of consolidated indebtedness to total capitalization of not greater than 0.35 to 1.0 and to maintain a consolidated tangible net worth of not less than the higher of (i) $1.25 billion or (ii) the sum of $1.258 billion plus 50% of positive net income for each fiscal year plus 75% of the aggregate increases in shareholders’ equity resulting from the issuance or sale of shares minus the amount of any extraordinary dividend payment or repurchase of shares.  Our consolidated tangible net worth was $1.54 billion, or $294.2 million greater than the minimum consolidated tangible net worth covenant of $1.25 billion as of December 31, 2011.  In addition, each of our reinsurance subsidiaries must maintain a financial strength rating from A.M. Best of at least B++ at all times.  We are in compliance with the covenants under the Syndicated Credit Facility. The Syndicated Credit Facility provides that we may increase the lender commitments by up to $150.0 million subject to the participation of lenders.
 
Letter of Credit Facility
 
On June 30, 2011, our reinsurance subsidiaries entered into a letter of credit facility in the maximum aggregate amount of $100.0 million (the “LOC Facility”) that expires on December 31, 2013.  Under the terms of the LOC Facility, up to $100.0 million is available for the issuance of letters of credit to support reinsurance obligations of our reinsurance subsidiaries.  The LOC Facility contains customary representations, warranties and covenants.  We are in compliance with the covenants under the LOC Facility.  We also have the ability to request a supplemental letter of credit facility for up to $150.0 million subject to agreement with the lender.
 
 
F-21

 
 
Platinum Underwriters Holdings, Ltd. and Subsidiaries
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS - (Continued)
 
We had no cash borrowings under the Syndicated Credit Facility during the years ended December 31, 2011 and 2010.  The following table summarizes the outstanding letters of credit and the cash and cash equivalents and investments held in trust to collateralize letters of credit issued as of December 31, 2011 ($ in thousands):

   
Letters of Credit
   
Collateral
 
   
Capacity
   
Issued
   
Cash and Cash Equivalents
   
Investments
   
Total
 
Syndicated Credit Facility:
                             
Secured
  $ 200,000     $ 116,100     $ 42,960     $ 90,187     $ 133,147  
Unsecured
    100,000       -       -       -       -  
Total Syndicated Credit Facility
    300,000       116,100       42,960       90,187       133,147  
                                         
LOC Facility
    100,000       16,018       -       18,370       18,370  
Total
  $ 400,000     $ 132,118     $ 42,960     $ 108,557     $ 151,517  

8.
Income Taxes
 
We provide for income tax expense or benefit based upon income reported in the consolidated financial statements and the provisions of currently enacted tax laws.  Platinum Holdings and Platinum Bermuda are incorporated under the laws of Bermuda and are subject to Bermuda law with respect to taxation.  Under current Bermuda law, they are not taxed on any Bermuda income or capital gains and they have received an assurance from the Bermuda Minister of Finance that if any legislation is enacted in Bermuda that would impose tax computed on profits or income, or computed on any capital asset, gain or appreciation, or any tax in the nature of estate duty or inheritance tax, then the imposition of any such tax will not be applicable to Platinum Holdings or Platinum Bermuda or any of their respective operations, shares, debentures or other obligations until March 31, 2035.
 
Platinum Holdings has subsidiaries based in the United States, the United Kingdom and Ireland that are subject to the tax laws thereof.  The operations of Platinum US are subject to U.S. federal income taxes generally at a rate of 35%.  Any of our non-U.S. subsidiaries could become subject to U.S. federal income tax only to the extent that they derive U.S. source income that is subject to U.S. withholding tax or income derived from activity that is deemed to be the conduct of a trade or business within the U.S.  We do not consider our non-U.S. subsidiaries to be engaged in a trade or business within the U.S. and, therefore, do not believe that our non-U.S. subsidiaries are subject to U.S. federal income tax.  However, there is little legal precedent as to what constitutes being engaged in a trade or business within the U.S. and, thus, there exists the possibility that the U.S. Internal Revenue Service could assert claims that our non-U.S. subsidiaries are engaged in a trade or business in the U.S. and attempt to assess taxes that are not provided for.
 
Dividends or other distributions from Platinum Finance to Platinum Regency are subject to U.S. withholding tax which is based upon, among other items, cumulative taxable earnings and profits of Platinum Finance.
 
The 2003 income tax return of our U.S.-based subsidiaries is currently under examination by the U.S. Internal Revenue Service. The income tax returns that remain open to examination are for calendar years 2008 and forward.
 
Under current Irish law, Platinum Regency is taxed at a 25% corporate income tax rate on non-trading income and a 12.5% corporate income tax rate on trading income.  There is generally no withholding tax on dividends distributed from Platinum Regency to Platinum Holdings.
 
The following table presents our income or loss before income taxes by jurisdiction for the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009 ($ in thousands):

   
2011
   
2010
   
2009
 
United States
  $ 7,351     $ 130,305     $ 15,970  
Bermuda
    (235,596 )     122,940       365,521  
Other
    1,048       5,407       6,085  
Income (loss) before income taxes
  $ (227,197 )   $ 258,652     $ 387,576  

The following table presents our current and deferred income taxes for the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009 ($ in thousands):

   
2011
   
2010
   
2009
 
Current tax expense
  $ 2,117     $ 32,656     $ 7,808  
Deferred tax expense (benefit)
    (5,250 )     10,498       (3,523 )
Income tax expense (benefit)
  $ (3,133 )   $ 43,154     $ 4,285  
 
 
F-22

 
 
Platinum Underwriters Holdings, Ltd. and Subsidiaries
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS - (Continued)
 
The following table presents a reconciliation of expected income taxes, computed by applying the tax rate of 0% under Bermuda law to income or loss before income taxes, to income tax expense or benefit for the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009 ($ in thousands):
   
2011
   
2010
   
2009
 
Expected income tax expense (benefit) at 0%
  $ -     $ -     $ -  
Foreign taxes at local expected rates:
                       
United States
    2,573       45,607       5,590  
Other
    263       1,345       1,500  
Tax exempt investment income
    (5,040 )     (5,207 )     (6,129 )
U.S. withholding tax (recovery)
    (600 )     600       600  
U.S. state taxes, net of U.S. federal tax benefit
    476       415       54  
Prior year adjustment
    -       (740     1,713  
Non-deductible expenses and other
    (805 )     1,134       957  
Income tax expense (benefit)
  $ (3,133 )   $ 43,154     $ 4,285  
 
The following table presents the tax effects of temporary differences that give rise to the deferred tax assets and deferred tax liabilities as of December 31, 2011 and 2010 ($ in thousands):

   
2011
   
2010
 
Deferred tax assets:
           
Unpaid losses and LAE
  $ 45,886     $ 42,406  
Unearned premiums
    6,855       8,471  
Deferred losses on investments
    -       5,523  
Temporary differences in recognition of expenses
    1,866       2,389  
Other
    1,611       -  
Total deferred tax assets
  56,218     $ 58,789  
                 
Deferred tax liabilities:
               
Deferred acquisition costs
  8,556     $ 10,525  
Deferred gains on investments
    15,539       -  
Other
    510       487  
Total deferred tax liabilities
    24,605       11,012  
Net deferred tax assets
  $ 31,613     $ 47,777  

The deferred tax assets and liabilities as of December 31, 2011 and 2010 were all related to U.S. income tax.  To evaluate the recoverability of the deferred tax assets, we consider the timing of the reversal of deferred income and expense items as well as the likelihood that we will generate sufficient taxable income to realize the future tax benefits.  We believe that it is more likely than not we will generate sufficient taxable income and realize the future tax benefits in order to recover the deferred assets and accordingly, no valuation allowance was established as of December 31, 2011 or 2010.
 
9.
Shareholders' Equity
 
Common Shares
 
Platinum Holdings is authorized to issue up to 200,000,000 common shares, $0.01 par value, and 25,000,000 preferred shares, $0.01 par value.  We had 35,526,400 and 37,757,926 common shares outstanding as of December 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively.
 
In 2002, Platinum Holdings completed an initial public offering of common shares.  Concurrently, Platinum Holdings sold 6,000,000 common shares and issued options to purchase 6,000,000 common shares to The St. Paul Companies, Inc., now a part of The Travelers Companies, Inc. (“Travelers”) and sold 3,960,000 common shares and issued options to purchase 2,500,000 common shares to RenaissanceRe Holdings Ltd. (“RenaissanceRe”).  The options had a ten-year term.  Travelers sold its 6,000,000 common shares in June 2004 and RenaissanceRe sold its 3,960,000 common shares in December 2005, in each case in public offerings. The options were amended to provide that in lieu of paying the exercise price of $27.00 per share, any option exercise will be settled on a net share basis, which would result in Platinum Holdings issuing a number of common shares equal to the excess of the market price per share, determined in accordance with the amendments, over $27.00, less the par value per share, multiplied by the number of common shares issuable upon exercise of the option divided by that market price per share.  In October 2010, we purchased, for an aggregate of $98.5 million in cash, the common share options issued to Travelers.  In January 2011, we purchased, for an aggregate of $47.9 million in cash, the common share options issued to RenaissanceRe.  The options were purchased under the Company’s share repurchase program and were canceled.
 
 
F-23

 
 
Platinum Underwriters Holdings, Ltd. and Subsidiaries
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS - (Continued)
 
Preferred Shares
 
On December 6, 2005, Platinum Holdings completed an offering of 5,750,000 6.0% Series A Mandatory Convertible Preferred Shares (our “Mandatory Convertible Preferred Shares”) at a price to the public of $30.15 per share, less related expenses under the unallocated shelf registration statement.  On February 17, 2009, our Mandatory Convertible Preferred Shares automatically converted into 5,750,000 common shares at a ratio of 1 to 1 which was based on the volume weighted average price of $29.90 of our common shares from January 14, 2009 through February 11, 2009.
 
Share Repurchases
 
Our Board of Directors has authorized the repurchase of our common shares through a share repurchase program.  The following table summarizes our repurchases of common shares for the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009 ($ in thousands, except per share data):

Year
 
Shares Repurchased
   
Weighted Average Cost per Share (1)
   
Aggregate Amount Paid
 
2011
    2,569,068     $ 36.86     $ 94,695  
2010
    9,672,231       39.25       379,675  
2009
    7,852,498     $ 32.13     $ 252,296  
 
(1) Including commissions.

The shares we repurchased were canceled.  As of December 31, 2011, the remaining amount available under the repurchase program was $176.6 million.  
 
Accumulated Other Comprehensive Income (Loss)
 
Accumulated other comprehensive income or loss is a component of shareholders’ equity and includes net unrealized gains or losses on fixed maturity available-for-sale securities and short-term investments, reclassification adjustments for investment gains and losses on available-for-sale securities included in net income, and the cumulative effect of the accounting change related to OTTI on January 1, 2009.
 
The components of other comprehensive income included in the statements of operations and comprehensive income for the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009 are as follows ($ in thousands):

   
2011
   
2010
   
2009
 
Other comprehensive income, before deferred tax:
                 
Net change in unrealized gains and losses on available-for-sale securities arising during the period
  $ 171,021     $ 123,144     $ 191,432  
Less reclassification adjustments:
                       
Net realized gains on investments
    854       109,419       48,832  
Net impairment losses on investments
    (22,370 )     (36,610 )     (17,603 )
Less: cumulative effect of accounting change
    -       -       15,102  
Other comprehensive income, before deferred tax
  $ 192,537     $ 50,335     $ 145,101  
                         
Deferred income tax (expense) benefit on:
                       
Net change in unrealized gains and losses on available-for-sale securities arising during the period
  $ (18,712 )   $ (18,213 )   $ (12,945 )
Less reclassification adjustments:
                       
Net realized gains on investments
    607       (17,867 )     (2,395 )
Net impairment losses on investments
    2,095       4,472       2,183  
Less: cumulative effect of accounting change
    -       -       (858 )
Deferred tax on other comprehensive income
  $ (21,414 )   $ (4,818 )   $ (11,875 )
                         
Other comprehensive income, net of deferred tax:
                       
Net change in unrealized gains and losses on available-for-sale securities arising during the period
  $ 152,309     $ 104,931     $ 178,487  
Less reclassification adjustments:
                       
Net realized gains on investments
    1,461       91,552       46,437  
Net impairment losses on investments
    (20,275 )     (32,138 )     (15,420 )
Less: cumulative effect of accounting change
    -       -       14,244  
Other comprehensive income, net of deferred tax
  $ 171,123     $ 45,517     $ 133,226  
 
 
F-24

 
 
Platinum Underwriters Holdings, Ltd. and Subsidiaries
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS - (Continued)
 
10.
Statutory Regulations and Dividend Capacity
 
Our reinsurance subsidiaries in Bermuda and the United States are subject to reinsurance laws and regulations in the jurisdictions in which they operate.  Platinum Bermuda and Platinum US file financial statements prepared in accordance with statutory accounting practices prescribed or permitted by insurance regulatory authorities in Bermuda and United States, respectively.  The differences between statutory basis financial statements and financial statements prepared in accordance with U.S. GAAP vary between jurisdictions.  The principal differences in Bermuda are that statutory basis financial statements do not reflect deferred acquisition costs, prepaid assets or fixed assets.  Also, reinsurance assets and liabilities are presented net of retrocessional reinsurance and there is no cash flow statement.  The principal differences in the U.S. are that statutory basis financial statements do not reflect deferred acquisition costs, bonds are generally carried at amortized cost, deferred income tax is charged or credited directly to equity (subject to limitations) and reinsurance assets and liabilities are presented net of retrocessional reinsurance.  In preparing our statutory basis financial statements, we have used only statutory accounting practices that are prescribed by the relevant regulatory authorities.

The combined statutory capital and surplus and statutory net income or loss for our reinsurance subsidiaries as of the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009 are as follows ($ in thousands):
 
   
(Unaudited)
             
   
2011
   
2010
   
2009
 
Statutory capital and surplus:
                 
Bermuda
  $ 1,146,426     $ 1,366,414     $ 1,569,846  
United States
    528,058       642,820       586,269  
Total statutory capital and surplus
  $ 1,674,484     $ 2,009,234     $ 2,156,115  
                         
Statutory net income (loss):
                       
Bermuda
  $ (218,593 )   $ 145,105     $ 390,994  
United States
    25,088       111,154       28,559  
Total statutory net income (loss)
  $ (193,505 )   $ 256,259     $ 419,553  

The laws and regulations of Bermuda and the United States include certain restrictions on the amount of dividends that can be paid by Platinum Bermuda and Platinum US to their respective parent companies, Platinum Holdings and Platinum Finance, without the prior approval of the relevant regulatory authorities.  Based on regulatory restrictions, the unaudited maximum amount available for payment of dividends by our reinsurance subsidiaries during 2012 without prior regulatory approval is as follows ($ in thousands):
 
Platinum Bermuda
  $ 286,607  
Platinum US
    52,806  
Total
  $ 339,413  

During the year ended December 31, 2011, dividends of $300.0 million were paid by the reinsurance subsidiaries of Platinum Holdings, of which $255.0 million was paid by Platinum Bermuda to Platinum Holdings and $45.0 million was paid by Platinum US to Platinum Finance.
 
During the year ended December 31, 2011, Platinum US repaid a $100.0 million surplus note to Platinum Regency, the parent company of Platinum Finance, and Platinum Regency paid dividends of $100.0 million to Platinum Holdings.  There are no regulatory restrictions on the amount of dividends that Platinum Finance can pay to Platinum Regency.  Irish law prohibits Platinum Regency from declaring a dividend to its shareholders unless it has “profits available for distribution.”  The determination of whether a company has profits available for distribution is based on its accumulated realized profits less its accumulated realized losses.

11.
Operating Segment Information
 
We have organized our worldwide reinsurance business into the following three operating segments: Property and Marine, Casualty and Finite Risk.  The Property and Marine segment includes principally property and marine reinsurance coverages that are written in the United States and international markets.  This operating segment includes property reinsurance, crop reinsurance and marine and aviation reinsurance.  The Property and Marine segment includes property catastrophe and marine excess-of-loss reinsurance contracts, property and marine per-risk excess-of-loss reinsurance contracts and property proportional reinsurance contracts.  The Casualty segment includes reinsurance contracts that cover general and product liability, professional liability, accident and health, umbrella liability, workers' compensation, casualty clash, automobile liability, surety, trade credit, and political risk.  We generally seek to write casualty reinsurance on an excess-of-loss basis.  The Finite Risk operating segment includes principally structured reinsurance contracts with ceding companies whose needs may not be met efficiently through traditional reinsurance products.  In exchange for contractual features that limit our risk, reinsurance contracts that we include in our Finite Risk segment typically provide the potential for significant profit commission to the ceding company.  The classes of risks underwritten through our finite risk contracts are generally consistent with the classes covered by our traditional products.  The finite risk reinsurance contracts that we underwrite generally provide prospective protection, meaning coverage is provided for losses that are incurred after inception of the contract, as contrasted with retrospective coverage, which covers losses that are incurred prior to inception of the contract.  The three main categories of finite risk contracts are quota share, multi-year excess-of-loss and whole account aggregate stop loss.
 
 
F-25

 
 
Platinum Underwriters Holdings, Ltd. and Subsidiaries
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS - (Continued)
 
In managing our operating segments, we use measures such as net underwriting income and underwriting ratios to evaluate segment performance.  We do not allocate assets or certain income and expenses such as net investment income, net realized gains and losses on investments, net impairment losses on investments, net changes in fair value of derivatives, net foreign currency exchange gains and losses, interest expense and certain corporate expenses by segment.  The measures we use in evaluating our operating segments should not be used as a substitute for measures determined under U.S. GAAP.  The following table summarizes underwriting activity and ratios for the three operating segments, together with a reconciliation of underwriting income (loss) to income (loss) before income taxes for the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009 ($ in thousands):
 
   
Year Ended December 31, 2011
 
   
Property and Marine
   
Casualty
   
Finite Risk
   
Total
 
Net premiums written
  $ 344,682     $ 296,989     $ 9,843     $ 651,514  
                                 
Net premiums earned
    356,976       318,734       13,742       689,452  
Net losses and loss adjustment expenses
    628,062       178,650       (1,275 )     805,437  
Net acquisition expenses
    49,348       72,738       11,091       133,177  
Other underwriting expenses
    27,622       19,002       940       47,564  
Segment underwriting income (loss)
  $ (348,056 )   $ 48,344     $ 2,986       (296,726 )
                                 
Net investment income
                            125,863  
Net realized gains (losses) on investments
                            3,934  
Net impairment losses on investments
                            (22,370 )
Other income (expense)
                            645  
Net changes in fair value of derivatives
                            (4,329 )
Corporate expenses not allocated to segments
                            (15,615 )
Net foreign currency exchange (losses) gains
                            473  
Interest expense
                            (19,072 )
Income (loss) before income taxes
                          $ (227,197 )
                                 
Underwriting ratios:
                               
Net loss and loss adjustment expense
    175.9 %     56.0 %     (9.3 %)     116.8 %
Net acquisition expense
    13.8 %     22.8 %     80.7 %     19.3 %
Other underwriting expense
    7.7 %     6.0 %     6.8 %     6.9 %
Combined
    197.4 %     84.8 %     78.2 %     143.0 %
                                 
                                 
   
Year Ended December 31, 2010
 
   
Property and Marine
   
Casualty
   
Finite Risk
   
Total
 
Net premiums written
  $ 412,675     $ 329,397     $ 18,517     $ 760,589  
                                 
Net premiums earned
    418,763       343,812       17,419       779,994  
Net losses and loss adjustment expenses
    343,509       119,679       4,232       467,420  
Net acquisition expenses
    60,224       71,474       14,978       146,676  
Other underwriting expenses
    32,678       23,091       1,260       57,029  
Segment underwriting income (loss)
  $ (17,648 )   $ 129,568     $ (3,051 )     108,869  
                                 
Net investment income
                            134,385  
Net realized gains (losses) on investments
                            107,791  
Net impairment losses on investments
                            (36,610 )
Other income (expense)
                            (207 )
Net changes in fair value of derivatives
                            (9,588 )
Corporate expenses not allocated to segments
                            (25,607 )
Net foreign currency exchange (losses) gains
                            (1,385 )
Interest expense
                            (18,996 )
Income (loss) before income taxes
                          $ 258,652  
                                 
Underwriting ratios:
                               
Net loss and loss adjustment expense
    82.0 %     34.8 %     24.3 %     59.9 %
Net acquisition expense
    14.4 %     20.8 %     86.0 %     18.8 %
Other underwriting expense
    7.8 %     6.7 %     7.2 %     7.3 %
Combined
    104.2 %     62.3 %     117.5 %     86.0 %
                                 
 
 
F-26

 
 
Platinum Underwriters Holdings, Ltd. and Subsidiaries
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS - (Continued)
 
   
Year Ended December 31, 2009
 
   
Property and Marine
   
Casualty
   
Finite Risk
   
Total
 
Net premiums written
  $ 517,011     $ 356,488     $ 24,335     $ 897,834  
                                 
Net premiums earned
    528,488       388,901       19,947       937,336  
Net losses and loss adjustment expenses
    250,646       226,511       1,185       478,342  
Net acquisition expenses
    66,992       88,841       20,586       176,419  
Other underwriting expenses
    37,331       25,644       1,412       64,387  
Segment underwriting income (loss)
  $ 173,519     $ 47,905     $ (3,236 )     218,188  
                                 
Net investment income
                            163,941  
Net realized gains (losses) on investments
                            78,630  
Net impairment losses on investments
                            (17,603 )
Other income (expense)
                            3,084  
Net changes in fair value of derivatives
                            (9,741 )
Corporate expenses not allocated to segments
                            (30,295 )
Net foreign currency exchange (losses) gains
                            399  
Interest expense
                            (19,027 )
Income (loss) before income taxes
                          $ 387,576  
                                 
Underwriting ratios:
                               
Net loss and loss adjustment expense
    47.4 %     58.2 %     5.9 %     51.0 %
Net acquisition expense
    12.7 %     22.8 %     103.2 %     18.8 %
Other underwriting expense
    7.1 %     6.6 %     7.1 %     6.9 %
Combined
    67.2 %     87.6 %     116.2 %     76.7 %

The following table presents our net premiums written for the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009 by geographic location of the ceding company ($ in thousands):

   
2011
   
2010
   
2009
 
United States
  $ 457,735     $ 527,097     $ 690,483  
International
    193,779       233,492       207,351  
Total
  $ 651,514     $ 760,589     $ 897,834  

12.
Share Incentive Compensation and Employee Benefit Plans
 
Share Incentive Compensation

We have a share incentive plan under which our employees and directors may be granted options, restricted shares, restricted share units, share appreciation rights, or other rights to acquire shares.  Upon effectiveness, our 2010 Share Incentive Plan (the "Plan") had an aggregate of 3,572,977 common shares available and reserved for issuance, which was comprised of 3,100,000 common shares as set forth in the Plan, plus authorized and unissued shares that remained available under a predecessor share incentive plan.  Share incentive awards granted under the Plan typically vest annually over a specified period of up to four years.
 
The following table provides the total share-based compensation expense recognized during the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009 ($ in thousands):

   
2011
   
2010
   
2009
 
Share-based compensation expense
  $ 3,819     $ 14,338     $ 16,463  
Tax benefit
    (598 )     (2,025 )     (2,267 )
Share based compensation expense, net of tax
  $ 3,221     $ 12,313     $ 14,196  
 
 
F-27

 
 
Platinum Underwriters Holdings, Ltd. and Subsidiaries
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS - (Continued)
 
(i)           Share options
 
Option awards generally vest over a three or four year period and expire ten years from the date of grant. 
 
The following table sets forth information regarding outstanding options for the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009 (amounts in thousands, except weighted average exercise prices of options):

   
As of and for the Years Ended
 
   
December 31, 2011
   
December 31, 2010
   
December 31, 2009
 
   
Options
   
Weighted Average Exercise Price
   
Options
   
Weighted Average Exercise Price
   
Options
   
Weighted Average Exercise Price
 
Outstanding - beginning of year
    1,081     $ 31.64       2,238     $ 31.12       2,574     $ 30.48  
Granted
    -       -       -       -       -       -  
Exercised
    (48 )     25.87       (1,133 )     30.56       (274 )     24.63  
Forfeited
    (3 )     33.96       (24 )     34.35       (62 )     33.22  
Outstanding - end of year
    1,030     $ 31.90       1,081     $ 31.64       2,238     $ 31.12  
Options exercisable at year end
    966               838               1,745          
Weighted average exercise price of options exercisable at year end
          $ 31.77             $ 30.92             $ 30.33  

Share-based compensation expense related to these awards was $0.6 million, $1.6 million and $2.1 million in 2011, 2010 and 2009, respectively.  As of December 31, 2011, there was less than $0.1 million of unrecognized compensation cost related to outstanding options, all of which is expected to be recognized by the end of the first quarter of 2012.  The weighted average remaining contractual terms of all outstanding options and options exercisable were 4.6 years and 4.5 years, respectively, as of December 31, 2011.

The following table presents the intrinsic and fair values of the options exercised and vested during the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009 ($ in thousands):

   
2011
   
2010
   
2009
 
Intrinsic value of options exercised (1)
  $ 707     $ 9,865     $ 2,949  
Fair value of options exercised (2)
    379       6,622       2,117  
Fair value of options vested (2)
  $ 1,496     $ 1,917     $ 2,544  

(1)
Represents the difference between the market value and exercise price on the date of exercise.
(2)
Based on the Black-Scholes option pricing model.
 
Our computation of expected volatility was based on 5 years of historical volatility using daily price observations.  Our computation of expected option life was based on historical data analysis of exercises, forfeitures, and post-vest cancellations.  The forfeitures are used to determine the outstanding pool of options and do not affect the expected term calculation (either historical or projected).  The exercises and post-vest cancellations are used to calculate the time between grant and settlement date (exercise date or post-vest cancel date), and then weighted by the shares settled (options exercised or canceled).

(ii)           Restricted Shares
 
Restricted shares are granted on a periodic basis.  There were no restricted shares granted in 2011.  The restricted shares we have granted generally vest in equal annual tranches.
 
The following table sets forth information regarding outstanding restricted shares as of December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009 (amounts in thousands, except per share weighted average grant date fair value):

   
As of and for the Years Ended
 
   
December 31, 2011
   
December 31, 2010
   
December 31, 2009
 
   
Restricted Shares
   
Weighted Average Grant Date Fair Value
   
Restricted Shares
   
Weighted Average Grant Date Fair Value
   
Restricted Shares
   
Weighted Average Grant Date Fair Value
 
Outstanding - beginning of year
    217     $ 36.21       229     $ 35.75       270     $ 34.91  
Granted
    -       -       80       36.73       66       36.22  
Vested
    (71 )     35.61       (82 )     35.56       (107 )     33.90  
Forfeited
    -       -       (10 )     35.19       -       -  
Outstanding - end of year
    146     $ 36.50       217     $ 36.21       229     $ 35.75  
 
 
F-28

 
 
Platinum Underwriters Holdings, Ltd. and Subsidiaries
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS - (Continued)
 
The fair value of restricted shares at the grant date was $3.0 million and $2.4 million in 2010 and 2009, respectively.  Share-based compensation expense related to these awards was $3.1 million, $3.9 million and $3.4 million in 2011, 2010 and 2009, respectively.   As of December 31, 2011, there was $2.3 million of unrecognized compensation cost related to restricted share awards that is expected to be recognized over a weighted-average period of 1.1 years.

(iii)           Restricted Share Units
 
Service Based Awards Under the Share Incentive Plan
 
Service based restricted share units granted in 2008 and prior years generally vest in equal tranches on the third and fourth anniversaries of the grant date and restricted share units granted subsequent to 2008 vest pro rata over a four year period.
 
The following table sets forth information regarding outstanding restricted share units for our service based awards under our share incentive plan for the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009 (amounts in thousands, except per share weighted average grant date fair value):

   
As of and for the Years Ended
 
   
December 31, 2011
   
December 31, 2010
   
December 31, 2009
 
   
Restricted Share Units
   
Weighted Average Grant Date Fair Value
   
Restricted Share Units
   
Weighted Average Grant Date Fair Value
   
Restricted Share Units
   
Weighted Average Grant Date Fair Value
 
Outstanding - beginning of year
    366     $ 33.76       399     $ 31.96       332     $ 33.31  
Granted
    109       43.20       135       37.08       151       28.81  
Vested
    (176 )     33.88       (141 )     31.80       (69 )     31.37  
Forfeited
    (19 )     36.65       (27 )     33.52       (15 )     32.90  
Outstanding - end of year
    280     $ 37.17       366     $ 33.76       399     $ 31.96  

The fair value of service based awards of restricted share units at the grant date was $4.7 million, $5.0 million and $4.4 million in 2011, 2010 and 2009, respectively. Share-based compensation expense related to these awards was $4.0 million, $4.0 million and $3.6 million in 2011, 2010 and 2009, respectively.  As of December 31, 2011, there was $6.2 million of unrecognized compensation cost related to restricted share unit awards that is expected to be recognized over a weighted-average period of 1.1 years.
 
Long-term Performance Based Awards Under the Executive Incentive Plan
 
Our executive incentive plan is a long-term performance based incentive plan that provides for awards of restricted share units that may be settled in shares or cash. The executive incentive plan utilizes shares reserved under the share incentive plan for share-settled awards.  Awards that are settled in cash are discussed below under liability-classified awards.  Awards under the plan generally have a three year performance and vesting period, beginning with the grant year, and the actual number of common shares or amount of cash that each participant receives varies based on the average return on equity in the performance period.  An average return on equity of 18% or more results in a settlement of 200% of the initial award in common shares and an average return on equity of less than 6% reduces the award to zero.  An average return on equity between 6% and 18% results in a settlement of 1% to 200% of the initial award in cash or common shares determined through straight line interpolation.

a)  Equity-Classified Awards:
 
The grant date fair value of the executive incentive plan awards that are settled in common shares was $0.3 million, $3.7 million and $3.4 million in 2011, 2010 and 2009, respectively.  These restricted share units are generally settled in common shares at the completion of the performance period or upon certain terminations of employment on a prorated basis.
 
As a result of the decline in the average return on equity of the performance periods during the year ended December 31, 2011, $3.9 million of previously recognized share-based compensation expense related to restricted share units granted under our long-term performance based incentive plan was reversed.  Share-based compensation expense related to these awards was $4.8 million and $6.6 million in 2010 and 2009, respectively, and was based on estimates as of December 31, 2010 and 2009 of the average return on equity for the related performance periods.  As of December 31, 2011, there was no estimated unrecognized compensation cost related to these awards.
 
For the three-year performance periods ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009, restricted share units earned by our executives who participated in the full three-year performance period for the executive incentive share grants were 20,333 shares for the 2009 grants, 126,436 shares for the 2008 grants, and 163,968 shares for the 2007 grants, respectively. These shares vested in the period subsequent to the end of the three-year performance period.  In addition, in 2011 restricted share units earned and vested upon terminations of certain executives were 5,253 and 23,284 for the 2010 and 2009 grant years, respectively.
 
 
F-29

 
 
Platinum Underwriters Holdings, Ltd. and Subsidiaries
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS - (Continued)
 
The following table sets forth information regarding outstanding restricted share units for our equity-classified awards under our long-term performance based incentive plan for the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009 (amounts in thousands, except per share grant date fair value):

   
As of and for the Years Ended
 
   
December 31, 2011
   
December 31, 2010
   
December 31, 2009
 
   
Restricted Share Units
   
Weighted Average Grant Date Fair Value
   
Restricted Share Units
   
Weighted Average Grant Date Fair Value
   
Restricted Share Units
   
Weighted Average Grant Date Fair Value
 
Outstanding - beginning of year
    412     $ 31.91       483     $ 32.03       357     $ 32.71  
Granted
    6       43.67       99       36.90       119       28.65  
Vested
    (155 )     33.23       (164 )     34.43       (149 )     30.58  
Forfeited
    (39 )     32.90       -       -       -       -  
Performance adjustment
    (205 )     31.40       (6 )     55.56       156       31.68  
Outstanding - end of year
    19     $ 28.65       412     $ 31.91       483     $ 32.03  

b)  Liability-Classified Awards:
 
During 2011, we granted restricted share units under our long-term performance based incentive plan to certain executive officers that are settled in cash.  Restricted share units settled in cash are classified as liability awards.  They are recorded at fair value based on the market price of our stock at the end of each reporting period.  The grant date fair value of these restricted share units was $3.0 million in 2011.  There were no liability-classified grants in 2010 or 2009.
 
As a result of negative return on equity for the year ended December 31, 2011, we recorded no share-based compensation expense related to these awards in 2011 and, as of December 31, 2011, there was no estimated unrecognized compensation cost related to these awards.
 
The following table sets forth information regarding outstanding restricted share units for our liability-classified awards under our long-term performance based incentive plan for the year ended December 31, 2011 (amounts in thousands, except per share grant date fair value):

   
As of and for the Year Ended
 
   
December 31, 2011
 
   
Restricted Share Units
   
Weighted Average Grant Date Fair Value
 
Outstanding - beginning of year
    -     $ -  
Granted
    70       43.67  
Converted
    -       -  
Forfeited
    -       -  
Performance adjustment
    (70 )     43.67  
Outstanding - end of year
    -     $ -  

Additionally, during 2005, we granted variable long-term incentive cash awards to certain executive officers which had a grant date fair value of $1.8 million.  The cash settlement value of the awards was based on a percentage of the recipients’ average salary over a five-year performance period, beginning in the grant year, and a multiplier of 0% to 200%, based on the average return on equity in the five-year period, determined through straight line interpolation.  The Company recognized $0.8 million of share-based compensation expense related to these awards in 2009 based on the settlement value.  As of December 31, 2009, there was no unrecognized compensation cost related to these awards and they vested and settled for $1.3 million in 2010.
 
Share Unit Plan for Non-Employee Directors
 
For years prior to 2009, members of our Board of Directors received all or a portion of their directors’ fees in the form of share units.  In February 2010, the share unit plan was terminated as to future awards.  These awards were fully vested at the grant date and are settled in common shares or cash the earlier of 5 years from the grant date or when the participant ceases to be a member of the Board of Directors.  As at December 31, 2011, 21,585 share units were vested but not settled.
 
Defined Contribution Plans
 
The Company provides retirement benefits to employees through defined contribution plans whereby the Company contributes an amount to each employee equal to a specified percentage of the employee’s salary.  The defined contribution plans consist of plans in the United States, Bermuda and the United Kingdom.  Participants in the U.S. plan are required to make a contribution to the plan in order to receive the full Company contribution.  Expenses related to the defined contribution plans were $2.2 million, $2.3 million and $2.3 million for the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009, respectively.
 
 
F-30

 
 
Platinum Underwriters Holdings, Ltd. and Subsidiaries
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS - (Continued)
 
13.
Earnings (Loss) per Common Share
 
The following is a reconciliation of the basic and diluted earnings or loss per common share computations for the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009 ($ and amounts in thousands, except per share data):

   
2011
   
2010
   
2009
 
Earnings (Loss)
                 
Basic
                 
Net income (loss) attributable to common shareholders
  $ (224,064 )   $ 215,498     $ 381,990  
Net income (loss) allocated to participating common shareholders (1)
    (1,189 )     -       -  
Net income (loss) allocated to common shareholders
  $ (222,875 )   $ 215,498     $ 381,990  
                         
Diluted
                       
Net income (loss) allocated to common shareholders
  $ (222,875 )   $ 215,498     $ 381,990  
Effect of dilutive securities:
                       
Preferred dividends
    -       -       1,301  
Adjusted net income (loss) for diluted earnings per common share
  $ (222,875 )   $ 215,498     $ 383,291  
                         
Common Shares
                       
Basic
                       
Weighted average common shares outstanding
    36,901       41,930       49,535  
                         
Diluted
                       
Weighted average common shares outstanding
    36,901       41,930       49,535  
Effect of dilutive securities:
                       
Conversion of preferred shares
    -       -       756  
Common share options
    164       2,610       1,595  
Restricted share units
    195       512       429  
Adjusted weighted average common shares outstanding
    37,260       45,052       52,315  
                         
Earnings (Loss) Per Common Share
                       
Basic earnings (loss) per common share
  $ (6.04 )   $ 5.14     $ 7.71  
Diluted earnings (loss) per common share (2)
  $ (6.04 )   $ 4.78     $ 7.33  
 
(1)
Represents earnings attributable to holders of unvested restricted shares issued under the Company's share incentive plans that are considered to be participating securities.
(2)
During a period of loss, the basic weighted average common shares outstanding is used in the denominator of the diluted loss per common share computation as the effect of including potential dilutive shares would be anti-dilutive.

14.
Related Party Transactions and Agreements
 
Platinum US had a two year consulting agreement with SHN Enterprises, Inc. ("SHN") beginning in 2008.  Steven H. Newman, the former chairman of our Board of Directors, was the President of SHN.  Expenses incurred pursuant to the agreement with SHN in 2009 were approximately $0.5 million.  There were no expenses incurred in 2011 and 2010.  Additionally in 2008, Platinum Holdings entered into a nonqualified share option agreement with the former chairman, under the terms of which he was granted a fully vested option for the purchase of 500,000 common shares at an exercise price of $36.00 per share.  All options were exercised in 2010.
 
15.
Commitments and Contingencies
 
Lease Commitments
 
The following table presents our future minimum annual lease commitments under various non-cancelable operating leases for our facilities ($ in thousands):

Years Ending December 31,
     
2012
  $ 2,843  
2013
    1,188  
2014
    243  
2015
    165  
2016
    132  
Thereafter
    37  
Total
  $ 4,608  

Operating lease expense was $2.8 million, $2.6 million and $2.7 million for the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009, respectively.
 
 
F-31

 
 
Platinum Underwriters Holdings, Ltd. and Subsidiaries
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS - (Continued)
 
Employment Agreements
 
The Company has entered into employment agreements with its executive officers. These agreements provide for annual compensation in the form of salary, benefits, annual incentive payments, share-based awards, the reimbursement of certain expenses, as well as certain severance provisions. The severance provisions include accelerated vesting of share-based compensation under certain circumstances, such as upon a change in control, as defined by the Company’s Change in Control Severance Plan and Employee Severance Plan.
 
Concentrations of Credit Risk
 
The areas where significant concentration of credit risk may exist principally include investments, cash and cash equivalents, reinsurance premiums receivable and reinsurance recoverable. The Company limits the amount of credit exposure to any one financial institution and none of the Company’s investments exceeded 10% of shareholders’ equity at December 31, 2011. See Note 5, “Retrocessional Reinsurance” for information with respect to reinsurance recoverable. In addition, the Company underwrites a significant amount of its business through brokers and a credit risk exists should any of these brokers be unable to fulfill their contractual obligations with respect to the payments of reinsurance balances owed to and by the Company.
 
Litigation
 
In the normal course of business, we may become involved in various claims and legal proceedings.  We are not currently aware of any pending or threatened material litigation or arbitration other than in the ordinary course of our reinsurance business.  Estimated losses related to claims arising in the normal course of our reinsurance business, including the anticipated outcome of any pending arbitration or litigation, are included in unpaid losses and LAE in our consolidated balance sheets.

16.
Quarterly Financial Data (Unaudited)
 
The following quarterly financial information for each of the three months ended March 31, June 30, September 30 and December 31, 2011 and 2010 is unaudited.  However, in the opinion of management, all necessary adjustments have been made (consisting of normal recurring adjustments) to present fairly the results of operations for such periods ($ in thousands, except per share data):

   
Three Months Ended
 
   
December 31,
   
September 30,
   
June 30,
   
March 31,
 
   
2011
   
2011
   
2011
   
2011
 
Net premiums earned
  $ 167,322     $ 166,813     $ 172,436     $ 182,881  
Net investment income
    29,758       29,762       33,965       32,378  
Net losses and LAE
    125,032       201,453       159,357       319,595  
Net acquisition expenses
    34,904       30,208       34,115       33,950  
Operating expenses
    14,168       14,755       17,105       17,151  
Net income (loss) attributable to common shareholders
  $ 7,064     $ (53,535 )   $ (20,401 )   $ (157,192 )
Earnings (loss) per common share:
                               
Basic
  $ 0.20     $ (1.43 )   $ (0.55 )   $ (4.20 )
Diluted
  $ 0.19     $ (1.43 )   $ (0.55 )   $ (4.20 )
Average common shares outstanding:
                               
Basic
    36,117       37,183       37,113       37,199  
Diluted
    36,302       37,360       37,399       38,022  
 
   
Three Months Ended
 
   
December 31,
   
September 30,
   
June 30,
   
March 31,
 
   
2010
   
2010
   
2010
   
2010
 
Net premiums earned
  $ 184,980     $ 183,404     $ 191,432     $ 220,178  
Net investment income
    30,430       31,078       35,372       37,505  
Net losses and LAE
    152,283       79,094       71,475       164,568  
Net acquisition expenses
    32,742       32,517       44,088       37,329  
Operating expenses
    20,731       20,004       20,160       21,741  
Net income (loss) attributable to common shareholders
  $ (17,724 )   $ 93,662     $ 124,139     $ 15,421  
Earnings (loss) per common share:
                               
Basic
  $ (0.46 )   $ 2.31     $ 2.87     $ 0.34  
Diluted
  $ (0.46 )   $ 2.13     $ 2.68     $ 0.32  
Average common shares outstanding:
                               
Basic
    38,670       40,485       43,225       45,431  
Diluted
    40,953       44,044       46,249       48,494  
 
17.
Condensed Consolidating Financial Information

Platinum Holdings fully and unconditionally guarantees the $250.0 million of debt obligations issued by Platinum Finance as described in Note 7.
 
The following tables present the condensed consolidating financial information for Platinum Holdings, Platinum Finance and the non-guarantor subsidiaries of Platinum Holdings as of December 31, 2011 and 2010 and for the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009 ($ in thousands):
 
 
F-32

 
 
Platinum Underwriters Holdings, Ltd. and Subsidiaries
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS - (Continued)
 
Condensed Consolidating Balance Sheet
December 31, 2011
 
   
Platinum
Holdings
   
Platinum
Finance
   
Non-guarantor Subsidiaries
   
Consolidating Adjustments
   
Consolidated
 
ASSETS
                                   
Total investments
  $ -     $ 274     $ 3,377,260     $ -     $ 3,377,534  
Investment in subsidiaries
    1,638,898       621,041       484,561       (2,744,500 )     -  
Cash and cash equivalents
    47,791       108,260       636,459       -       792,510  
Reinsurance assets
    -       -       297,374       -       297,374  
Other assets
    6,229       6,620       71,344       -       84,193  
Total assets
  $ 1,692,918     $ 736,195     $ 4,866,998     $ (2,744,500 )   $ 4,551,611  
LIABILITIES AND SHAREHOLDERS' EQUITY
                                       
Liabilities
                                       
Reinsurance liabilities
  $ -     $ -     $ 2,573,701     $ -     $ 2,573,701  
Debt obligations
    -       250,000       -       -       250,000  
Other liabilities
    2,059       1,634       33,358       -       37,051  
Total liabilities
  $ 2,059     $ 251,634     $ 2,607,059     $ -     $ 2,860,752  
                                         
Shareholders' Equity
                                       
Common Shares
  $ 355     $ -     $ 8,000     $ (8,000 )   $ 355  
Additional paid-in capital
    313,730       213,342       2,000,335       (2,213,677 )     313,730  
Accumulated other comprehensive income (loss)
    146,635       41,277       187,903       (229,180 )     146,635  
Retained earnings
    1,230,139       229,942       63,701       (293,643 )     1,230,139  
Total shareholders' equity
  $ 1,690,859     $ 484,561     $ 2,259,939     $ (2,744,500 )   $ 1,690,859  
                                         
Total liabilities and shareholders' equity
  $ 1,692,918     $ 736,195     $ 4,866,998     $ (2,744,500 )   $ 4,551,611  
 
Condensed Consolidating Balance Sheet
December 31, 2010
 
   
Platinum
Holdings
   
Platinum
Finance
   
Non-guarantor
Subsidiaries
   
Consolidating Adjustments
   
Consolidated
 
ASSETS
                                   
Total investments
  $ -     $ 394     $ 3,224,227     $ -     $ 3,224,621  
Investment in subsidiaries
    1,910,617       599,965       434,539       (2,945,121 )     -  
Cash and cash equivalents
    45,035       7,347       935,495       -       987,877  
Reinsurance assets
    -       -       301,778       -       301,778  
Inter-company loans (1)
    -       75,000       -       (75,000 )     -  
Other assets
    17,337       3,111       80,096       (507 )     100,037  
Total assets
  $ 1,972,989     $ 685,817     $ 4,976,135     $ (3,020,628 )   $ 4,614,313  
LIABILITIES AND SHAREHOLDERS' EQUITY
                                       
Liabilities
                                       
Reinsurance liabilities
  $ -     $ -     $ 2,431,741     $ -     $ 2,431,741  
Debt obligations
    -       250,000       -       -       250,000  
Inter-company loans (1)
    75,000       -       -       (75,000 )     -  
Other liabilities
    2,534       1,592       33,498       (507 )     37,117  
Total liabilities
  $ 77,534     $ 251,592     $ 2,465,239     $ (75,507 )   $ 2,718,858  
                                         
Shareholders' Equity
                                       
Common Shares
  $ 377     $ -     $ 8,000     $ (8,000 )   $ 377  
Additional paid-in capital
    453,619       212,956       1,876,561       (2,089,517 )     453,619  
Accumulated other comprehensive income (loss)
    (24,488 )     1,509       (22,991 )     21,482       (24,488 )
Retained earnings
    1,465,947       219,760       649,326       (869,086 )     1,465,947  
Total shareholders' equity
  $ 1,895,455     $ 434,225     $ 2,510,896     $ (2,945,121 )   $ 1,895,455  
                                         
Total liabilities and shareholders' equity
  $ 1,972,989     $ 685,817     $ 4,976,135     $ (3,020,628 )   $ 4,614,313  
 
(1) During 2010, Platinum Finance provided loans to Platinum Holdings of $75.0 million, due February 1, 2011.  These loans were repaid on February 1, 2011.
 
 
F-33

 
 
Platinum Underwriters Holdings, Ltd. and Subsidiaries
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS - (Continued)
 
Condensed Consolidating Statement of Operations
For the Year Ended December 31, 2011

   
Platinum
Holdings
   
Platinum
Finance
   
Non-guarantor Subsidiaries
   
Consolidating Adjustments
   
Consolidated
 
Revenue:
                                   
Net premiums earned
  $ -     $ -     $ 689,452     $ -     $ 689,452  
Net investment income
    5       25       125,886       (53 )     125,863  
Net realized gains on investments
    -       -       3,934       -       3,934  
Net impairment losses on investments
    -       -       (22,370 )     -       (22,370 )
Other income (expense)
    (573 )     121       1,097       -       645  
Total revenue
    (568 )     146       797,999       (53 )     797,524  
                                         
Expenses:
                                       
Net losses and loss adjustment expenses
    -       -       805,437       -       805,437  
Net acquisition expenses
    -       -       133,177       -       133,177  
Net changes in fair value of derivatives
    -       -       4,329       -       4,329  
Operating expenses
    15,813       341       47,025       -       63,179  
Net foreign currency exchange losses (gains)
    1       -       (474 )     -       (473 )
Interest expense
    53       19,072       -       (53 )     19,072  
Total expenses
    15,867       19,413       989,494       (53 )     1,024,721  
Income (loss) before income taxes
    (16,435 )     (19,267 )     (191,495 )     -       (227,197 )
Income tax expense (benefit)
    (600 )     (6,531 )     3,998       -       (3,133 )
Income (loss) before equity in earnings of subsidiaries
    (15,835 )     (12,736 )     (195,493 )     -       (224,064 )
Equity in earnings of subsidiaries
    (208,229 )     22,918       10,182       175,129       -  
Net income (loss)
  $ (224,064 )   $ 10,182     $ (185,311 )   $ 175,129     $ (224,064 )
                                         
 
Condensed Consolidating Statement of Operations
For the Year Ended December 31, 2010

   
Platinum
Holdings
   
Platinum
Finance
   
Non-guarantor Subsidiaries
   
Consolidating Adjustments
   
Consolidated
 
Revenue:
                                   
Net premiums earned
  $ -     $ -     $ 779,994     $ -     $ 779,994  
Net investment income
    82       209       134,172       (78 )     134,385  
Net realized gains on investments
    -       81       107,710       -       107,791  
Net impairment losses on investments
    -       -       (36,610 )     -       (36,610 )
Other income (expense)
    4,225       -       (4,432 )     -       (207 )
Total revenue
    4,307       290       980,834       (78 )     985,353  
                                         
Expenses:
                                       
Net losses and loss adjustment expenses
    -       -       467,420       -       467,420  
Net acquisition expenses
    -       -       146,676       -       146,676  
Net changes in fair value of derivatives
    -       -       9,588       -       9,588  
Operating expenses
    26,108       229       56,299       -       82,636  
Net foreign currency exchange losses (gains)
    -       -       1,381       4       1,385  
Interest expense
    78       18,996       -       (78 )     18,996  
Total expenses
    26,186       19,225       681,364       (74 )     726,701  
Income (loss) before income taxes
    (21,879 )     (18,935 )     299,470       (4 )     258,652  
Income tax expense (benefit)
    600       (6,524 )     49,078       -       43,154  
Income (loss) before equity in earnings of subsidiaries
    (22,479 )     (12,411 )     250,392       (4 )     215,498  
Equity in earnings of subsidiaries
    237,977       101,689       89,157       (428,823 )     -  
Net income
  $ 215,498     $ 89,278     $ 339,549     $ (428,827 )   $ 215,498  
                                         

 
F-34

 
 
Platinum Underwriters Holdings, Ltd. and Subsidiaries
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS - (Continued)
 
Condensed Consolidating Statement of Operations
For the Year Ended December 31, 2009

   
Platinum
Holdings
   
Platinum
Finance
   
Non-guarantor Subsidiaries
   
Consolidating Adjustments
   
Consolidated
 
Revenue:
                                   
Net premiums earned
  $ -     $ -     $ 937,336     $ -     $ 937,336  
Net investment income
    54       141       163,746       -       163,941  
Net realized gains on investments
    -       1       78,629       -       78,630  
Net impairment losses on investments
    -       -       (17,603 )     -       (17,603 )
Other income (expense)
    4,724       -       (1,640 )     -       3,084  
Total revenue
    4,778       142       1,160,468       -       1,165,388  
                                         
Expenses:
                                       
Net losses and loss adjustment expenses
    -       -       478,342       -       478,342  
Net acquisition expenses
    -       -       176,419       -       176,419  
Net changes in fair value of derivatives
    -       -       9,741       -       9,741  
Operating expenses
    29,640       371       64,671       -       94,682  
Net foreign currency exchange losses (gains)
    -       -       (400 )     1       (399 )
Interest expense
    -       19,027       -       -       19,027  
Total expenses
    29,640       19,398       728,773       1       777,812  
Income (loss) before income taxes
    (24,862 )     (19,256 )     431,695       (1 )     387,576  
Income tax expense (benefit)
    600       (6,684 )     10,369       -       4,285  
Income (loss) before equity in earnings of subsidiaries
    (25,462 )     (12,572 )     421,326       (1 )     383,291  
Equity in earnings of subsidiaries
    408,753       26,295       14,106       (449,154 )     -  
Net income (loss)
    383,291       13,723       435,432       (449,155 )     383,291  
Preferred dividends
    1,301       -       -       -       1,301  
Net income (loss) attributable to common shareholders
  $ 381,990     $ 13,723     $ 435,432     $ (449,155 )   $ 381,990  
                                         
 
Condensed Consolidating Statement of Cash Flows
For Year Ended December 31, 2011

   
Platinum
Holdings
   
Platinum
Finance
   
Non-guarantor
Subsidiaries
   
Consolidating Adjustments
   
Consolidated
 
                               
Net cash provided by (used in) operating activities
  $ (4,151 )   $ (16,200 )   $ (13,355 )   $ -     $ (33,706 )
                                         
Investing Activities:
                                       
Proceeds from sale of fixed maturity available-for-sale securities
    -       -       466,759       -       466,759  
Proceeds from sale of fixed maturity trading securities
    -       -       20,413       -       20,413  
Proceeds from sale of short-term investments
    -       -       52,695       -       52,695  
Proceeds from maturity or paydown of fixed maturity
available-for-sale securities
    -       113       125,682       -       125,795  
Proceeds from maturity of fixed maturity trading securities
    -       -       5,000       -       5,000  
Proceeds from maturity of short-term investments
    -       -       583,999       -       583,999  
Proceeds from sale of investment-related derivatives
    -       -       7,778       -       7,778  
Acquisition of fixed maturity available-for-sale securities
    -       -       (223,675 )     -       (223,675 )
Acquisition of short-term investments
    -       -       (1,053,552 )     -       (1,053,552 )
Acquisition of investment-related derivatives
    -       -       (9,423 )     -       (9,423 )
Dividends from subsidiaries
    355,000       45,000       -       (400,000 )     -  
Investment in subsidiary
    (120,000 )     (3,000 )     -       123,000       -  
Inter-company loans
    -       75,000       100,000       (175,000 )     -  
Net cash provided by (used in) investing activities
    235,000       117,113       75,676       (452,000 )     (24,211 )
                                         
Financing Activities:
                                       
Dividends paid to common shareholders
    (11,744 )     -       (400,000 )     400,000       (11,744 )
Repurchase of common shares
    (94,695 )     -       -       -       (94,695 )
Purchase of common share options
    (47,900 )     -       -       -       (47,900 )
Proceeds from exercise of common share options
    1,246       -       -       -       1,246  
Capital contribution from parent
    -       -       123,000       (123,000 )     -  
Inter-company loans
    (75,000 )     -       (100,000 )     175,000       -  
Net cash provided by (used in) financing activities
    (228,093 )     -       (377,000 )     452,000       (153,093 )
                                         
Effect of foreign currency exchange rate changes on cash
    -       -       15,643       -       15,643  
Net increase (decrease) in cash and cash equivalents
    2,756       100,913       (299,036 )     -       (195,367 )
Cash and cash equivalents at beginning of year
    45,035       7,347       935,495       -       987,877  
Cash and cash equivalents at end of year
  $ 47,791     $ 108,260     $ 636,459     $ -     $ 792,510  

 
F-35

 
 
Platinum Underwriters Holdings, Ltd. and Subsidiaries
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS - (Continued)
 
Condensed Consolidating Statement of Cash Flows
For the Year Ended December 31, 2010

   
Platinum
Holdings
   
Platinum
Finance
   
Non-guarantor Subsidiaries
   
Consolidating Adjustments
   
Consolidated
 
                               
Net cash provided by (used in) operating activities
  $ (18,940 )   $ (9,403 )   $ 53,072     $ -     $ 24,729  
                                         
Investing Activities:
                                       
Proceeds from sale of fixed maturity available-for-sale securities
    -       10,572       3,331,239       -       3,341,811  
Proceeds from sale of preferred stocks
    -       -       5,176       -       5,176  
Proceeds from sale of short-term investments
    -       -       17,110       -       17,110  
Proceeds from maturity or paydown of fixed maturity
available-for-sale securities
    -       521       226,553       -       227,074  
Proceeds from maturity of short-term investments
    -       20,400       438,925       -       459,325  
Acquisition of fixed maturity available-for-sale securities
    -       -       (2,687,690 )     -       (2,687,690 )
Acquisition of short-term investments
    -       (5,398 )     (619,090 )     -       (624,488 )
Dividends from subsidiaries
    396,500       58,000       -       (454,500 )     -  
Inter-company loans
    -       (75,000 )     -       75,000       -  
Net cash provided by (used in) investing activities
    396,500       9,095       712,223       (379,500 )     738,318  
                                         
Financing Activities:
                                       
Dividends paid to common shareholders
    (13,403 )     -       (454,500 )     454,500       (13,403 )
Repurchase of common shares
    (379,675 )     -       -       -       (379,675 )
Purchase of common share options
    (98,520 )     -       -       -       (98,520 )
Proceeds from exercise of common share options
    34,625       -       -       -       34,625  
Inter-company loans
    75,000       -       -       (75,000 )     -  
Net cash provided by (used in) financing activities
    (381,973 )     -       (454,500 )     379,500       (456,973 )
                                         
Effect of foreign currency exchange rate changes on cash
    -       -       (981 )     -       (981 )
Net increase (decrease) in cash and cash equivalents
    (4,413 )     (308 )     309,814       -       305,093  
Cash and cash equivalents at beginning of year
    49,448       7,655       625,681       -       682,784  
Cash and cash equivalents at end of year
  $ 45,035     $ 7,347     $ 935,495     $ -     $ 987,877  
 
Condensed Consolidating Statement of Cash Flows
For the Year Ended December 31, 2009

   
Platinum
Holdings
   
Platinum
Finance
   
Non-guarantor Subsidiaries
   
Consolidating Adjustments
   
Consolidated
 
                               
Net cash provided by (used in) operating activities
  $ (7,639 )   $ (17,008 )   $ 501,844     $ -     $ 477,197  
                                         
Investing Activities:
                                       
Proceeds from sale of fixed maturity available-for-sale securities
    -       -       1,538,633       -       1,538,633  
Proceeds from sale of fixed maturity trading securities
    -       -       153,223       -       153,223  
Proceeds from sale of short-term investments
    -       -       365,676       -       365,676  
Proceeds from maturity or paydown of fixed maturity
available-for-sale securities
    -       757       434,126       -       434,883  
Proceeds from maturity of short-term investments
    -       -       67,450       -       67,450  
Acquisition of fixed maturity available-for-sale securities
    -       (9,985 )     (2,351,328 )     -       (2,361,313 )
Acquisition of fixed maturity trading securities
    -       -       (164,748 )     -       (164,748 )
Acquisition of short-term investments
    -       (14,944 )     (369,149 )     -       (384,093 )
Dividends from subsidiaries
    255,000       20,000       -       (275,000 )     -  
Proceeds from sale of subsidiary shares
    -       -       15,377       (15,377 )     -  
Purchase of subsidiary shares
    -       -       (18,367 )     18,367       -  
Net cash provided by (used in) investing activities
    255,000       (4,172 )     (329,107 )     (272,010 )     (350,289 )
                                         
Financing Activities:
                                       
Dividends paid to preferred shareholders
    (2,602 )     -       -       -       (2,602 )
Dividends paid to common shareholders
    (16,099 )     -       (275,000 )     275,000       (16,099 )
Repurchase of common shares
    (252,296 )     -       (15,377 )     15,377       (252,296 )
Proceeds from exercise of common share options
    6,759       -       -       -       6,759  
Proceeds from common share issuance
    -       18,367       -       (18,367 )     -  
Net cash provided by (used in) financing activities
    (264,238 )     18,367       (290,377 )     272,010       (264,238 )
                                         
Effect of foreign currency exchange rate changes on cash
    -       -       7,097       -       7,097  
Net increase (decrease) in cash and cash equivalents
    (16,877 )     (2,813 )     (110,543 )     -       (130,233 )
Cash and cash equivalents at beginning of year
    66,325       10,468       736,224       -       813,017  
Cash and cash equivalents at end of year
  $ 49,448     $ 7,655     $ 625,681     $ -     $ 682,784  
 
 
F-36

 
 
Platinum Underwriters Holdings, Ltd. and Subsidiaries
INDEX TO SCHEDULES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
 
   
Page
Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm
S-2
Schedule I
Summary of Investments – Other Than Investments in Related Parties as of December 31, 2011
S-3
Schedule II
Condensed Financial Information of the Registrant
S-4
Schedule III
Supplementary Insurance Information for the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009
S-7
Schedule IV
Reinsurance for the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009
S-8
 
Schedules other than those listed above are omitted for the reason that they are not applicable or the information is provided elsewhere in the consolidated financial statements.
 
 
S-1

 
 
REPORT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM
 
The Board of Directors and Shareholders
Platinum Underwriters Holdings, Ltd.:
 
Under date of February 21, 2012, we reported on the consolidated balance sheets of Platinum Underwriters Holdings, Ltd. and subsidiaries as of December 31, 2011 and 2010, and the related consolidated statements of operations and comprehensive income (loss), shareholders' equity and cash flows for each of the years in the three-year period ended December 31, 2011, as contained in the annual report on Form 10-K for the year 2011.  In connection with our audits of the aforementioned consolidated financial statements, we also audited the related consolidated financial statement schedules as listed in the accompanying index.  These financial statement schedules are the responsibility of the Company's management.  Our responsibility is to express an opinion on these financial statement schedules based on our audits.
 
In our opinion, such financial statement schedules, when considered in relation to the basic consolidated financial statements taken as a whole, present fairly, in all material respects, the information set forth therein.
 
As discussed in note 1 to the consolidated financial statements, the Company changed the manner in which it accounts for other-than-temporary impairments of debt securities in 2009.

 
/s/ KPMG

 
Hamilton, Bermuda
February 21, 2012

 
S-2

 
 
SCHEDULE I
Platinum Underwriters Holdings, Ltd. and Subsidiaries
Summary of Investments - Other Than Investments in Related Parties
As of December 31, 2011
($ in thousands)

   
Cost*
   
Fair Value
   
Amount at which shown in Balance Sheet
 
                   
Fixed maturity securities:
                 
Bonds:
                 
U.S. Government and government agencies and authorities
  $ 104,702     $ 105,342     $ 105,342  
States, municipalities and political subdivisions
    1,432,458       1,576,216       1,576,216  
Non-U.S. governments
    185,148       196,392       196,392  
Non-U.S. corporate
    71,433       74,864       74,864  
Public utilities
    143,240       154,968       154,968  
All other corporate
    672,885       680,918       680,918  
Total fixed maturity securities
    2,609,866       2,788,700       2,788,700  
Short-term investments
    588,788       588,834       588,834  
Total investments
  $ 3,198,654     $ 3,377,534     $ 3,377,534  
 
* Original cost of fixed maturities reduced by repayments and adjusted for amortization of premiums and discounts.
 
See accompanying report of the independent registered public accounting firm.
 
 
S-3

 
 
SCHEDULE II
Platinum Underwriters Holdings, Ltd. and Subsidiaries
(Parent Company)
Condensed Balance Sheets
December 31, 2011 and 2010
($ in thousands, except share data)
 
   
2011
   
2010
 
ASSETS
           
Investment in subsidiaries
  $ 1,638,898     $ 1,910,617  
Cash and cash equivalents
    47,791       45,035  
Other assets
    6,229       17,337  
Total assets
  $ 1,692,918     $ 1,972,989  
                 
LIABILITIES AND SHAREHOLDERS' EQUITY
               
Liabilities
               
Inter-company loans
  $ -     $ 75,000  
Other liabilities
    2,059       2,534  
Total liabilities
  $ 2,059     $ 77,534  
Shareholders' equity
               
Common shares, $.01 par value, 200,000,000 shares authorized 35,526,400 and 37,757,926 shares issued and outstanding, respectively
  $ 355     $ 377  
Additional paid-in-capital
    313,730       453,619  
Accumulated other comprehensive income (loss)
    146,635       (24,488 )
Retained earnings
    1,230,139       1,465,947  
Total shareholders' equity
  $ 1,690,859     $ 1,895,455  
Total liabilities and shareholders' equity
  $ 1,692,918     $ 1,972,989  
 
See accompanying report of the independent registered public accounting firm.
 
 
S-4

 
 
SCHEDULE II, continued
Platinum Underwriters Holdings, Ltd. and Subsidiaries
(Parent Company)
Condensed Statements of Operations
For the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009
($ in thousands)

   
2011
   
2010
   
2009
 
Revenue:
                 
Net investment income
  $ 5     $ 82     $ 54  
Other income (expense)
    (573 )     4,225       4,724  
Total revenue
    (568 )     4,307       4,778  
                         
Expenses:
                       
Operating expenses
    15,813       26,108       29,640  
Net foreign currency exchange losses (gains)
    1       -       -  
Interest expense on inter-company loans
    53       78       -  
Total expenses
    15,867       26,186       29,640  
                         
Income (loss) before income taxes
    (16,435 )     (21,879 )     (24,862 )
Income tax expense (benefit)
    (600 )     600       600  
Income (loss) before equity in earnings of subsidiaries
    (15,835 )     (22,479 )     (25,462 )
Equity in earnings of subsidiaries
    (208,229 )     237,977       408,753  
Net income (loss)
    (224,064 )     215,498       383,291  
Preferred dividends
    -       -       1,301  
Net income (loss) attributable to common shareholders
  $ (224,064 )   $ 215,498     $ 381,990  
 
See accompanying report of the independent registered public accounting firm.
 
 
S-5

 
 
SCHEDULE II, continued
Platinum Underwriters Holdings, Ltd. and Subsidiaries
(Parent Company)
Condensed Statements of Cash Flows
For the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009
($ in thousands)

   
2011
   
2010
   
2009
 
Operating Activities:
                 
Net loss before equity in earnings of subsidiaries
  $ (15,835 )   $ (22,479 )   $ (25,462 )
Adjustments to reconcile net loss to net cash provided by (used in) operations:
                       
Share-based compensation
    984       5,917       6,865  
Depreciation and amortization
    -       76       403  
Other net
    10,700       (2,454 )     10,555  
Net cash provided by (used in) operating activities
    (4,151 )     (18,940 )     (7,639 )
                         
Investing Activities:
                       
Dividends from subsidiaries
    355,000       396,500       255,000  
Investment in subsidiary
    (120,000 )     -       -  
Net cash provided by (used in) investing activities
    235,000       396,500       255,000  
                         
Financing Activities:
                       
Dividends paid to preferred shareholders
    -       -       (2,602 )
Dividends paid to common shareholders
    (11,744 )     (13,403 )     (16,099 )
Repurchase of common shares
    (94,695 )     (379,675 )     (252,296 )
Purchase of common share options
    (47,900 )     (98,520 )     -  
Proceeds from exercise of common share options
    1,246       34,625       6,759  
Inter-company loans
    (75,000 )     75,000       -  
Net cash provided by (used in) financing activities
    (228,093 )     (381,973 )     (264,238 )
Net increase (decrease) in cash and cash equivalents
    2,756       (4,413 )     (16,877 )
Cash and cash equivalents at beginning of year
    45,035       49,448       66,325  
Cash and cash equivalents at end of year
  $ 47,791     $ 45,035     $ 49,448  
                         
Supplemental disclosures of cash flow information:
                       
Income taxes paid (recovered)
  $ (600 )   $ 600     $ 600  
Interest paid
  $ 131     $ -     $ -  
 
See accompanying report of the independent registered public accounting firm.
 
 
S-6

 
 
SCHEDULE III
Platinum Underwriters Holdings, Ltd. and Subsidiaries
Supplementary Insurance Information
 ($ in thousands)
 

Period
 
Deferred Policy Acquisition Costs
   
Net Unpaid Losses and Loss Adjustment Expenses
   
Net Unearned Premium
   
Other Policy Claims and Benefits Payable
   
Net Earned Premium
   
Net Investment Income
   
Net Losses and Loss Adjustment Expenses Incurred
   
Amortization of Deferred Policy Acquisition Costs (1)
   
Other Operating Expenses (2)
   
Net Written Premiums
 
Year ended December 31, 2011:
                                                           
Property and Marine
  $ 4,772     $ 806,066     $ 13,895           $ 356,976           $ 628,062     $ 49,348     $ 27,622     $ 344,682  
Casualty
    22,915       1,512,727       93,938             318,734             178,650       72,738       19,002       296,989  
Finite Risk
    1,092       66,866       4,971             13,742             (1,275 )     11,091       940       9,843  
Total
  $ 28,779     $ 2,385,659     $ 112,804     $ -     $ 689,452     $ 125,863     $ 805,437     $ 133,177     $ 47,564     $ 651,514  
                                                                                 
Year ended December 31, 2010:
                                                                               
Property and Marine
  $ 6,184     $ 523,283     $ 25,982             $ 418,763             $ 343,509     $ 60,224     $ 32,678     $ 412,675  
Casualty
    28,462       1,597,740       115,663               343,812               119,679       71,474       23,091       329,397  
Finite Risk
    1,938       87,443       8,869               17,419               4,232       14,978       1,260       18,517  
Total
  $ 36,584     $ 2,208,466     $ 150,514     $ -     $ 779,994     $ 134,385     $ 467,420     $ 146,676     $ 57,029     $ 760,589  
                                                                                 
Year ended December 31, 2009:
                                                                               
Property and Marine
  $ 6,840     $ 470,288     $ 32,194             $ 528,488             $ 250,646     $ 66,992     $ 37,331     $ 517,011  
Casualty
    31,854       1,753,160       130,174               388,901               226,511       88,841       25,644       356,488  
Finite Risk
    1,733       111,560       7,771               19,947               1,185       20,586       1,412       24,335  
Total
  $ 40,427     $ 2,335,008     $ 170,139     $ -     $ 937,336     $ 163,941     $ 478,342     $ 176,419     $ 64,387     $ 897,834  
 
(1)  
Amounts represent the net acquisition expenses in the accompanying Consolidated Statements of Operations and Comprehensive Income (Loss) and include total deferred acquisition costs amortized of $101.8 million, $113.7 million and $133.6 million in 2011, 2010 and 2009, respectively.
(2)  
Amounts exclude corporate expenses not allocated to segments of $15.6 million, $25.6 million, and $30.3 million in 2011, 2010, and 2009, respectively.
 
 
See accompanying report of the independent registered public accounting firm.
 
 
S-7

 
 
SCHEDULE IV
Platinum Underwriters Holdings, Ltd. and Subsidiaries
Reinsurance
 ($ in thousands)

Description
 
Direct Amount
   
Ceded to Other Companies
   
Assumed From Other Companies
   
Net Amount
   
Percentage of Amount Assumed to Net
 
Property and liability premiums written:
                             
Year ended December 31, 2011:
                             
Property and Marine
  $ -     $ 35,782     $ 380,464     $ 344,682       110.4 %
Casualty
    -       -       296,989       296,989       100.0 %
Finite Risk
    -       -       9,843       9,843       100.0 %
Total
  $ -     $ 35,782     $ 687,296     $ 651,514       105.5 %
Year ended December 31, 2010:
                                       
Property and Marine
  $ -     $ 18,937     $ 431,612     $ 412,675       104.6 %
Casualty
    -       -       329,397       329,397       100.0 %
Finite Risk
    -       -       18,517       18,517       100.0 %
Total
  $ -     $ 18,937     $ 779,526     $ 760,589       102.5 %
Year ended December 31, 2009:
                                       
Property and Marine
  $ -     $ 26,840     $ 543,851     $ 517,011       105.2 %
Casualty
    -       -       356,488       356,488       100.0 %
Finite Risk
    -       -       24,335       24,335       100.0 %
Total
  $ -     $ 26,840     $ 924,674     $ 897,834       103.0 %
 
See accompanying report of the independent registered public accounting firm.
 
S-8